Panasonic DMR-BS750 Blu-ray Disc Recorder

P8 – 15
Quick Start Guide
Operating Instructions
Blu-ray Disc Recorder
Model No. DMR-BS850EB
DMR-BS750EB
The illustrations in these Operating Instructions show the images of DMR-BS850EB.
Dear customer
Thank you for purchasing this product.
For optimum performance and safety, please read these instructions carefully.
Before connecting, operating or adjusting this product, please read the instructions completely.
Please keep this manual for future reference.
Note: “EB” on the packaging indicates the United Kingdom.
Trademark of the DVB Digital Video Broadcasting Project
Declaration of Conformity (12th December 2008)
For DMR-BS850 No. 6261
For DMR-BS750 No. 6262
This Blu-ray Disc Recorder is for viewing and recording free to view channels only, not Pay TV or encrypted channels.
This unit does not have a terrestrial tuner.
Region management information
BD-Video
This unit plays BD-Video marked with labels containing the region code B.
Example:
DVD-Video
The unit plays DVD-Video marked with labels containing the region number “2” or “ALL”.
Example:
2
ALL
2
3
4
Web Site: http://www.panasonic-europe.com
EB
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 1
RQT9430-1B
2009/05/13 15:00:53
Features
freesat HD tuners built-in
Receives freesat - free digital satellite
broadcasts in the UK
This Blu-ray Disc Recorder has two freesat tuners
built-in. freesat is a brand new free digital TV service
which broadcasts via satellite so you can receive TV,
radio, interactive TV.
To enjoy HD programme
You can enjoy the original HD progarmme by
connecting to TV through HDMI.
• Connection (➔ 10)
• Watching Television (➔ 24)
• Also in HD (➔ 29)
• Guide Link, Series recording, Split programme (➔ 28)
• 7days EPG
Timer recording is made easier because the TV
Guide allows you to see programme information up
to 7 days ahead. (➔ 43)
WED 19/08/2009 13:30
TV Guide: Landscape
All Types
WED 19th
12:00-20:00 HD BBC HD Preview
Time: 14:00
14:30
108 BBC HD
BBC HD Preview
113 ITV2
Red Cap
Red Cap
114 ITV2+1
115 ITV3
116 ITV3+1
117 ITV4
120 Channel4
15:00
Love USA
News Show
100 Sheep Dream
Heartbeat
UFO
Behind me
Select Channel
OK
Select Programme
RETURN
VIERA CASTTM
You can access a selection of Internet services from
the Home screen with VIERA CAST, for example
YouTube, Picasa Web Albums. (Current as of
February 2009)
• Enjoying VIERA CASTTM (➔ 85)
Linked operations with the TV
You can enjoy linked operations with the TV and
receiver by using VIERA Link or Q Link.
• Linked operations with the TV (VIERA Link “HDAVI
ControlTM”/Q Link) (➔ 86)
• Eco-LINK to save power consumption
• Pause Live TV (➔ 93)
VIERA
All Channels
15:30
16:00
Red Cap
News Show
USO
Blue Wave Great A
In the
100 Sheep Dream
Hot Wave
Used Car
Black House
Crowntown
Portrait/Landscape
+24 hours
Deal
Page Up
Page Down
Info
GUIDE
Convenient Functions !
Prog. Type
CH
Channel Genre
DIGA
High Quality Picture
Record with High Definition
It is possible to record in high definition quality when
the broadcast is high definition. (➔ 19)
Copy high definition video
It is possible to input high definition video (AVCHD)
from the Panasonic’s video camera, etc.
• Copying HD Video (AVCHD format) (➔ 68)
Easy access to various functions
You can access the main function quickly and
easily from FUNCTION MENU display.
• FUNCTION MENU display (➔ 92)
If the programme is broadcast with HD, this unit let
you inform also in HD event on barner, EPG,
HD Picture Quality recording mode (➔ 19)
Compress the recorded programme (➔ 34)
FUNCTION MENU
HDD
Time Remaining 30:00 DR
Select a function
and an item.
Playback
Recording
Delete
Copy
DELETE Navigator Grouped Titles
Time Remaining
HDD
TV Guide
Date
Others
RETURN
45:54 DR VIDEO
Channel
25/05
01/06 AV2
01/06 AV1
OK
You can access
selected function
easily.
Time
PICTURE
Title Name
MUSIC
Titles
12:36 Born And Bred: A Wrathful
1:35
1:13
2
1
1
Rec time
0:00(DR)
Not viewed
Copy to Blu-ray Disc
Page 01/01
OK
RETURN
OPTION
VIDEO
Select
PICTURE
MUSIC
It can record in high definition quality in addition to
large volume recording. (➔ 18)
TWIN HD Satellite Tuner
Parental Guidance
It is possible to record 2 programmes being
broadcasted at the same time. (➔ 38)
You can restrict viewing and playback of the titles
that may include contents for adults.
When you record the programme with
icon, PIN
is needed to playback the title. (➔ 34)
2
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 2
2009/05/13 15:00:53
Accessories
Please check and identify the supplied accessories. Use numbers indicated in parentheses when asking for replacement parts.
(Product numbers correct as of April 2009. These may be subject to change.)
1
Remote control (N2QAYB000337)
2
Batteries for remote control
(R6 Size)
Sales and Support Information
Customer Care Centre
• For customers within the UK: 0844 844 3852
• For customers within the Republic of Ireland: 01 289 8333
• Visit our website for product information
www.panasonic.co.uk
• E-mail: customer.care@panasonic.co.uk
Direct Sales at Panasonic UK
• For customers: 0844 844 3856
• Order accessory and consumable items for your product with
ease and confidence by phoning our Customer Care Centre
Monday–Thursday 9:00 a.m.– 5:30 p.m., Friday 9:30 a.m.– 5:30
p.m. (Excluding public holidays).
1 AC mains lead (K2CT3CA00004)
• For use with this unit only. Do not use it with
other equipment. Also, do not use cords for
other equipment with this unit.
• Or go on line through our Internet Accessory ordering application
at shop.panasonic.co.uk.
• Most major credit and debit cards accepted.
• All enquiries transactions and distribution facilities are provided
directly by Panasonic UK Ltd.
• It couldn’t be simpler!
• Also available through our Internet is direct shopping for a wide
range of finished products, take a browse on our website for
further details shop.panasonic.co.uk.
Interested in purchasing an extended guarantee?
Please call 0870 240 6284 or visit our website
www.panasonic.co.uk/guarantee.
Caution for AC Mains Lead
For your safety, please read the following text carefully.
This appliance is supplied with a moulded three pin mains plug for
your safety and convenience.
A 5-ampere fuse is fitted in this plug.
Should the fuse need to be replaced please ensure that the
replacement fuse has a rating of 5-ampere and that it is approved by
ASTA or BSI to BS1362.
Check for the ASTA mark
fuse.
or the BSI mark
on the body of the
If the plug contains a removable fuse cover you must ensure that it is
refitted when the fuse is replaced.
If you lose the fuse cover the plug must not be used until a
replacement cover is obtained.
A replacement fuse cover can be purchased from your local dealer.
CAUTION!
IF THE FITTED MOULDED PLUG IS UNSUITABLE FOR THE
SOCKET OUTLET IN YOUR HOME THEN THE FUSE SHOULD
BE REMOVED AND THE PLUG CUT OFF AND DISPOSED OF
SAFELY.
THERE IS A DANGER OF SEVERE ELECTRICAL SHOCK IF THE
CUT OFF PLUG IS INSERTED INTO ANY 13-AMPERE SOCKET.
WARNING: DO NOT CONNECT EITHER WIRE TO THE
EARTH TERMINAL WHICH IS MARKED WITH THE
LETTER E, BY THE EARTH SYMBOL
OR COLOURED GREEN
OR GREEN/YELLOW.
THIS PLUG IS NOT WATERPROOF—KEEP DRY.
Before use
Remove the connector cover.
How to replace the fuse
The location of the fuse differ according to the type of AC mains plug
(figures A and B). Confirm the AC mains plug fitted and follow the
instructions below.
Illustrations may differ from actual AC mains plug.
1. Open the fuse cover with a screwdriver.
Figure A
Figure B
Fuse cover
If a new plug is to be fitted please observe the wiring code as stated
below.
If in any doubt please consult a qualified electrician.
IMPORTANT
The wires in this mains lead are coloured in accordance with the
following code:
Blue: Neutral, Brown: Live.
As these colours may not correspond with the coloured markings
identifying the terminals in your plug, proceed as follows:
The wire which is coloured Blue must be connected to the terminal
which is marked with the letter N or coloured Black or Blue.
The wire which is coloured Brown must be connected to the terminal
which is marked with the letter L or coloured Brown or Red.
2. Replace the fuse and close or attach the fuse cover.
Figure A
Figure B
Fuse
(5 ampere)
Fuse
(5 ampere)
3
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 3
2009/05/13 15:00:53
Table of Contents
Getting started
Getting Started
Features. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2
Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3
Sales and Support Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3
Caution for AC Mains Lead . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3
HDD (Hard disk drive) Handling Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6
Remote Control Information/Unit Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7
Remote Control Information. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7
Unit Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7
Quick Start Guide
Location of Parts/Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8
Remote Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8
The Unit’s Display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9
Main Unit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9
Rear Panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9
Basic Connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10
When your Television has an HDMI input terminal. . . . . . . . . . . 10
When your Television does not have an HDMI input terminal . . 12
Auto Set Up (freesat). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13
Tuning in Other Satellite Services . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .16
HDD and Disc Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .18
Regarding Blu-ray Disc . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .18
Recording and copying programmes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .19
HDD and Disc Handling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .20
HDD and discs you can use for recording and play . . . . . . . . . . .20
Play-only discs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .22
Discs that cannot be played . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .22
Types of disc for the type of connected TV . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .22
USB Memory and Card Handling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .23
USB memories you can use on this unit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .23
Cards usable on this unit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .23
Basic Operations
Watching Television (freesat) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24
Selecting a channel with TV Guide . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24
Watching Television of the Other Satellite Service . . 25
Selecting a channel with the channel list . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25
Playback . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26
Recording Television Programmes HDD . . . . . . . . . . 27
Timer Recording Using the TV Guide
(freesat) HDD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28
Recording the ITV HD, etc. programme . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29
Copying Titles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30
Deleting Titles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32
DELETE Navigator. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32
Delete Titles During Playback . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32
Title
Recording
Important Notes for Recording . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .33
Advanced Recording . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .35
Recording modes. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35
2 programmes simultaneous recording . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36
Specifying the Recording Time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .37
Direct TV Recording. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .37
Playing while you are recording . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .37
Operation during Recording. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .38
Advanced Timer Recording HDD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .39
Manual timer recordings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .39
Series recording. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .40
To cancel a timer recording in progress . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .41
Auto Renewal Recording . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .41
If the “Overlapped Timer Recording” screen appears . . . . . . . . .41
Check, Change, Delete Programmes, or Resolve Overlapping . .41
To deactivate timer programme
(e.g. to interrupt a daily or weekly timer programming) . . . . . . .42
Notes on timer recording . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .42
TV Guide system (freesat) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43
Using the TV Guide list . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43
Selecting the programme from the desired channel genre or
programme type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44
Playing Back
Advanced Playback . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .45
Selecting Titles to Play. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .45
Search . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .46
Skip . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .46
Quick View (Play x1.3) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .46
Direct Play . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .46
Slow-motion Play . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .46
Frame-by-Frame Viewing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .47
Time Slip . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .47
Manual Skip . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .47
Create Chapters. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .47
Display the subtitle during play . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .47
Playback of the High Definition Video (AVCHD) and
playlists . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .48
Playback of the High Definition Video (AVCHD) . . . . . . . . . . . . .48
Playback of the playlists created on other equipment . . . . . . . . .48
To enjoy the BD Video which supports BONUSVIEW
or BD-Live . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .49
Playing secondary video (picture-in-picture)
and secondary audio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .49
Enjoying BD-Live discs with Internet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .49
To enjoy High Bit rate Audio and Video . . . . . . . . . . . . .50
Enjoying High Bit rate Audio with 7.1ch speaker . . . . . . . . . . . . .50
Regarding 24p output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .50
Playing DivX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .51
Playing DivX video contents. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .51
Editing
Titles−Editing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .53
Accessing the Title View . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .53
Title Operations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .53
Create/Playback/Edit of the Chapter. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .56
Create Chapter Mark . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .56
Editing and playing chapters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .56
Chapter operations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .56
Copying
Copying Titles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .57
Copy direction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .57
Copy speed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .58
Copying speed when copying from the HDD to BD-R
in High Speed Copy. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .58
Copy restrictions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .58
Copying list icons and functions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .58
Frequently Asked Questions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .59
Copy Title Playing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .60
Copying using the copying list—Copy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .61
Copying a finalised DVD-R, DVD-R DL, DVD-RW (DVD-Video
format), +R and +R DL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .63
With Other Equipment
Recording from a Satellite or Cable Receiver . . . . . . . .64
Manual Recording . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .64
Linked timer recordings with external equipment
(SKY Digital STB, satellite/cable receiver)–EXT LINK. . . . . . . .64
Recording from an External Device . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .65
Recording from a VCR, etc. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .65
Recording from a DV Camcorder. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .66
Recording via AV3 Input . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .67
Flexible Recording via AV Input . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .67
Copying HD Video (AVCHD format) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .68
From an SD card or Discs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .68
From a video equipment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .68
Copying SD Video (MPEG2 format). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .69
From an SD card . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .69
From a video equipment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .69
4
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 4
2009/05/13 15:00:54
Copying all the still pictures on the USB memory
—Copy All Pictures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .74
Copying new still pictures on the SD card
—Copy New Pictures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .74
Copying using the copying list . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .74
Deleting still pictures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .76
Music
Music
Playing music . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .77
Playing MP3 files . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .77
Playing music CD. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .77
Playing music recorded on HDD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .78
Useful functions during music play. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .79
Editing music/playlist. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .80
Editing music . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .80
Album and track operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .80
Register track to Playlist. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .81
Editing Playlist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .81
Playlist operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .81
Copying music to HDD. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .82
About the Gracenote® Database . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .82
Copying music from a disc or a USB memory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .82
Deleting music . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .83
Others
Convenient Functions
Entering Text . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .84
Enjoying VIERA CAST™ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .85
P8 – 15
If a software update is available, a notification is displayed . . . 111
The unit’s display during the update . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111
Quick Start Guide
Copying still pictures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .74
Software Update . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111
Reference
Additional Connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .112
Adding a VCR: Connecting to a Television
and a Video Cassette Recorder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .112
Adding a Digital Satellite or Cable Receiver: Connecting to a
Television and a Digital Satellite or Cable Receiver . . . . . . . .112
Using an Audio/Video Cable (not included) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .113
Using an S Video Cable (not included). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .113
Using Component Video Cables (not included) . . . . . . . . . . . . .113
Using an Audio Cable (not included) for Better Sound . . . . . . .114
Using a Optical Digital Audio Cable (not included)
for Better Sound . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .114
Connecting with an HDMI (High Definition Multimedia
Interface) Terminal. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .114
Network connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .115
Basic Operations
Editing still pictures (JPEG) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .72
Still pictures operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .73
Operations that can be performed
simultaneously . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116
Recording
Useful functions during still picture play. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .71
Editing still pictures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .72
Operations that can be performed while recording
or copying a title . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116
Starting of the timer recording
while executing other operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116
Media (Disc/USB Memory/SD Card) Handling . . . . . . .117
Frequently Asked Questions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .118
Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .120
Playing Back
Playing still pictures. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .70
Testing the connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109
Setting the IP address . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109
Setting the DNS-IP. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109
Setting the connection speed. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109
Setting the proxy server . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110
Setting the network service (VIERA CAST). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110
When removing a recorded disc . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .121
Troubleshooting Guide . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .122
Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .134
Copyright, etc.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .137
Glossary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .138
Safety precautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .140
Index . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .142
Editing
Still Picture
Network Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109
Copying
Still pictures
Linked Operations with the TV
(VIERA Link “HDAVI Control™”/Q Link) . . . . . . . . . . 86
Easy control only with VIERA remote control. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 87
Setting On-Screen Display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .88
With Other
Equipment
Accessing the On-Screen Display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .88
Information Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .90
Digital Satellite Channel Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .90
Status Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .91
Convenient Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .92
Still Picture
FUNCTION MENU display. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .92
Switch the aspect ratio of the screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .92
To pause the TV programme you are watching
—Pause Live TV . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .93
Disc and Card Management . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .94
Accessing the Management Menus. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .94
Setup Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .97
Convenient
Functions
About descriptions in these operating instructions
• These operating instructions are applicable to models
DMR-BS850 and DMR-BS750. Unless otherwise indicated,
illustrations in these operating instructions are DMR-BS850.
DMR-BS850 : indicates features applicable to DMR-BS850 only.
DMR-BS750 : indicates features applicable to DMR-BS750 only.
• Pages to be referred to are indicated as “➔
”.
Reference
HOLD function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .108
Using the Unit’s Remote Control to Operate the TV . . . . . . . . .108
Music
Accessing the Setup Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .97
Channel Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .97
HDD/Disc Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .100
Picture and Sound Settings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .102
Display and Connection Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .104
Network Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .106
System Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .107
Other Settings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .108
5
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 5
2009/05/13 15:00:54
HDD (Hard disk drive) Handling Care
The HDD is a high precision recording instrument and because of its long recording capability and high speed operation it is a very special
device that is easily susceptible to damage.
As a basic rule, save important content to a disc as backup.
■ The HDD is a device that is not built to withstand vibration/shock or dust
Depending on the setup environment and handling of the HDD some content may become damaged and play and recording may no longer be
possible. Especially during operation, do not subject the unit to any vibration, shock, or remove the AC mains lead from the household mains
socket. In the event of a power failure during recording or play, the content may be damaged.
■ The HDD is a temporary storage device
The HDD is not an everlasting storage device for recorded content. Use the HDD as a temporary storage place for one-off viewing, editing, or
copying. It is recommended to save the recorded content on a disc or to keep the original data or CDs that they were copied from.
■ Immediately save (backup) all content as soon as you feel there may be a problem with the HDD
If there is an irregularity within the HDD, repetitive strange sounds or problems with picture (block noise, etc.) may result. Using the HDD in this
condition may worsen the problem and in the worst case the HDD may no longer be usable. As soon as you notice this type of problem, copy all
content to disc and request service. Recorded content (data) on an HDD that has become unusable is unrecoverable.
When the unit is turned on or off, there may be an unexpected sound. This does not indicate a problem with this unit.
■ Setup precautions
Do not place in an enclosed area where the rear cooling fan
and the cooling vents on the side are covered up.
Place the unit on a surface that is flat and not subject to
vibration or impact.
Do not place on anything that generates
much heat, for example an audio
DO NOT
amplifier.
Do not place in an area often subject to
temperature changes.
This unit
Place in an area where condensation does
Amplifier
not occur. Condensation is a phenomenon
where moisture forms on a cold surface
when there is an extreme change in
temperature. Condensation may cause internal damage to the unit.
Conditions where condensation may occur
– When there is an extreme change in temperature (moving from a
very hot location to a very cold location, or vice versa, or when
subjected to an air conditioner or when cooled air directly impacts
the unit). When the HDD (warms during operation) is subjected to
cold air, condensation may form on the inside of the HDD and
may cause damage to the HDD heads, etc.
– When there is high humidity or a lot of steam in the room.
– During the rainy season.
In the above situation, without turning the unit on, let the unit
adjust to the room temperature and wait 2–3 hours until
condensation is gone.
■ Cigarette smoke etc. causes malfunction or
breakdown
The unit may breakdown if cigarette smoke or bug spray/vapor, etc.
gets inside the unit.
■ While operating
Do not move the unit or subject to vibration or impact. (The HDD
may become damaged.)
Do not remove the AC mains lead from the household mains
socket, or flip the power breaker switch.
While the unit is on, the HDD is rotating at high speed. Sound or
movement due to rotation is normal.
■ When moving the unit
1 Turn the unit off. (Wait until “BYE” disappears from the display.)
2 Remove the AC mains lead from the household mains socket.
3 Move only after the unit has come to a complete stop (approx. 2
minutes) in order to avoid subjecting to vibration and shock.
(Even after turning the unit off, the HDD continues operating for a
short time.)
■ Indemnity concerning recorded content
Panasonic does not accept any responsibility for damages directly or indirectly due to any type of problems that result in loss of recording or
edited content (data), and does not guarantee any content if recording or editing does not work properly. Likewise, the above also applies in a
case where any type of repair is made to the unit (including any other non-HDD related component).
6
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 6
2009/05/13 15:00:54
Remote Control Information/Unit Care
Remote Control Information
About batteries
• Insert so the poles (4 and 3) match those in the remote control.
Using the remote control
Aim at the sensor, avoiding obstacles, up to a maximum range of 7 m
directly in front of the unit.
Remote control signal sensor
R6/LR6, AA
•
•
•
•
•
Use alkaline or manganese batteries.
Do not mix old and new batteries.
Do not use different types at the same time.
Do not heat or expose to flame.
Do not leave the batteries in an automobile exposed to direct
sunlight for a long period of time with doors and windows closed.
• Do not take apart or short circuit.
• Do not attempt to recharge alkaline or manganese batteries.
• Do not use batteries if the covering has been peeled off.
20
30
20
30
Mishandling of batteries can cause electrolyte leakage which can
damage items the fluid contacts and may cause a fire.
Remove if the remote control is not going to be used for a long period
of time. Store in a cool, dark place.
Unit Care
The precision parts in this unit are readily affected by the
environment, especially temperature, humidity, and dust.
Cigarette smoke also can cause malfunction or breakdown.
To clean this unit, wipe with a soft, dry cloth.
• Never use alcohol, paint thinner or benzine to clean this unit.
• Before using chemically treated cloth, carefully read the instructions
that came with the cloth.
Observe the following points to ensure continued listening and
viewing pleasure.
Dust and dirt may adhere to the unit’s lens over time, making it
impossible to record or play discs.
Use the Lens cleaner (not included) about once every year,
depending on frequency of use and the operating environment.
Carefully read the lens cleaner’s instructions before use.
Do not place the unit on
amplifiers or equipment that may
become hot.
The heat can damage the unit.
DO NOT
Select a position with good ventilation when installing the unit. Do
not block the cooling fan on the rear of the unit.
Before moving the unit, ensure the disc tray is empty.
Failure to do so will risk severely damaging the disc and
the unit.
Lens cleaner: RP-CL720E
The manufacturer accepts no responsibility and offers no compensation for loss of recorded or edited
material due to a problem with the unit or recordable media, and accepts no responsibility and offers
no compensation for any subsequent damage caused by such loss.
Examples of causes of such losses are
• A disc copied and edited with this unit is played in a Blu-ray Disc Recorder or computer disc drive manufactured by
another company.
• A disc used as described above and then played again in this unit.
• A disc recorded and edited with a Blu-ray Disc Recorder or computer disc drive manufactured by another company is
played in this unit.
7
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 7
2009/05/13 15:00:54
Location of Parts/Controls
Remote Control
bo
8
9
bk
Turn the unit on or off.............................................. (➔ 13)
Select drive [HDD, BD or SD]. .......................... (➔ 26, 70)
Select channels and title numbers etc./Enter numbers
or characters (The character buttons may be used when
operating VIERA CAST contents.)
To delete unwanted recorded titles, timer programmes,
still pictures or music ............................. (➔ 32, 41, 76, 83)
Basic operations for recording and play
Show the digital satellite channel information ........ (➔ 90)
Programme information within TV Guide screen ... (➔ 43)
Show status messages........................................... (➔ 91)
Show DIRECT NAVIGATOR/Pop-up Menu/
Top Menu .......................................................... (➔ 26, 45)
Selection/OK, Frame-by-frame ......................... (➔ 13, 47)
Show OPTION menu
Use Colour buttons according to on-screen instructions.
bl
Recording function
1
2
3
bp
1
2
3
1 2abc 3def
4ghi 5jkl 6mno
4
7pqrs 8tuv 9wxyz
DEL 0
PAGE
bq
4
5
6
7
br
bs
bt
SKIP
5
PLAY/x1.3
6
ck
cl
GUIDE
7
8
9
cm
BACK/
RETURN
bk
bl
bm
bn
PROG/CHECK
cn
co
cp
cq
cr
bm
bn
bo
bp
bq
br
bs
bt
ck
cl
cm
cn
co
cp
cq
cr
– for switching the DIRECT NAVIGATOR screen
– for TV Guide operations
– disactivating timer programme
– for selecting programme category
– for editing favourites
[* REC]: Start recording ............................................................... (➔ 27)
[REC MODE]: Change recording mode ........................................ (➔ 64)
[EXT LINK]: Linked timer recordings with external equipment ..... (➔ 64)
[* DIRECT TV REC]: Direct TV recording .................................... (➔ 37)
Show Digital TEXT (MHEG)/Teletext service ......... (➔ 91)
Show subtitles......................................................... (➔ 91)
Transmission window
TV operations ....................................................... (➔ 108)
Channel select/Change pages in the
TV Guide system ........................................ (➔ 24, 27, 43)
Show VIERA CAST ................................................ (➔ 85)
Input select (freesat, Other Sat., AV1, AV2, AV3, AV4,
DV) ........................................................ (➔ 24, 25, 64, 65)
Skip approx. 1 minute forward ................................ (➔ 47)
Exit the menu screen
Show the TV Guide screen......................... (➔ 24, 28, 43)
Show FUNCTION MENU display ........................... (➔ 92)
By using the FUNCTION MENU display you may
access the main functions (Playback, Recording, etc.)
quickly and easily.
Return to previous screen
Skip the specified time ........................................... (➔ 47)
Create chapters ...................................................... (➔ 56)
Show timer recording list ........................................ (➔ 39)
Show menu for disc playback etc. .......................... (➔ 88)
8
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 8
2009/05/13 15:00:55
The Unit’s Display
EXT-L COPY
HDDSDVD
USBDD D
SD USB
PLAY
6 7
8
3
4
5
SD card slot indicator
Linked timer recordings with external equipment
indicator .................................................... (➔ 64)
USB port indicator
Copying indicator
Disc indicator
6
Drive (HDD, BD or SD) indicator
1
2
Quick Start Guide STEP 1
12 34 5
9
7
bk
Remote control signal indicator
This flashes when it is operated by the remote control.
8
Main display section
Current time/playback counter, various messages
9
bk
This indicator lights up when a disc is inserted.
Select “BD” for any discs. BD indicator will light up.
Playback indicator
Timer recording indicator (z) ................... (➔ 29)
On:
When a timer recording programme is registered.
Flashes:
When the unit cannot record a timer recording programme.
Main Unit
1
2
Disc tray
2
6 7 8 9 bk bl
Standby/on switch (^/I) .............................(➔ 13)
Press to switch the unit from on to standby mode
or vice versa. In standby mode, the unit is still
consuming a small amount of power.
Blue LED .............................................................. (➔ 104)
• It is possible to set the LED to turn on/off.
3
control
3 Remote
signal sensor 4
Pull to
flip down
the front
panel.
5
1
The unit’s display
Recording indicator (“REC1”, “REC2”)
Red indicator light during recording.
REC1, REC2 shows the status of one or twin
recording.
REC indication flash during Recording Pause.
(e.g., when starting Guide LINK recording)
4
5
6
7
8
9
bk
bl
bm
bm
Disc tray open/close button ..........................(➔ 26)
DV IN terminal
(for a digital video camcorder) .....................(➔ 65)
SD card slot ................................................(➔ 117)
USB port .....................................................(➔ 117)
Channel select button .............................(➔ 24, 27)
Start recording button ...................................(➔ 27)
Stop button .............................................(➔ 26, 27)
Play/✕1.3 button ...........................................(➔ 26)
AV3 input terminals.......................................(➔ 65)
Rear Panel
PR
PB
LAN
10BASE-T
100BASE-TX
AV1
(TV)
COMPONENT
DISH
IN 2
AC IN
AV2(EXT)
AV OUT
3
4
5 6
1
2
Serial number
AC IN~ = Power supply
3
4
5
Cooling fan
Satellite input terminals .....................(➔ 10, 11)
HDMI AV OUT terminal ...................(➔ 10, 112)
6
7
LAN terminal ......................................... (➔ 115)
AV1 (TV) 21-pin Scart terminal ...(➔ 10, 11, 112)
8
AV2 (EXT) 21-pin Scart terminal ...........(➔ 112)
9
TV set connection
Connection of an external unit
For information about the 21-pin Scart terminal (➔ 112)
7 8 9 bk
DIGITAL
AUDIO
OUT
COAXIAL
R-AUDIO-L VIDEO
bl
S VIDEO
OPTICAL
(PCM/BITSTREAM)
bm bn bo
COMPONENT VIDEO OUT (PROGRESSIVE/
INTERLACE) terminals .........................(➔ 113)
Y = Luminance signal (brightness), PB = Chrominance signal
(colour difference), PR = Chrominance signal (colour difference)
Connection for the AC mains lead
Digital audio and video output terminal
OUT
DISH
13V/ 18V
350mA max IN 1
AV4 IN
PR 0 0 0 0 01010
1 2
Y
VIDEO OUT
DMR-BS850EBK
SER NO.
bk
bl
bm
bn
bo
AUDIO/VIDEO output terminals ....(➔ 113, 114)
AV4 input terminals
S VIDEO output terminal .......................(➔ 113)
Digital audio output terminal (optical) ....(➔ 114)
Digital audio output terminal (coaxial).....(➔ 114)
9
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 9
2009/05/13 17:21:06
Basic Connection
This recorder requires 2 signal feeds from a satellite dish to be able to record 2 different channels at the
same time. Please consult with your Panasonic dealer for details of dish installation.
• Connect both satellite terminals (DISH IN 1 and DISH IN 2) to the satellite dish when you want to record 2
programmes simultaneously or view TV during recording.
• Connect DISH IN 1 terminal to the satellite dish when you use only one terminal. (You cannot view if you
connect only DISH IN 2 terminal.) In this case, you cannot record 2 programmes simultaneously or view TV
during recording.
• Supply power from another device when you use 2 or more devices to receive satellite broadcast, because this
unit does not supply power when it is turned in standby.
• Before connection, turn off the mains for all connected equipment and read the appropriate operating instructions.
READ THE CAUTION FOR THE AC MAINS LEAD ON PAGE 3 BEFORE CONNECTION.
When your Television has an HDMI input terminal
When connected to an HDMI compatible unit, an uncompressed digital audio and video signal is transmitted,
enabling you to enjoy high quality, digital video and audio with just one cable. When connecting to an HDMIcompatible HDTV (High Definition Television), the output can be switched to 1080p, 1080i or 720p HD video.
Regarding VIERA Link “HDAVI ControlTM” function
When connecting with a Panasonic TV (VIERA) or a receiver equipped with the “HDAVI Control” function, linked
operations would be possible. [➔ 86, Linked Operations with the TV (VIERA Link “HDAVI Control™”/Q Link)]
• Non-HDMI-compliant cables cannot be utilized.
• It is recommended that you use Panasonic’s HDMI cable.
Recommended part number: RP-CDHG10 (1.0 m), RP-CDHG15 (1.5 m), RP-CDHG20 (2.0 m), RP-CDHG30 (3.0
m), RP-CDHG50 (5.0 m), etc.
A When your television does not have a digital satellite tuner
TV
HDMI IN
Connecting with a
Panasonic TV (VIERA)
AV
If the 21-pin Scart cable is
connected, the Direct TV
Recording and Pause Live
TV function is available.
(➔ 37)
DISH IN 1
To household
mains socket
DISH IN 2
AC IN
HDMI
AV OUT
AV1 (TV)
This unit
HDMI cable (not supplied)
21-pin Scart cable (not supplied)
10
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 10
2009/05/13 15:00:55
B When your television has a digital satellite tuner
Satellite
HDMI IN
Quick Start Guide STEP 2
TV
Connecting with a
Panasonic TV (VIERA)
AV
If the 21-pin Scart cable is
connected, the Direct TV
Recording and Pause Live
TV function is available when
you view other than satellite
programme. (➔ 37)
DISH IN 1
To household
mains socket
DISH IN 2
AC IN
HDMI
AV OUT
AV1 (TV)
This unit
HDMI cable (not supplied)
21-pin Scart cable (not supplied)
Connect only after all other connections are complete.
After completing the connections, proceed to the TV Tuning (➔ 13).
• Refer to page 120 if “U50”, “U50 1” or “U50 2” appears on the unit’s display.
HDMI features
•
•
•
•
Please use High Speed HDMI Cables that have the HDMI logo (as shown on the cover).
When outputting 1080p signal, please use the HDMI cables 5.0 meters or less.
Set “HDMI Video Mode” and “HDMI Audio Output” to “On” (➔ 105). (The default setting is “On”.)
This unit incorporates HDMI™ (V.1.3a with Deep Colour, x.v. Colour™, High Bit rate Audio) technology
(➔ 138, 139).
• Video sources converted to 1920 × 1080 resolution, while of high quality, will exhibit somewhat lower subjective
image resolution than true, native 1080p full-HD sources. See dealer for details.
Notes
• The freesat channel uses Astra 2 at 28.2° East, and Eurobird 1 at 28.5° East satellites. To ensure your satellite
dish is correctly installed please consult your freesat registered dealer.
• If you connect 2 satellite dishes for different satellites (e.g., DISH IN 1: Astra 28.2, DISH IN 2: Astra 19.2), the unit
cannot receive the signal correctly.
• You can use the unit as one tuner when connecting DISH IN 1 to a satellite dish that can receive SKY.
• If connecting to equipment that is only compatible with 2 channel audio output, audio with 3 channels or more will
be down-mixed (➔ 138) and output as 2 channels, even if connecting with an HDMI cable (some discs cannot be
down-mixed).
• For display units compatible with HDCP (High-Band width Digital Content Protection) that are equipped with a
digital DVI input terminal (PC monitors, etc.):
Depending on the unit, picture may not display properly or at all when connecting with a DVI/HDMI switching cable
(audio cannot be output).
• If you connect a DVI device that is not compatible with HDCP, set “HDCP on HDMI Output” in the Setup menu to
“Off” (➔ 105).
Tips
You can check the satellite signal condition using “Signal Condition” in the Setup menu (➔ 98).
When the unit is not to be used for a long time
To save power, unplug it from the household mains socket. This unit consumes a small amount of power,
even when it is turned in standby.
[approx. 0.4 W (“Power Save” is set to “On”)]
11
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 11
2009/05/13 15:00:56
Basic Connection
When your Television does not have an HDMI input terminal
In this setting, you cannot enjoy HDTV in HD picture quality. The resolution will be 576i/480i.
TV
AV
DISH IN 1
To household
mains socket
DISH IN 2
AC IN
AV1 (TV)
This unit
21-pin Scart cable (not supplied)
Connect only after all other connections are complete.
After completing the connections, proceed to the TV Tuning (➔ 13).
• Refer to page 120 if “U50”, “U50-1” or “U50-2” appears on the unit’s display.
Notes
• The freesat channel uses Astra 2 at 28.2° East, and Eurobird 1 at 28.5° East satellites. To ensure your satellite
dish is correctly installed please consult your freesat registered dealer.
• If you connect 2 satellite dishes for different satellites (e.g., DISH IN 1: Astra 28.2, DISH IN 2: Astra 19.2), the unit
cannot receive the signal correctly.
• You can use the unit as one tuner when connecting DISH IN 1 to a satellite dish that can receive SKY.
Tips
• You can check the satellite signal condition using “Signal Condition” in the Setup menu (➔ 98).
• Additional Connections (➔ 112).
12
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 12
2009/05/13 15:00:56
Search and store TV programmes automatically.
These steps are not necessary if the setup has been completed by your local
dealer or freesat registered dealer.
Quick Start Guide STEP 3
Auto Set Up (freesat)
TV
Preparation:
• Turn on the television (and connected equipment)
and select the video input terminal that this unit is
connected to.
VOL
DRIVE
SELECT
CH
AV
2abc 3def
1
4ghi 5jkl 6mno
TV’s remote control
PAGE
CH
7qrs 8tuv 9wxyz
p
to turn the unit on.
0
DEL
SKIP
SLOW/SEARCH
freesat Auto Setup
Searching
DISH Input 1-Signal Quality
0
DISH Input 1-Signal Strength
0
DISH Input 2-Signal Quality
0
DISH Input 2-Signal Strength
0
TV Channels Found
0
Radio Channels Found
0
Data Channels Found
0
Channels found, creating channel list
10
10
10
10
STOP
PAUSE
PLAY/x1.3
EXIT
STATUS
Exit freesat setup
The bar appears beside
Signal Quality and Signal
Strength when the signal
is input.
DIR ECT NAVIGATO
R
GUIDE
Enter Postcode for local channels including space
Postcode
A B C D E F G H I
U V W X Y Z
0 1
J K L M N O P Q R S T
2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
OK
Select
BACK/
RETURN
Set character
Select
RETURN
Delete
Enter your Postcode.
Press [e, r,w, q] to
select the character, then
press [OK].
Repeat step
Confirm
REC
Please enter new PIN
PIN
.
– This PIN will be used only for the Owner ID-Data Entry screen.
7qrs 8tuv 9wxyz
p
0
REC MODE EXT LINK DIRECT TV REC
* * * *
0 - 9 PIN entry
RETURN
Press the numbered buttons to enter your choice
of a 4-digit PIN.
4ghi 5jkl 6mno
TIME SLIP CHAPTER
Owner ID
– Your postcode is required to receive local services and sort the channel order.
2abc 3def
CREATE
You now have the opportunity to enter your
details and help the police to crack crime.
See Instruction Book.
Press the “Green” button to confirm.
1
OPTION
Delete all
CTION MENU
FUN
Auto Setup will start to search for TV
programmes and store them in the
numbered order as specified by the
broadcasters.
– Check signal quality/strength
displayed on the screen (➔ right).
If the signal is weak, Auto Setup
will not start. Check that the
satellite dish is correctly positioned
and connected.
MANUAL SKIP
INPUT
SELECT
You now have the opportunity to enter your
details and help the police to crack crime.
See Instruction Book.
Owner ID
Please enter new PIN again to confirm
PIN
* * * *
0 - 9 PIN entry
RETURN
(continued on the next page)
Tips
To cancel the Auto Setup
Press [BACK/RETURN ].
To restart the Auto Setup (➔ 98, freesat
Auto Setup)
To correct the character
Press the “Red” button to delete character
one by one.
You can delete all input characters by
pressing the “Blue” button.
You can perform this operation in step ,
or .
Notes
• To initialise all settings (➔ 107, Shipping
Condition)
• When the below screen appears after
step .
freesat Auto Setup
No satellite signals detected at dish 2 input.
Please check dish installation / connection before starting search,
otherwise record / playback functions will be limited.
Select
Set character
Select
RETURN
This screen appears when this unit does not
detect the connection to DISH IN 2.
When you connect DISH IN 1 only press
[OK], then go to step .
When you connect both DISH IN 1 and 2,
turn this unit off and check your
connection. Then perform from step .
• The Auto Setup may require a certain
length of time.
13
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 13
2009/05/13 15:00:56
Auto Set Up (freesat)
Repeat step
to enter PIN
again to confirm.
8
– This PIN will be used for controlling
• BD-Video playback
• DVD-Video playback
• Accessing to the channels you selected in “Child
Lock” (➔ 99)
• Playback programmes for adults
• Using VIERA CAST
Owner ID-Data Entry
PIN
NAME
HOUSE NO
POSTCODE
Enter new PIN.
0000
RG12 8FP
Select
Change PIN
RETURN
– Make a note of PIN in case you forget it.
– The default PIN is “0000”.
– The Owner ID-Data Entry screen appears.
– Make a note of PIN in case you forget it.
Press [e, r] to select the number, then press [q].
Enter your NAME.
– You can also use the numbered buttons.
Press [e, r] to select “NAME”, then press [OK].
Repeat step
for enter 4-digit PIN.
User input
Press [OK] to confirm.
NAME
A
U
a
u
B
V
b
v
C
W
c
w
D
X
d
x
E F G H I J K L M N O P Q R S T
Y Z
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 ! : #
e f g h i j k l m n o p q r s t
y z ( ) + - . * _
PIN Entry
Remember the PIN.
Select
Set character
Select
RETURN
Delete
Delete all
0
0
Press [e, r,w, q] to select the character, then
press [OK].
Repeat step
.
0
0
OK
9
Press [BACK/RETURN ] to return to the
Owner ID-Data Entry screen.
Enter your HOUSE NO.
Press [e, r] to select “HOUSE NO”, then press
[OK].
Power Save Function: e, r to
select “On” or “Off”, then
Power Save
On
User input
Off
HOUSE NO
A
U
a
u
B
V
b
v
C
W
c
w
D
X
d
x
On : Minimise standby power consumption,
without Quick Start function and
AV2 loop-through in standby.
E F G H I J K L M N O P Q R S T
Y Z
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 ! : #
e f g h i j k l m n o p q r s t
y z ( ) + - . * _
Off : With Quick Start function
and AV2 loop-through in standby.
Select
Set character
Select
RETURN
Delete
OK
Delete all
RETURN
Press [e, r,w, q] to select the character, then
press [OK].
Repeat step
.
Press [BACK/RETURN ] to return to the
Owner ID-Data Entry screen.
Owner ID-Data Entry
PIN
NAME
HOUSE NO
POSTCODE
0000
EEEE
ABC
RG12 8FP
– Set to “On” to reduce power consumption in
standby mode.
The features of the power save function when
the unit is in standby mode are as below.
Power Save
Power
consumption
Startup time
Select
Edit
Front display
RETURN
BACK/
RETURN
to confirm the Owner IDData Entry screen.
PIN Entry
Enter a new 4-digit PIN, then press OK.
This PIN will be used for controlling viewing and playback.
PIN will be set to “0000” by pressing “RETURN” when there is no
number input.
-
RETURN
-
-
Number
-
0 - 9
Watching the
picture from
the external
equipment
connected to the
AV2 terminal
On
Off
Approx. 0.4 W
Approx. 12 W
Not quick
Turns off
(The clock is not
displayed.)
Quick
cannot do
Stays lighted
can do
• Auto setup for your unit is complete. You can now make your
favourite channels and store them in the required order in the
favourites (➔ 97).
14
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 14
2009/05/13 15:00:57
To tune in other satellite channels
(➔ 16, Tuning in Other Satellite
Services)
To hide unwanted channels
(➔ 98, freesat Channel List)
To change PIN (➔ 107, Owner ID)
To correct the character
Press the “Red” button to delete character one by one.
You can delete all input characters by pressing the “Blue” button.
You can perform this operation in step ,
or .
To display the Owner ID information on TV
Press and hold [g] on the main unit for more than 5 seconds.
The PIN is not displayed.
After 30 seconds this menu automatically disappears.
You cannot change the Owner ID on this screen.
You can perform this operation after step .
To set the clock manually
Quick Start Guide STEP 3
To check the signal condition
(➔ 98, Signal Condition)
Normally this unit obtains time and date information from TV
channels to set its clock and automatically adjusts the time
several times a day.
If the clock is incorrect or cannot be automatically set, perhaps
due to bad signal reception, you will need to adjust the clock
manually.
• In the case of a power failure, the clock setting remains in
memory for approximately 60 minutes.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
Press [FUNCTION MENU].
Press [e, r] to select “Others”, then press [OK].
Press [e, r] to select “Setup”, then press [OK].
Press [e, r] to select “Others”, then press [OK].
Press [e, r] to select “Clock”, then press [OK].
Press [w, q] to select “Off” of “Auto Clock
Setting”.
7. Press [e, r] to select “Manual Setting”, then
press [OK].
8. Press [w, q] to select the item you want to
change.
Hour
Minute
Second
Day
Month
Year
9. Press [e, r] to change the setting.
10.Press [OK] to confirm new date and time and to
initiate the clock.
Tips
To return to the previous screen
Press [BACK/RETURN ].
To exit the screen
Press [EXIT].
Notes
If a TV station transmits a time setting signal, and when “Auto Clock
Setting” in the Clock setting menu is set to “On”, the automatic time
correction function checks the time and if necessary it is adjusted
several times every day.
15
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 15
2009/05/13 15:00:57
Tuning in Other Satellite Services
You can also view or record other free channels (Astra 2 at 28.5 degree east) or free channels from other satellites
that you can receive in your area.
This setup is not required if you are only viewing or recording from freesat channels.
Search and store TV programmes of the other satellite service automatically.
These steps are not necessary if the setup has been completed by your local
dealer or freesat registered dealer.
TV
VOL
DRIVE
SELECT
to turn the unit on.
CH
AV
2abc 3def
1
4ghi 5jkl 6mno
PAGE
CH
7qrs 8tuv 9wxyz
p
e, r to select “Others”, then
Tuning
freesat Favourites Edit
freesat Channel List
freesat Auto Setup
Other Satellite Channel List
Other Satellite Tuning Menu
Signal Condition
Child Lock
Preferred Multi Audio
Preferred Subtitles
STOP
MANUAL SKIP
INPUT
SELECT
SKIP
e, r to select “Setup”, then
e, r to select “Tuning”, then
0
DEL
SLOW/SEARCH
PAUSE
PLAY/x1.3
EXIT
STATUS
Access
GUIDE
OK
DIR ECT NAVIGATO
R
e, r to select “Other Satellite
Tuning Menu”, then
Other Satellite Tuning Menu
Auto Setup
Manual Tuning
Dish Setup
Access
OK
BACK/
RETURN
OPTION
CREATE
OK
TIME SLIP CHAPTER
RETURN
e, r to select “Auto Setup”,
then
Other Satellite Auto Setup - Satellite Selection
Satellite Selection
Search Mode
Channel Type
CTION MENU
FUN
RETURN
REC
Astra2/Eurobird
All
All
TEXT
freesat and other satellite channels
REC MODE EXT LINK DIRECT TV REC
STTL
DISPLAY PROG/CHECK
Tips
Select
Start
Change
RETURN
8 w, q to select the desired satellite.
– You can select from a list of following satellites.
• Astra2/Eurobird
• Astra1 (The dish will need to be repositioned to receive from these satellites.)
• Hotbird (The dish will need to be repositioned to receive from these satellites.)
• All (Any satellites that the dish can pick up from its current position.)
To tune to other satellites manually (➔ 98)
To cancel the Auto Setup
Press [EXIT].
Notes
• To initialise all settings (➔ 107, Shipping
Condition)
9 r to select “Search Mode”.
w, q to select the search mode.
– You can select the search mode from the followings.
• All : All channels including encrypted channels will be searched.
• Free channels
r to select “Channel Type”.
16
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 16
2009/05/13 15:00:57
w, q to select the channel type.
– You can select the channel type from the followings.
• All : All channels including TV, Radio, Data, etc. will be searched.
• TV
• Radio
to start the Auto
Setup
Other Satellite Auto Setup - Satellite Selection
Astra2/Eurobird
All
All
Satellite Selection
Search Mode
Channel Type
• When the below screen appears after
step .
freesat and other satellite channels
DISH Input 1 - Signal Quality 0
DISH Input 1 - Signal Strength 0
DISH Input 1 - Signal Lock Locked
DISH Input 2 - Signal Quality 0
DISH Input 2 - Signal Strength 0
DISH Input 2 - Signal Lock Locked
10
10
– Go to step when you
10
10
select “All” in step 8 .
– It takes time. Please follow the
instruction on the screen.
– This unit is checking signals
The bar appears beside Signal Quality
during displaying “Please wait”. and Signal Strength when the signal is
“Locked” appears when the
input.
checking is finished. Both DISH
IN 1 and 2 are checking the signals when both terminals are
connected.
• If “Locked” does not appears, the signal is weak, and Auto Setup
will not start. Check that the satellite dish is correctly positioned
and corrected.
Continue
RETURN
to continue the
to start the scan.
Other satellite Auto Setup
No satellite signals detected at dish 2 input.
Please check dish installation / connection before starting search,
otherwise record / playback function will be limited.
Select
Set character
Select
RETURN
This screen appears when this unit does
not detect the connection to DISH IN 2.
When you connect DISH IN 1 only press
[OK], then go to step
or .
When you connect both DISH IN 1 and
2, turn this unit off and check your
connection. Then perform from step .
• Auto Setup can take up to 45 minutes.
Other Satellite Auto Setup
Auto Setup.
– Ensure that signals to both DISH
IN 1 and 2 are locked before
starting scan.
Notes
All other satellite tuning data will be erased.
Continue
RETURN
Other Satellite Auto Setup - Satellite Scan
Satellite Scan
0
100%
Please wait... This may take up to 45 minutes to complete.
– The scan starts.
Free TV Channels found
Free Radio Channels found
Data Channels found
Pay TV Channels found
0
0
0
0
RETURN
Delete unwanted
channels.
Other Satellite Auto Setup - Select Channels to Remove
1/19
All Channels
Type
Name
BBC R5L
Radio
ETV2
Free TV
BBC 1 Wales
Free TV
Keep
Free TV
BBC 2 Wales
– To delete all channels of each
BBC 1 Scotland
Free TV
type on the screen (other than
BBC 2 Scotland
Free TV
Kept Channels:
111
Free TV), press the “Red”
Available Space: 2888
button. And then press [e, r]
Found Channels: 111
Multiple delete
Channel type
to select the channel type you
want to delete, press [OK].
– To remove the selected channel, press [e, r] to select the channel
you want to remove, press [OK]. The check mark is removed.
Select
Remove
RETURN
BACK/
RETURN
to confirm deletion.
Page Up
Page Down
CH
Tips
To select the type
Press the “Blue” button in step .
Each time you press the “Blue” button, the
type will be changed as follows.
All Channels ➔ Free TV ➔ Pay TV ➔
Radio ➔ Data ➔ Unknown ➔
All Channels ➔ …
To restore all channels
Press the “Red” button, and then press
[e, r] to select “Restore all channels”,
press [OK] in step .
To restore the channel
Press [e, r] to select the channel you
want to restore, press [OK] in step .
The check mark is displayed.
17
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 17
2009/05/13 15:00:58
HDD and Disc Information
This unit can record to HDD and copy to the following recording media.
Internal
DVD-RAM
BD-RE
HDD
+R
BD-R
DVD-R
DVD-R DL DVD-RW
+R DL
+RW
Recordings can only be made to HDD in DR mode first, with the same quality as broadcasted, then they can be copied to discs.
Instant record
It can only record to HDD by pressing [* REC].
Discs
HDD
REC
Record to the HDD and
then copy to the disc.
Can do
Cannot do
Timer record
It can only record to HDD when using timer recording.
All Types
Time: 14:00
14:30
108 BBC HD
BBC HD Preview
113 ITV2
Red Cap
Red Cap
114 ITV2+1
115 ITV3
116 ITV3+1
117 ITV4
120 Channel4
15:00
Love USA
News Show
100 Sheep Dream
Heartbeat
UFO
Behind me
Select Channel
OK
Select Programme
RETURN
Red Cap
Black House
Crowntown
Deal
Page Up
Page Down
Portrait/Landscape
+24 hours
16:00
Record to the HDD and
then copy to the disc.
News Show
USO
Blue Wave Great A
In the
100 Sheep Dream
Hot Wave
Used Car
Info
GUIDE
All Channels
15:30
Discs
HDD
WED 19/08/2009 13:30
TV Guide: Landscape
WED 19th
12:00-20:00 HD BBC HD Preview
Prog. Type
Can do
Cannot do
CH
Channel Genre
Regarding Blu-ray Disc
High capacity
The Blu-ray Disc (BD-RE and BD-R) has a lot more capacity compared with the DVD.
When you compare the Blu-ray Disc (single-side dual-layer 50 GB) with the DVD-R (4.7 GB)
DVD-R (4.7 GB)
Blu-ray Disc (50 GB:single-side dual-layer )
About 10 DVD-Rs
When a 2 hour movie is recorded (in SP mode)
About 1 movie (per 1 DVD disc)
About 10 movies
High quality
You can copy the image of the digital broadcasting to Blu-ray discs in the same quality as broadcasted. Therefore, high
definition quality image can be copied as it is.
Blu-ray Disc
Broadcasted images can be copied as they are
(When copied in DR mode)
DVD-R, etc.
Broadcasted images cannot be copied as they are
18
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 18
2009/05/13 15:00:58
Recording and copying programmes
This unit can record standard or high definition programmes from its built-in satellite tuners onto HDD with the same
quality picture and sound as they are broadcasted. Contents that can be recorded or copied will depend on the copy
management signals being sent by broadcasters. (➔ below)
Goal!
Recording
HDD
Goal!
DR mode
All subtitles and multi audio are recorded (selectable during playback).
All recordings are first made to HDD in DR mode only.
COPY
Copy as they are broadcasted
BD-RE
BD-R
When copying titles to disc
Quality and speed of copy depends on the type of
disc being used.
Copy in high definition for
long recording time1
Copy in standard definition
BD-RE
BD-R
Other discs
Goal!
DR mode
All subtitles and multiple audio are
copied.
Copy as high definition (HD) quality
(the same quality as broadcast)
Copy in High Speed mode
HG, HX, HE, HL mode1
Only one subtitle and one audio can
be copied.2
Copy as high definition (HD) quality
with compressed high definition data
Copy in Normal Speed mode when copying
the title recorded in DR mode on HDD
XP, SP, LP, EP, FR mode
Only one subtitleand one audio can
be copied.2
Copy as standard definition (SD) quality.
Copy in Normal Speed mode.
1
Data size of the copied title may be larger than the original title, depending on the transfer rate.
It is recommended to use HE or HL mode when you record high definition and long programmes.
2
You cannot switch the subtitle or audio description on or off during playback of the copied title.
Notes
• Some programmes are copy-restricted and the number of times you can copy in HD quality is assigned by the broadcaster.
(➔ 33, Copy-restriction on freesat programmes)
• Teletext and Digital TEXT (MHEG) cannot be recorded.
19
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 19
2009/05/13 15:00:59
HDD and Disc Handling
HDD and discs you can use for recording and play
( : Possible, –: Impossible)
Disc type
Hard disk drive (HDD)
Standard symbol
HDD
Data that can be recorded and played
Quality in which video is recorded
Video/Still picture/Music
High definition (HD) quality/Standard definition (SD) quality
Recording mode in which video is recorded
DR, HG, HX, HE, HL, XP, SP, LP, EP, FR
Rewritable
Timer recording
Recording “HD Copy Once” programmes (➔ 33)
Recording “HD No Copy” programmes (➔ 33)
Disc type
Standard symbol
Data that can be recorded and played
Quality in which video is recorded
Recording mode in which video is recorded
BD-RE
BD-R
(50 GB/25 GB)
(50 GB/25 GB)
BD-RE
BD-R
Video/Still picture
Video
High definition (HD) quality/Standard definition (SD) quality
DR, HG, HX, HE, HL, XP, SP, LP, EP, FR
Rewritable
–
Timer recording
Copying “HD Copy Once” titles (➔ 33)
–
Copy in high definition quality (DR, HG, HX, HE, HL) is possible only once.
Copying “HD No Copy” titles (➔ 33)
Copy in standard definition quality (XP, SP, LP, EP, FR mode) is possible.
Play on other players
Note
It can be played on the players compatible to BD-RE (Ver. 2.1) and BD-R.
BD-RE and BD-R that were recorded on this unit may not be played on other Blu-ray
players, etc.
Playback of LTH type BD-R discs may not be possible with players that do not support the
LTH type format.
Single-side dual-layer (50 GB) disc can only be played on the compatible player.
DL is also included.
“DL” is a single-side dual-layer disc.
BD-RE (Ver. 1.0) with a cartridge cannot
be used with this unit. (It cannot be used
even if it is taken out from the cartridge)
Use the BD-RE compliant to Blu-ray Disc
Rewritable Format Version 2.1.
DL is also included.
“DL” is a single-side dual-layer disc.
LTH type is also included.
For BD-R finalised with this unit or other
equipment, only playback is possible on
this unit. (➔ 96, 138)
Recording modes that can be selected differ depending on the recording methods. For details, please refer to the respective operating.
20
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 20
2009/05/13 15:00:59
Disc type
DVD-RAM
DVD-R
DVD-R DL
DVD-RW
Standard symbol
RAM
-R before finalisation
DVD-V after finalisation
-R DL before
finalisation
DVD-V after finalisation
-RW(V) before
finalisation
DVD-V after finalisation
Data that can be recorded and
played
Video
Still picture
Video
Quality in which video is recorded
Standard definition (SD) quality
Recording mode in which video is
recorded
XP, SP, LP, EP, FR
Rewritable
–
Timer recording
–
Copying “HD Copy Once” titles (➔ 33)
Copy in standard definition quality (XP, SP, LP, EP, FR mode) is possible.
Copying “HD No Copy” titles (➔ 33)
Copy in standard definition quality (XP, SP, LP, EP, FR mode) is possible.
Play on other players
RAM can be played
back on Panasonic
DVD recorders and
DVD-RAM compatible
DVD players.
Note
Take the disc out from
the cartridge to use the
DVD-RAM with a
cartridge. (TYPE1
cannot be used)
Disc type
Standard symbol
Finalisation is needed for playback on other equipment.
-R DL can be played back only on equipment compatible with this disc.
–
+R
+R before finalisation
DVD-V after finalisation
+R DL
DVD-V
Data that can be recorded and played
+R DL
+RW
before finalisation
after finalisation
+RW
Video
Quality in which video is recorded
Standard definition (SD) quality
Recording mode in which video is
recorded
XP, SP, LP, EP, FR
Rewritable
Timer recording
–
–
Copying “HD Copy Once” titles (➔ 33)
Copy in standard definition quality (XP, SP, LP, EP, FR mode) is possible.
Copying “HD No Copy” titles (➔ 33)
Copy in standard definition quality (XP, SP, LP, EP, FR mode) is possible.
Play on other players
Finalisation is needed for playback on other equipment.
+R DL can be played back only on equipment compatible with
this disc.
+RW can be played back only
on equipment compatible with
this disc.
If the disc failed to play on other
equipment, we recommend you
create top menu (➔ 96).
Note
+R +R DL These discs recorded with this unit or with another Panasonic DVD Recorder may be
incompatible. However, discs that are finalised are compatible and can be played.
8X Speed +RW disc is not supported.
Notes
Discs recorded on equipment other than this unit may not be used for recording on this unit.
This unit cannot record NTSC signals to discs that already have PAL signal recordings. (However, both types of programmes can be recorded
onto the HDD, BD-RE or BD-R.)
You may not be able to record depending on the condition of the discs and you may not be able to play due to the condition of the recording.
■ Regarding 8 cm Disc
This unit cannot record or edit the 8 cm BD-RE, BD-R, DVD-RAM, DVD-R, DVD-R DL, DVD-RW, +R DL or +RW.
Only playback or copy to the HDD is possible.
21
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 21
2009/05/13 15:00:59
HDD and Disc Handling
Play-only discs
Disc type
Logo
Standard
symbol
Uses
High Definition (HD) movie and music discs
This unit can playback BONUSVIEW™ or BD-Live compatible discs.
(➔ 49)
BD-Video
BD-V
When playing a set of two or more BD-Video discs, the menu screen
may continue to display even if the disc has been ejected.
To enjoy High Bit rate Audio and Video (➔ 50)
Operation of this unit may become slower when the BD-J application
(➔ 138) is executing. This is not malfunction.
DVD-Video
DVD-V
DVD-RW
(DVD Video
Recording
format)
-RW(VR)
DVD-R
DVD-R DL
DivX, MP3,
JPEG
CD
CD
–
Disc
with high
definition
video
(AVCHD)
recorded by
Panasonic’s
video
camera, etc.
–
DivX, MP3,
JPEG
AVCHD
High quality movie and music discs
DVD-RW video recorded on another DVD recorder
• By formatting (➔ 95) the disc, you can copy onto it in DVD-Video
format.
• It may be necessary to finalise the disc on the equipment used for
recording.
• DVD-R and DVD-R DL with video recorded in DivX (➔ 51)
• DVD-R and DVD-R DL with music recorded in MP3 (➔ 77)
• DVD-R and DVD-R DL with still pictures recorded in JPEG (➔ 70)
• Recorded audio and music (including CD-R/RW )
You can copy tracks to this unit’s HDD.
• CD-R and CD-RW with video recorded in DivX (➔ 51)
• CD-R and CD-RW with music recorded in MP3 (➔ 77)
• CD-R and CD-RW with still pictures recorded in JPEG (➔ 70)
Following disc can be played.
BD-RE, BD-R, DVD-RAM, DVD-R, DVD-R DL, DVD-RW, +R, +R DL,
+RW
Finalise (➔ 138) the DVD-R, DVD-R DL, DVD-RW, +R or +R DL with
the same equipment that was used to record.
Set “Play Video (AVCHD) on BD-RE/BD-R” to “On” for the disc that
has high definition video (AVCHD) recorded by Panasonic’s video
camera, etc. and other video format such as those recorded on this
unit. (➔ 100)
Close the session after recording. Play may be impossible on some discs due to the condition of the recording.
• Operation and sound quality of CDs that do not conform to CD-DA specifications (copy control CDs, etc.) cannot be guaranteed.
• The producer of the disc can control how discs are played. So you may not always be able to control play as described in these operating
instructions. Read the disc’s instructions carefully.
Discs that cannot be played
• BD-RE (Ver.1.0)
• DVD-RAM that cannot be removed from their
cartridges
• 2.6/5.2 GB DVD-RAM, 12 cm
• 3.95/4.7 GB DVD-R for Authoring
• DVD-R, DVD-R DL, DVD-RW, +R, +R DL recorded
on another unit and not finalised (➔ 138)
• BD-Video with a region code other than “B”
• DVD-Video with a region number other than “2” or
“ALL”
• DVD-Audio
• HD DVD
• DVD-ROM, +R 8 cm, CD-ROM, CDV, CD-G, Photo
CD, CVD, SVCD, SACD, MV-Disc, PD, Video CD, etc.
Types of disc for the type of
connected TV
When you use the discs recorded either PAL or NTSC, or playback a
title recorded on HDD using PAL or NTSC, refer to this table.
( : Possible to view, −: Impossible to view)
TV type
Multi-system TV
PAL TV
NTSC TV
Disc/Titles
recorded on HDD
PAL
NTSC
PAL
NTSC
PAL
NTSC
Yes/No
1
(PAL60)
−
2
1
Select “PAL60” in “NTSC Video Output” (➔ 102).
If your television is not equipped to handle PAL 525/60 signals the
picture will not be shown correctly.
2 Select “NTSC” in “TV System” (➔ 104).
• When playing back a disc or title recorded on the HDD, ensure
that you match the “TV System” setting to the disc or title (PAL or
NTSC) (➔ 104).
22
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 22
2009/05/13 15:00:59
USB Memory and Card Handling
USB memories you can use on this unit
USB memories can only be used for playback or copy to HDD or discs.
USB memories which are defined as USB mass storage class, and digital cameras that use PTP protocol:
– USB memories that support USB 1.0/1.1 and USB 2.0 Full Speed/High Speed.
• USB memories of up to 128 GB can be used.
• USB memories that support bulk only transfer.
Compatible USB memories
CBI (Control/Bulk/Interrupt) is not supported.
• Digital Cameras which require additional programme installation when connected to a PC are not supported.
• MTP (Media Transport Protocol) device is not supported.
• A multi-port USB card reader is not supported.
FAT16 and FAT32 file systems are supported.
• UDF/NTFS/exFAT file system is not supported.
Format
• Depending on the sector size, some files may not work.
• Only the first partition on USB memories with multi-partition is supported.
Standard symbol
USB
Data that can be played
DivX, MP3, Still pictures (JPEG)
MP3
• It can be copied to HDD.
Still pictures (JPEG)
• It can be copied to HDD, BD-RE or DVD-RAM.
Data that can be copied
SD Video (MPEG2 format)
HD Video (AVCHD format)
• If a Panasonic’s video camera, etc. with HDD is connected to this unit’s USB port:
– you can copy the SD Video shot with the camera to this unit’s HDD or DVD-RAM. (➔ 69)
– you can copy the HD Video shot with the camera to this unit’s HDD, BD-RE or BD-R. (➔ 68)
• Despite meeting the conditions mentioned above, there may be USB memories that cannot be used for this unit.
Notes
• This unit’s USB port does not support bus-powered USB device.
Cards usable on this unit
SD cards can be used for playback, copy to HDD or discs or copy from HDD or discs.
Type
Standard symbol
Data that can be
played
Data that can be
copied
Instructions
• SD Memory Card 1 (from 8 MB to 2 GB)
• SDHC Memory Card 2 (from 4 GB to 32 GB)
1
Including miniSD Card and microSD Card
2
Including miniSDHC Card and microSDHC Card
The card types mentioned above will be referred to as “SD card” in these operating instructions.
SD
Still pictures (JPEG)
HD Video (AVCHD format)
Still pictures (JPEG)
• It can be copied to/from HDD, BD-RE or DVD-RAM.
SD Video (MPEG2 format)
HD Video (AVCHD format)
• SD Video shot with a Panasonic’s video camera, etc. can be copied to the HDD or DVD-RAM. (➔ 69)
• HD Video shot with a Panasonic’s video camera, etc. can be copied to the HDD, BD-RE or BD-R. (➔ 68)
You can insert directly into the SD card slot.
1
A miniSD Card and a microSD Card must be used with the adaptor that comes with the card.
2
A miniSDHC Card and microSDHC Card must be used with the adaptor that comes with the card.
Suitable SD cards
• When using SD cards 4 GB or larger, only SD cards that display the SDHC logo can be used.
• Usable memory is slightly less than the card capacity.
• Please confirm the latest information on the following website.
http://panasonic.co.jp/pavc/global/cs (This site is in English only.)
• If the SD card is formatted on other equipment, the time necessary for recording may be longer. Also, if the SD card is formatted on a PC,
you may not be able to use it on this unit. In these cases, format the card on this unit (➔ 95, 138).
• This unit is compatible with SD Memory Cards that meet SD Card Specifications FAT12 and FAT16 formats, as well as SDHC Memory
Cards in FAT32 format.
• SDHC Memory Cards used for recording with this unit can only be used with other SDHC Memory Card-compatible equipment. SDHC
Memory Cards cannot be used with equipment that is only compatible with SD Memory Cards.
• We recommend using a Panasonic SD card.
• Keep the SD Card out of reach of children to prevent swallowing.
■ Setting the protection
LOCK
Switch the write-protect switch to the “LOCK” position.
23
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 23
2009/05/13 15:01:00
Watching Television (freesat)
Selecting a channel with TV Guide
Refer to “TV Guide system (freesat)” (➔ 43) for detailed information.
This unit can receive and record digital satellite channels.
TV
Preparation:
Turn on the television and select the video input terminal that this unit is
connected to.
Important:
This unit has only digital satellite tuners.
VOL
DRIVE
SELECT
CH
AV
2abc 3def
1
4ghi 5jkl 6mno
PAGE
CH
7qrs 8tuv 9wxyz
p
to turn the unit on.
0
DEL
SKIP
a few times and select “freesat”, then
MANUAL SKIP
INPUT
SELECT
SLOW/SEARCH
Channel Genre Selection
STOP
Regional
Favourites
– The TV Guide list appears.
114 ITV2+1
115 ITV3
116 ITV3+1
117 ITV4
120 Channel4
All Types
15:00
Love USA
News Show
100 Sheep Dream
Heartbeat
UFO
Behind me
Black House
GUIDE
Crowntown
Millions
4000 FilmFour
Movie
WED 19/08/2009
13:00 - 15:10
OK
BACK/
RETURN
OPTION
CREATE
TIME SLIP CHAPTER
Deal
Page Up
Page Down
Prog. Type
OK
16:00
Red Cap
News Show
USO
Blue Wave Great A
In the
100 Sheep Dream
Hot Wave
Used Car
Portrait/Landscape
Selection Screen
All Channels
15:30
Info
+24 hours
e, r to select current
programme, then
WED 19/08/2009 13:30
TV Guide: Landscape
WED 19th
12:00-20:00 HD BBC HD Preview
Select Channel
OK
Select Programme
RETURN
EXIT
CTION MENU
FUN
RETURN
Time: 14:00
14:30
108 BBC HD
BBC HD Preview
113 ITV2
Red Cap
Red Cap
PLAY/x1.3
GUIDE
OK
e, r, w, q to select the
desired genre, then
PAUSE
STATUS
DIR ECT NAVIGATO
R
– The Channel Genre Selection
screen appears.
All Channels
Entertainment
News & Sport
Movies
Lifestyle
Music
Children
Special Interest
Radio
Shopping
Gaming & Dating
CH
Channel Genre
WED 19/08/2009 13:30
View
Single Timer Rec.
Series Timer Rec.
Delete
Tips
To show Digital TEXT (MHEG) and
subtitles (➔ 91)
To select or change Multi Audio/AD
(➔ 90, Multi Audio/AD)
To register the channel to “Favourites”
(➔ 97)
RETURN
e, r to select “View”, then
Notes
• The TV Guide list is not displayed
immediately after initial tuning is done.
• Channel number is indicated on the
unit’s display as an example, “FS151”.
Selecting a channel without using TV Guide
To select desired channel
Press [1, 2 CH].
To directly enter channels
You can also select channels with the numbered buttons.
e. g., “151”: [1] ➔ [5] ➔ [1]
“504”: [5] ➔ [0] ➔ [4]
24
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 24
2009/05/13 15:01:00
Watching Television of the Other Satellite Service
To view or record free channels from other satellite services.
There are no programme guides for these channels. Only the channel list is
available.
Selecting a channel with the channel list
TV
This unit can receive and record digital satellite channels.
VOL
DRIVE
SELECT
Preparation:
Turn on the television and select the video input terminal that this unit is
connected to.
Important:
This unit has only digital satellite tuners.
CH
AV
1
2
3
4
5
6
abc
ghi
PAGE
def
jkl
CH
mno
7qrs 8tuv 9wxyz
p
0
DEL
SKIP
a few times and select “Other Sat.”,
then
STOP
All Other Sat Channels
SLOW/SEARCH
PAUSE
PLAY/x1.3
EXIT
STATUS
Sorting:123... Type:All Channels
freesatHome
freesatSSU
Brit Shorts
HINRG LOWNRG
WELL Class
GROOVE
-
GUIDE
Select
View
Page Up
Page Down
CH
RETURN
Sorting
Type
OK
CTION MENU
FUN
– To display the type of the
selected channel, press the
“Blue” button. Each time you
press the “Blue” button, the
type will be displayed as
follows.
Free TV ➔ Radio ➔ Data ➔ All Channels ➔ Free TV ➔ …
DIR ECT NAVIGATO
R
– The channel list appears.
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
MANUAL SKIP
INPUT
SELECT
Basic Operations
to turn the unit on.
BACK/
RETURN
OPTION
CREATE
TIME SLIP CHAPTER
– To sort the channel, press the “Yellow” button.
Each time you press the “Yellow” button the item will be displayed
as follows.
123 (channel number order) ➔ ABC (channel name order) ➔ …
Tips
e, r to select the desired channel, then
To set the channel list (➔ 98, Channel
Settings)
REC
TEXT
REC MODE EXT LINK DIRECT TV REC
STTL
DISPLAY PROG/CHECK
Notes
Selecting a channel without using the channel list
To select desired channel
Press [1, 2 CH].
You can perform this operation after step
• There are no programme guide
information in other satellite mode, only
list of channel name is available.
• Channel number is indicated on the
unit’s display as an example, “S1234”.
.
To directly enter channels
You can also select channels with the numbered buttons.
e. g., “5”:
[5] ➔ [OK]
“88”:
[8] ➔ [8] ➔ [OK]
“1234”: [1] ➔ [2] ➔ [3] ➔ [4]
25
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 25
2009/05/13 15:01:01
Playback
Refer to “Advanced Playback” (➔ 45 to 47) for detailed information.
HDD BD-RE BD-R RAM -R -R DL -RW(V) +R +R DL +RW BD-V DVD-V
-RW(VR)
TV
Preparation:
Turn on the television and select the video input terminal that this unit is
connected to.
2abc 3def
4ghi 5jkl 6mno
If you use a disc
PAGE
CH
7qrs 8tuv 9wxyz
p
to open the tray (Button located on front of the unit).
0
DEL
– Insert a disc (➔ 117) and press [; OPEN/CLOSE] again to close
the tray.
STOP
– Select “BD” for any discs.
MANUAL SKIP
INPUT
SELECT
SKIP
a few times to select the HDD or BD drive.
SLOW/SEARCH
PAUSE
PLAY/x1.3
EXIT
STATUS
PLAY/x1.3
Press [g].
– The stopped position is memorized.
(Resume play function )
This operation may not work
depending on a disc or the
position where it was stopped.
Press [h].
– Press again to restart play.
Menu screens on the TV
BD-V DVD-V
OK
CTION MENU
FUN
Pausing Play
DIR ECT NAVIGATO
R
GUIDE
Stopping Play
BACK/
RETURN
OPTION
CREATE
TIME SLIP CHAPTER
REC
REC MODE EXT LINK DIRECT TV REC
Tips
To display Pop-up Menu
BD-V
DINOSAUR
Generally, menu screens that appear on the TV may be navigated as
follows:
e. g.,
DVDTOP MENU
Play
Chapter List
CH
AV
1
to turn the unit on.
OPEN/CLOSE
VOL
DRIVE
SELECT
Subtitles
Trailer
During play
Press [DIRECT NAVIGATOR].
To display Top Menu
BD-V
While playing
1. Press [OPTION].
2. Press [e, r] to select “Top Menu”, then
press [OK].
While stopped
Press [DIRECT NAVIGATOR].
DVD-V
e, r, w, q to select an item, then
1. Press [OPTION].
2. Press [e, r] to select “Top Menu” , then
press [OK].
You can sometimes use the numbered buttons to select an item.
Notes
• BD-V DVD-V Playback starts from the
point specified by the disc.
• Depending on the disc type, playing may
automatically start without pressing [q]
(PLAY).
• The unit takes some time to read the
disc before play starts.
• Discs continue to rotate while menus
are displayed. Press [g] when you finish
to preserve the unit’s motor and your
television screen.
• If “5” appears on the TV, the operation is
prohibited by the unit or disc.
26
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 26
2009/05/13 15:01:01
Recording Television Programmes HDD
Refer to “Important Notes for Recording” (➔ 33 to 34) and “Advanced Recording” (➔ 35 to 38) for detailed
information on recording.
This operation will only record to HDD in DR mode.
Preparation:
Turn on the television and select the video input terminal that this unit is
connected to.
TV
VOL
DRIVE
SELECT
CH
AV
to turn the unit on.
1
a few times and select the HDD drive.
4ghi 5jkl 6mno
2abc 3def
PAGE
CH
7qrs 8tuv 9wxyz
p
– To select with the numbered buttons
(➔ 24 for freesat, 25 for other satellite services)
– To record 2 programmes simultaneously. (➔ 36)
– When [* REC] is pressed while a drive other than the HDD is
selected, it will automatically switch to HDD and start the recording.
Pausing Recording
Stopping Recording
Press [h].
– Press again to restart recording.
(The title is not divided.)
Press [g].
SLOW/SEARCH
PAUSE
PLAY/x1.3
EXIT
STATUS
GUIDE
OK
CTION MENU
FUN
to start recording.
SKIP
STOP
MANUAL SKIP
INPUT
SELECT
Basic Operations
to select desired channel.
0
DEL
DIR ECT NAVIGATO
R
a few times and select “freesat” or “Other
Sat.”, then
BACK/
RETURN
OPTION
CREATE
TIME SLIP CHAPTER
REC
TEXT
REC MODE EXT LINK DIRECT TV REC
STTL
DISPLAY PROG/CHECK
27
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 27
2009/05/13 15:01:02
Timer Recording Using the TV Guide (freesat) HDD
Various function with freesat
This unit has a function that enables timer recordings to be controlled by the signal sent from
the broadcaster. “Guide Link”, “Series recording” (➔ 40), and “Split Programme” are available.
“Guide Link” — If you set a timer recording from the TV Guide, the recording’s
start and stop times can be controlled by the broadcaster, e.g. delayed start.
This is indicated by “Guide Link” in the Timer Recording screen in step
(➔ 29).
“Series Timer Recording” — You can record all the episodes of a series by setting just
one timer recording (➔ 40).
“Split Programme” — If a programme is separated into 2 or more parts by some other
programmes e.g. news, this unit pauses recording during the gap.
(➔ 29).
This is indicated by “Split” in the Timer Recording screen in step
When setting timer from the 1st split programme, other parts of the programme will be automatically
set and indicated by the timer icon on the TV Guide, but not shown on the timer recording list.
If the signal is not sent correctly, the recording may lack the beginning or the
ending part of the programmes.
In order to make the timer recording work successfully, we recommend you
set the start time earlier and the end time later by some minutes, up to a
maximum of 10 minutes for Guide Link to function.
e.g. When you set the timer recording for a programme that will start at 10:00
and end at 11:00, set “9:58” and “11:05” in step
(➔ 29).
TV
PAGE
1
2
3
ghi
4
5
6
p
qrs
7
8tuv 9wxyz
DEL
0
abc
def
CH
mno
jkl
MANUAL SKIP
INPUT
SELECT
SLOW/SEARCH
STOP
This operation will only record to HDD in DR mode.
CH
AV
SKIP
These functions are available for freesat channels only. Use “Manual timer
recording” (➔ 39) to timer record Other Sat. channels.
PAUSE
PLAY/x1.3
EXIT
STATUS
Preparation:
• Turn on the television and select the video input terminal that this unit is
connected to.
• Turn on this unit.
• Confirm that the clock on the unit’s display is set to the correct time.
DIR ECT NAVIGATO
R
GUIDE
OK
BACK/
RETURN
OPTION
then
CTION MENU
FUN
a few times and select “freesat”,
CREATE
TIME SLIP CHAPTER
Channel Genre Selection
– The channel genre selection
screen appears.
VOL
DRIVE
SELECT
All Channels
Entertainment
News & Sport
Movies
Lifestyle
Music
Children
Special Interest
Radio
Shopping
Gaming & Dating
REC
Regional
Favourites
REC MODE EXT LINK DIRECT TV REC
Tips
To check programmes for which you
set the timer recording (➔ 41)
To cancel a timer recording
programming
y
OK
RETURN
e, r, w, q to select the
desired genre, then
Time: 14:00
14:30
108 BBC HD
BBC HD Preview
113 ITV2
Red Cap
Red Cap
– The TV Guide list appears.
114 ITV2+1
115 ITV3
116 ITV3+1
117 ITV4
120 Channel4
WED 19/08/2009 13:30
TV Guide: Landscape
All Types
WED 19th
12:00-20:00 HD BBC HD Preview
15:00
Love USA
News Show
100 Sheep Dream
Heartbeat
UFO
Behind me
Select Channel
OK
Select Programme
RETURN
Black House
All Channels
15:30
16:00
Crowntown
Portrait/Landscape
+24 hours
Deal
Page Up
Page Down
Info
GUIDE
Timer icon
Red Cap
News Show
USO
Blue Wave Great A
In the
100 Sheep Dream
Hot Wave
Used Car
Prog. Type
CH
Channel Genre
e, r, w, q to select the desired programme,
then
– To jump back 24 hours, press the “Red” button.
You can only jump back to the current date and past information
cannot be viewed.
1. Press [e, r, w, q] to select the
programme (the timer icon is displayed),
then press [OK].
2. While “Delete” is selected, press [OK].
3. Press [w, q] to select “Yes”, then press
[OK].
– The timer icon disappears.
To cancel a series timer recording
programme (➔ 40, Series recording)
– To jump ahead 24 hours, press the “Green” button to jump ahead
by one day.
– To display channels sorted in prog. type, press the “Yellow” button.
– To display channels sorted in channel genre, press the “Blue” button.
28
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 28
2009/05/13 15:01:02
Notes
– If “Series Timer Rec.” can be selected on the Selection Screen, refer
to “Series recording” (➔ 40)
e.g.,
Selection Screen
WED 19/08/2009 13:30
Timer Recording
Millions
4000 FilmFour
Movie
WED 19/08/2009
13:00 - 15:10
View
Single Timer Rec.
Series Timer Rec.
Delete
Remain HDD 30:30 DR
Channel Day/Date Start
121
WED19/08 13:10
WED 19/08/2009 8:59
Stop
Drive
13:50
HDD
[Prog.Name] BBC News at One
Mode
DR
Input Name
BBS 1 CI
(Guide Link)
Genre: News
National and international news from the BBC, followed by Wather.
Series Info
OK
OK
RETURN
RETURN
(Guide Link) : Guide Link (➔28)
(Series) : Series recording (➔ 40) is set.
(Split) : The programme is split in two or more parts by other programmes. This unit
pauses recording during the gap between the parts of the programme.
This screen may not appear depending on the programme.
– The selection screen appears if there are both SD and HD
programmes when you select the programme, go to (➔ below,
Recording the ITV HD, etc. programme)
• You cannot display the TV Guide when
you select “Other Sat.” on step .
• The TV Guide list is not displayed
immediately after initial tuning is done.
• The TV Guide system will not work if
the clock is not set correctly.
• If “NTSC” has been selected for “TV
System” (➔ 104), the TV Guide system
cannot be used.
• If you set a timer recording that will
overlap with other timer recordings, the
“Overlapped Timer Recording” screen
appears to help you resolve the
overlapping.
Follow the on-screen instructions.
• TV Guide will disappear automatically
when you do not operate this unit more
than 5 minutes.
Basic Operations
e, r to select “Single Timer Rec.”, then
Confirm the programme (start and end time) by
TV magazine, etc. and correct if necessary
using
y
e, r, w, q, then
Timer icon
–
–
–
–
The timer icon is displayed when the settings are stored and the timer programme is on.
“z” lights on the unit’s display to indicate timer recording standby has been activated.
Repeat steps
–
to programme other recordings.
Press [^] to turn the unit off.
“Guide Link” will not be displayed and will not function under the following conditions.
– Timer programmes set manually (➔ 39).
– Timer programmes set from the TV Guide are modified or start/stop time changed by more
than 10 minutes from original time.
– Timer programmes set from the TV Guide with the start time modified to later time or the
stop time modified to earlier time than the original time.
Recording the ITV HD, etc. programme
When ITV programme is also broadcast, the unit offers to select HD/SD
programme based on the signal sent from the broadcaster.
You can record the ITV HD programme using this unit.
–
to select a programme (➔ 28)
After performing steps
Tips
e, r to select “Single Timer Rec.”, then
Selection Screen
Little League Champion
103 ITV1 Wales
Sport
TUE 10/03/2009
19:30 - 22:00
MON 09/03/2009 22:45
View
Single Timer Rec.
Series Timer Rec.
Delete
To set the series timer recording with
ITV HD programme, etc.
Select “Series Timer Rec.” in step .
(➔ 40, Series recording)
Series Info
OK
RETURN
e, r to select the HD programme for recording,
then
– This screen will only appear if there is an
HD broadcast of the programme.
Programme Selection
MON 09/03/2009 22:45
The same programme in High Definition picture quality exists.
Please choose programme and set the timer recording.
Channel
Schedule
Contents
10/03 TUE
...Southpaws Action from Anfield of the
ITV1 Wales 19:30 - 22:00 second leg of the first knock-out round...
10/03 TUE
...Southpaws Action from Anfield of the
19:30 - 22:00 second leg of the first knock-out round...
HD
OK
RETURN
to go to step
(➔ above).
29
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 29
2009/05/13 15:01:02
Copying Titles
HDD p BD-RE BD-R RAM -R -R DL -RW(V) +R +R DL +RW
Preparation:
• Turn on the television and select the video input terminal that this unit is
connected to.
• BD-RE BD-R RAM If the disc is protected, release protection (➔ 94).
to turn the unit on.
OPEN/CLOSE
to open the tray (Button located on front of the unit).
– Insert a disc (➔ 117) and press [; OPEN/CLOSE] again to close
the tray.
e.g.,
DVD-RAM
TV
VOL
DRIVE
SELECT
CH
AV
2abc 3def
1
4ghi 5jkl 6mno
PAGE
CH
7qrs 8tuv 9wxyz
p
0
DEL
SKIP
Play
MANUAL SKIP
INPUT
SELECT
SLOW/SEARCH
Copy
Format Disc
DVD-RAM is inserted.
STOP
PAUSE
PLAY/x1.3
OK
RETURN
EXIT
STATUS
e, r to select “Copy”, then
Source
Destination
HDD
2
Copy Mode
3
Create List
VIDEO High Speed
0
BD/DVD
Information of the copy destination
– DVD-RAM
– Copy restricted title can be
copied on to disc
Start Copying
DIR ECT NAVIGATO
R
Cancel All
Direction
1 Copy
HDD BD/DVD
OK
CTION MENU
FUN
Copy
GUIDE
BACK/
RETURN
OPTION
Select the copy direction.
RETURN
CREATE
TIME SLIP CHAPTER
Set the copy direction.
– If you are not going to change the copy direction, press [r]
(➔ step ).
Press [e, r] to select “Copy Direction”, then press [q].
Press [e, r] to select “Source”, then press [OK].
Press [e, r] to select “HDD”, then press [OK].
REC
TEXT
REC MODE EXT LINK DIRECT TV REC
STTL
DISPLAY PROG/CHECK
If you select “HDD”, “Destination” is automatically set
to “BD/DVD”.
Press [e, r] to select “Destination”, then press [OK].
Press [e, r] to select “BD/DVD”, then press [OK].
The same drive as the copy source cannot be selected.
Press [w] to confirm.
Set the recording mode.
– If you are not going to change the recording mode, press [r]
twice (➔ step ).
Press [e, r] to select “Copy Mode”, then press [q].
Press [e, r] to select “Format”, then press [OK].
Press [e, r] to select “VIDEO”, then press [OK].
Press [e, r] to select “Recording Mode”, then press [OK].
Press [e, r] to select the mode, then press [OK].
Press [w] to confirm.
30
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 30
2009/05/13 15:01:03
Register titles for copy.
– If you are going to copy the registered list without making any
change to it , press [r] twice (➔ step ).
Press [e, r] to select “Create List”, then press [q].
Copy
Cancel All
Direction
1 Copy
HDD
BD / DVD
2
Copy Mode
3
Create List
Destination Capacity: 4343MB
Size:
0MB ( 0% )
Title
No. Size
New item (Total=0)
Tips
To stop copying
Press and hold [BACK/RETURN ] for 3
seconds after step 9 . (You cannot stop
while finalising or creating the top menu.)
To return to the previous screen
Press [BACK/RETURN ].
To select the subtitle language to copy
(➔ 99, Preferred Subtitles)
VIDEO High Speed
Start Copying
OK
RETURN
OPTION
Page 01/01
Create copy list.
Press [e, r] to select “New item”, then press [OK].
Press [e, r] to select the title, then press [h].
A check mark is displayed. Repeat this step until you select all necessary items.
• Press [h] again to cancel.
• The items will be copied in the order of the copying list. If you want to specify
the order, repeat selecting one item at a time.
• To show other pages
Press [u, i].
Press [OK].
• To edit the copying list (➔ 61)
You cannot start copying when the value of “Size” (➔ 62) exceeds 100%
(“Destination Capacity” is not sufficient).
Press [w] to confirm.
Set other settings.
– If you are not going to change these settings, press [r] twice
(➔ step 8 ).
Regarding copy-restriction on freesat
programmes (➔ 33, Important Notes for
Recording)
Copying list icons and functions (➔ 58)
To check the properties of a title and
sort copying list (➔ 62)
Notes
• Titles in the grouped titles and
other titles cannot be registered
simultaneously.
• Titles recorded using a different
encoding system (PAL or NTSC) from
the TV system currently selected on the
unit cannot be copied.
• The subtitle copied with “Subtitles” set to
“Automatic” cannot be turned on or off
during playback.
• During Normal Speed Copy with
“Subtitles” set to “Automatic”, you cannot
turn off the subtitle displayed on the
television.
Basic Operations
0
Press [e, r] to select “Other setting”, then press [q].
“Subtitles”
(Only when copying titles in DR mode and the recording mode other
than High Speed is selected)
Press [e, r] to select “Subtitles”, then press [OK].
Press [e, r] to select “Automatic” or “Off”, then press [OK].
• If “Automatic” is selected
Subtitle in the source titles will be copied.
• If “Off” is selected
Subtitle in the source titles will not be copied.
“Finalise” or “Create Top Menu”
( HDD p -R -R DL -RW(V) +R +R DL +RW only)
Press [e, r] to select “Finalise” or “Create Top Menu”, then press [OK].
Press [e, r] to select “On” or “Off”, then press [OK].
• If “On” is selected
– -R -R DL -RW(V) +R +R DL After finalising, the discs become play-only and
you can also play them on other DVD equipment. However, you can no longer
record or edit.
– +RW Create the Top Menu. Top Menu is a convenient function. We recommend
you create the menu before playing a +RW disc on other equipment.
“Audio Description”
(Normal Speed Copy only)
Press [e, r] to select “Audio Description”, then press [OK].
Press [e, r] to select “Automatic” or “Off”, then press [OK].
• If “Automatic” is selected
If title recorded in DR mode includes Audio Description, the title will be copied
with Audio Description.
• If “Off” is selected
Title recorded in DR mode will be copied without Audio Description.
Press [w] to confirm.
8 e, r to select “Start Copying”, then
9 w, q to select “Yes”, then
31
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 31
2009/05/13 15:01:03
Deleting Titles
You can delete unnecessary titles.
In order to save HDD capacity, it is recommended that you delete the original
titles (in DR mode) after converting them to other recording modes using “DR
File Conversion” (➔ 55).
TV
Preparation:
• Turn on the television and select the video input terminal that this unit is
connected to.
• BD-RE BD-R RAM If the disc is protected, release protection (➔ 94).
• Press [; OPEN/CLOSE] and insert a disc. Press [; OPEN/CLOSE]
again to close the tray.
Important:
Once deleted, contents cannot be recovered.
VOL
DRIVE
SELECT
CH
AV
2abc 3def
1
4ghi 5jkl 6mno
PAGE
CH
7qrs 8tuv 9wxyz
p
HDD BD-RE BD-R RAM -R -R DL -RW(V) +R +R DL +RW
DELETE Navigator
0
DEL
MANUAL SKIP
INPUT
SELECT
SKIP
SLOW/SEARCH
a few times to select the HDD or BD drive.
STOP
– Select “BD” for any discs.
With the unit stopped
PLAY/x1.3
EXIT
STATUS
FUNCTION MENU
HDD
Time Remaining
PAUSE
GUIDE
30:00 DR
Playback
Recording
TV Guide
Others
OK
RETURN
OK
BACK/
RETURN
OPTION
e, r to select “Delete”, then
CTION MENU
FUN
DIR ECT NAVIGATO
R
Delete
Copy
CREATE
FUNCTION MENU
HDD
Time Remaining
DELETE Navigator Grouped Titles
Time Remaining
HDD
Date
30:00 DR
Channel
25/05
01/06 AV2
01/06 AV1
Playback
Recording
TIME SLIP CHAPTER
45:54 DR VIDEO
Time
PICTURE
Title Name
MUSIC
Titles
12:36 Born And Bred: A Wrathful
1:35
1:13
2
1
1
REC
REC MODE EXT LINK DIRECT TV REC
Rec time
Delete
0:00(DR)
Copy
TV Guide
TEXT
Not viewed
Others
STTL
DISPLAY PROG/CHECK
Page 01/01
OK
OK
RETURN
OPTION
VIDEO
Select
PICTURE
MUSIC
RETURN
HDD BD-RE RAM When “VIDEO” is not selected, press the “Red” button to select
“VIDEO”.
To view other pages
Press [u, i].
e, r to select the title, then
A check mark is displayed. Repeat this step until you select all necessary items.
• Press [ h ] again to cancel.
w to select “Delete”, then
Delete Titles During Playback
During playback
DEL
w to select “Delete”, then
Notes
• You cannot delete while copying at
Normal Speed.
• +R +R DL +RW Even if you have set
protection on other equipment, such
titles are deleted.
Tips
To return to the previous screen
Press [BACK/RETURN ].
• HDD BD-RE RAM Deleting an item
increases the available disc space by
the amount of space taken by the item
deleted.
• BD-R -R -R DL +R +R DL Available disc
space does not increase after deletion.
• -RW(V) +RW Available disc space
increases when you delete the last title
(If you format the disc, all of the disc
space will be available. (➔ 95)).
• HDD BD-RE RAM -RW(V) +RW To
recover total disc space, the disc needs
to be formatted. (➔ 95, 101)
32
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 32
2009/05/13 15:01:04
Important Notes for Recording
Recording to DVD-R DL
and +R DL
BD-RE BD-R RAM -R -RW(V) +R +RW
Recording on the discs is performed using “Recording via AV3 input” (➔ 67) and “DV Automatic Recording” (➔ 66).
You cannot directly record to a DVD-R DL and +R DL disc on this unit.
Record to the HDD and then copy to the disc.
Recording mode
Recording modes that can be selected differ depending on the recording methods and discs. (➔ 35)
High definition quality
image
Quality of titles to be recorded differs depending on the recording mode. (➔ 35)
When recording in DR mode /When copying the title recorded in DR mode at high speed
Recorded as high definition quality.
When copying in HG, HX, HE, HL modes
Recorded as high definition quality with compressed broadcast data.
When copying in XP, SP, LP, EP, FR modes
Recorded as standard definition quality.
Broadcast in multichannel sound
You can select the audio language when receiving audio in multi-channel broadcast using this unit’s tuner [“Multi
Audio” appears at the bottom of digital satellite channel information display (➔ 90)].
When recording in DR mode /When copying the title recorded in DR mode at high speed
All multiple audio are recorded. It is possible to switch audio during the playback of the title.
When copying in HG, HX, HE, HL, XP, SP, LP, EP, FR modes
Only one audio is recorded.
Before copying
– “Copy”: Select the audio with “Preferred Multi Audio” in the Setup menu (➔ 99).
– “Copy Title Playing”: Select the audio with “Multi Audio/AD” in the Disc menu (➔ 88).
Programmes with
subtitles
It is possible to display the subtitles when receiving a programme with the subtitles [“Subtitles” appears at the
bottom of digital satellite channel information display (➔ 90)].
When recording in DR mode/When copying the title recorded in DR mode at high speed
Subtitles will be recorded as is. It is possible to switch the subtitles during the playback of the title.
When copying in HG, HX, HE, HL, XP, SP, LP, EP, FR modes
Subtitles will be recorded but it is not possible to switch off during playback.
Before copying
– “Copy”: Select the subtitle language in “Preferred Subtitles” in the Setup menu (➔ 99) and set “ Automatic” in
“Subtitles” in the copy setting screen.
– “Copy Title Playing”: Select the subtitle language in “Preferred Subtitles” in the Setup menu (➔ 99) and set
“On” in “Subtitles” in the Disc menu (➔ 88).
Surround audio
You can enjoy surround audio when receiving a programme with surround audio (➔ 35).
When recording in DR mode/When copying the title recorded in DR mode at high speed
It is recorded as is.
When copying in HG, HX, HE, HL modes
It is recorded with surround audio that was converted from broadcasted audio format.
When copying in XP, SP, LP, EP, FR modes
It is recorded with stereo audio.
Copy-restriction on
freesat programmes
Some programmes on freesat channels are copy-restricted and the number of times you can copy in DR, HG,
HX, HE, HL mode is assigned by the broadcaster.
The titles which have the copy-restriction are indicated in Direct Navigator, Delete Navigator and copy source
selection screen with the following icons.
Basic Operations
Recording to discs
Recording or timer recording is performed in DR mode using this unit’s tuner.
Recording or timer recording from external equipment is performed in XP, SP, LP, EP or FR mode.
Recording
Recording to HDD
0
Titles with the “HD No Copy” restriction
Converting recording mode with “DR File Conversion”
After converted to HG, HX, HE, HL mode, the converted title retains the “HD No Copy” restriction and the
original title is automatically deleted after conversion.
Copying
You cannot select High Speed, HG, HX, HE, HL mode when copying to BD-RE or BD-R.
1
Titles with the “HD Copy Once” restriction
Converting recording mode with “DR File Conversion”
After converted to HG, HX, HE, HL mode, the converted title will retain the “HD Copy Once” restriction and the
original title is automatically deleted after conversion.
Copying
After copying in High Speed, HG, HX, HE, HL to BD-RE or BD-R, the original title and the copied one will be
indicated with the icon 0
. You cannot copy from them in high definition quality (DR, HG, HX, HE, HL) any more.
• Copying and converting recording mode with “DR File Conversion” to XP, SP, LP, EP, FR mode are not restricted.
• Regardless of the copy-restriction status, the picture output of freesat programmes in HD quality from
COMPONENT VIDEO OUT terminal is converted to SD quality (576i/p), when watching the broadcast or
playing back after recorded.
33
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 33
2009/05/13 15:01:04
Important Notes for Recording
16:9 image such as wide
broadcasting
When “Recording Format for DVD” (➔ 101) in the Setup menu is “Video format”
– Record from external equipment.
– Copy from the finalised disc (DVD-Video) to the HDD.
When copying to -R -R DL -RW(V)
When copying to BD-RE BD-R in HG, HX, HE, HL modes
When converting the recording mode from DR mode to HG, HX, HE, HL, XP, SP, LP, EP, FR modes
It will be recorded in accordance to the setting of “Aspect for Recording” (➔ 101) in the Setup menu.
In the following cases, even when set to “Automatic” or “16:9”, recordings will be made or copied in 4:3.
– -R -R DL -RW(V) When the recording mode is set to “EP” or “FR (recordings 5 hours or longer)” mode.
– When copying to +R, +R DL and +RW.
DR File Conversion
“DR File Conversion” is a function that converts the titles in DR mode to other recording modes.
In general, Data size of a title will be smaller than the original title after conversion.
You can save HDD capacity by deleting the original title after conversion.
Available disc space
Title DR
Converting to other mode
Available disc space
Title DR
Title HL
Deleting the original data
Available disc space
Title HL
The original title may be deleted automatically after conversion, if the title is copy-restricted (➔ 33).
High Speed Copy
0
Titles with the “HD No Copy” restriction
1
Titles with the “HD Copy Once” restriction
Speed to copy the title recorded on the HDD to a disc differs depending on the recording mode of the title and
the disc to copy.
Title in DR mode
BD-RE BD-R Title can be copied at high speed.
Title in HG, HX, HE, or HL modes
BD-RE BD-R Title can be copied at high speed.
Title in XP, SP, LP, EP, or FR modes
RAM Title can be copied at high speed.
BD-RE BD-R Title cannot be copied at high speed.
-R -R DL -RW(V) +R +R DL +RW
Title can be copied at high speed if “Recording Format for DVD” was set to “Video format” before the programme
is recorded to HDD from external input. (The default setting is “Video format”. ➔ 101)
But in the following cases, high speed mode does not work.
– +R +R DL +RW Titles recorded in “EP” mode and “FR (recordings 5 hours or longer)” mode
– +R +R DL +RW Titles recorded in 16:9 aspect
– -R -R DL -RW(V) Titles recorded in 16:9 aspect using “EP” mode or “FR (recordings 5 hours or longer)” mode
Playing the disc on
other players
BD-RE BD-R
Titles in DR, HG, HX, HE or HL mode may not playback on other Blu-ray disc player. (➔ 20)
-R -R DL -RW(V) +R +R DL
The disc must be finalised. (➔ 96)
It is necessary to finalise DVD-R, etc. on this unit after recording or copying titles to them. You can then play them
as a commercially sold DVD-Video. However, the discs become play-only and you can no longer record or copy.
You can record and copy again if you format DVD-RW. (➔ 95)
Record to DVD-R, etc.
Play on other DVD equipment
CHG
!! /I
!!
DOUBLE RE-MASTER CD SEQUENTIAL
DISC
1
2
3
4
5
!!
!!
!!
!!
/!!
!!
/!!
DISC EXCHANGE
DISC SKIP
!!OPEN/CLOSE
SEARCH
Finalise
ENTER
VOL
DISPLAY
TOP
MENU
RETURN
MENU
ON
OFF
DC
IN
9V
OPEN
UND
A.SURRO
REPEAT
MODE
MONITOR
MODE
PICTURE
+RW
Parental Control
If the disc failed to play on other equipment, we recommend you create top menu (➔ 96).
Programmes with scenes unsuitable for children are broadcasted with “Guidance Information”, which allows you
block the playback of the recorded titles.
If “Parental Control” in the Setup menu is set to “On”, the titles recorded from the programme broadcasted with
“Guidance Information” in the night (21:00–05:30) are indicated in DIRECT NAVIGATOR, DELETE Navigator and
copy source selection screen with the
icon. You will have to enter the PIN (➔ 14, step 8 ).
34
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 34
2009/05/13 15:01:04
Advanced Recording
Recording modes
This explains about recording and copying.
Recording modes that can be selected differ depending on the recording methods and discs.
Recording mode
Features
DR
Record with the same
quality of the broadcast
HG, HX, HE, HL
Record high definition
programme as
compressed High
Definition data
XP, SP, LP, EP
Record in quality as in
conventional analogue
broadcast
MPEG-4 AVC/H.264
encoding
Quality that can
be recorded
Quality produced by
conversion of broadcast
data (HD quality and SD
quality)
Multiple audio
Quality same as
broadcasted
(HD quality and SD
quality)
Record all multiple audio
Subtitles
Can be recorded
The audio of the
surround
programme
Surround audio as the
broadcast
Can be recorded 1 (➔ 33)
Surround audio produced Stereo audio
by conversion of
broadcast audio format 2
2
SD quality only
Record only one audio (➔ 33)
The subtitles cannot be switched on or off during playback.
If the audio sampling frequency is not 48 kHz, surround audio is mixed and recorded in front LR channels. Audio will be output from two front
speakers only, even if you play it on 5.1 ch speaker connection.
Recording
1
FR
Flexible Recording
Mode
Record in quality as in
conventional analogue
broadcast
Record by automatically
adjusting the quality
between XP and EP
(8 hours) depending on the
remaining area on the disc
■ Recording method
( :Possible, –:Impossible)
Recording method
Recording
Timer Recording
Flexible Recording via
AV Input
Recording via AV3 input
DV Automatic
Recording
1
2
HDD
(DR)
(HG, HX, HE, HL)
(XP, SP, LP, EP)
(FR)
(DR)
(HG, HX, HE, HL)
(XP, SP, LP, EP)
(FR)
(DR)
(HG, HX, HE, HL)
(XP, SP, LP, EP)
(FR)
(DR)
(HG, HX, HE, HL)
(XP, SP, LP, EP)
(FR)
(DR)
(HG, HX, HE, HL)
(XP, SP, LP, EP)
(FR)
1
–
2
–
1
–
2
2
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
BD-RE
BD-R
RAM
-R
-RW(V)
+R
+RW
-R DL
+R DL
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
When using this unit’s tuner
When recording from external equipment
■ Maximum number of titles that can be recorded
HDD
You can record up to 499 titles on HDD. (When continuously recording for long durations, titles are automatically divided every 8 hours.)
BD-RE BD-R
You can record up to 200 titles on one disc.
RAM -R -R DL -RW(V)
You can record up to 99 titles on one disc.
+R +R DL +RW
You can record up to 49 titles on one disc.
35
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 35
2009/05/13 15:01:04
Advanced Recording
■ FR (Flexible Recording Mode)
You can set FR (Flexible Recording) mode when copying or recording from external equipment. The unit automatically selects a recording rate
between XP and EP (8 Hours) that will enable the recordings to fit in the remaining disc space with the best possible recording quality.
For example with a 90 minute recording to an unused DVD-RAM, the picture quality is adjusted to between “XP” and “SP”.
When recording to the HDD, picture quality is automatically adjusted to fit a copied title on a 4.7 GB disc.
■ Recording modes and approximate recording time
Depending on the content being recorded, the recording time may become shorter than indicated.
(The time provided on this chart are an estimate.)
Recording Mode
HDD
BD-RE
BD-R
(25 GB)
BD-RE DL
BD-R DL
(50 GB)
Singlesided
(4.7 GB)
Doublesided 2
(9.4 GB)
DVD-R
DVD-RW
+R
+RW
(4.7 GB)
DVD-R DL
+R DL
(8.5 GB)
37 hours
30 min.
3 hours
30 min.
7 hours
30 min.
–
–
–
–
215 hours
105 hours
10 hours
15 min.
21 hours
–
–
–
–
HG
80 hours
40 hours
4 hours
8 hours
–
–
–
–
HX
120 hours
60 hours
6 hours
12 hours
–
–
–
–
HE
180 hours
90 hours
9 hours
18 hours
–
–
–
–
HL
240 hours
120 hours
12 hours
24 hours
–
–
–
–
XP
110 hours
55 hours
5 hours 15 min.
10 hours 30 min.
1 hour
2 hours
1 hour
1 hour 45 min.
SP
220 hours
110 hours
10 hours 30 min.
21 hours
2 hours
4 hours
2 hours
3 hours 35 min.
442 hours
221 hours
21 hours
42 hours
4 hours
8 hours
4 hours
7 hours 10 min.
885 hours
(664 hours 4)
441 hours
(331 hours 4)
42 hours
(31 hours 30 min. 4)
84 hours
(63 hours 4)
8 hours
(6 hours 4)
16 hours
(12 hours 4)
8 hours
(6 hours 4)
14 hours 20 min.
(10 hours 45 min. 4)
DMR-BS850
DMR-BS750
(500 GB)
(250 GB)
DR 1
(High Definition
Quality: 14 Mbps)
77 hours
DR 1
(Standard Definition
Quality: 5 Mbps)
LP
EP
3
DVD-RAM
Recording time of DR mode depends on bit rate of broadcasting.
It is not possible to record or play continuously from one side of a double sided disc to the other.
3
When recording to the HDD in “EP” or “FR (recordings 5 hours or longer)” mode, you cannot perform high-speed copy to +R, +R DL or +RW discs.
4
When “Recording time in EP mode” is set to “6 hours” in the Setup menu (➔ 101). The sound quality is better when using “6 hours” than when using “8 hours”.
RAM When recording to DVD-RAM using “8 hours” mode, play may not be possible on DVD players that are compatible with DVD-RAM. Use
“6 hours” mode if playback may be on other equipment.
BD-RE BD-R The recording time may be longer than the values indicated above, if you copy the titles recorded from radio service.
Due to peculiarities of BD-RE and BD-R, you may be unable to copy to them even if disc space is remained.
1
2
■ Regarding recording time remaining
DR mode recording
Remaining time in the DR mode is calculated with a bit rate of approx. 14 Mbps. But the bit rate differs depending on the broadcast, so the
displayed remaining time might be different from the actual remaining time.
Other recording modes (title conversion or from external input)
This unit records using a VBR (Variable bit rate) data compression system to vary recorded data segments to match video data segments which
may cause differences in the displayed amount of time and space remaining for recording.
If the remaining amount of time is insufficient, delete any unwanted titles to create enough space before you start recording.
2 programmes simultaneous recording
It is possible to record 2 programmes simultaneously, if both DISH IN 1 and DISH IN 2 terminals are connected to the satellite dish (➔ 10, Basic Connection).
Possible combination for 2 programmes simultaneous recording
To record both programmes
to the HDD
Digital broadcast
(DR mode)
HDD
and
Digital broadcast
(DR mode)
or external input
HDD
To perform 2 programmes simultaneous recording, 1 programme out of the 2 needs to be recorded to the HDD in DR mode.
Notes
2 programmes simultaneous recording is not possible in following conditions:
– 2 programmes from the external input
– While recording from DV input, or executing “Recording via AV3 input”
– While high speed copying
36
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 36
2009/05/13 15:01:05
Specifying the Recording Time
This operation will only record from the tuner to
HDD in DR mode.
This function allows specifying the length of recording
time up to 4 hours.
During recording
on the main unit repeatedly
until the desired time is reached.
Playing while you are recording
Chasing Playback
Allows playback from the beginning of the title you are
recording.
Simultaneous Record and Playback
Allows playback of a previous title, while recording
something else.
• You can also change the drive and play while
recording. Press [DRIVE SELECT].
– The recording time and the unit’s display change
as follows:
OFF 0:30
OFF 4:00
OFF 3:00
OFF 1:00
OFF 1:30
OFF 2:00
e, r to select the title to play,
then
Notes
•
•
•
•
This function does not work during timer recording.
Recording stops and the set time is cleared if you press [g].
The unit turns off automatically after recording finished.
When recording from external equipment, you can select the
recording mode from XP, SP, LP, EP. (➔ 65)
Tips
Direct TV Recording
To stop play
Press [g].
This operation will only record to HDD in DR mode.
This function allows you to immediately start recording
the programme that you are viewing on the TV without
having to change the channels on this unit.
• You can use the function when you connect the unit
to a Q Link compatible TV using the 21-pin Scart
cable.
(When recording using the TV’s tuner, you can select
the recording mode from XP, SP, LP, EP.)
You can also use this function using VIERA Link. (➔
86)
Recording
Counter (Cancel)
During recording
To exit the DIRECT NAVIGATOR screen
Press [DIRECT NAVIGATOR].
To stop recording
After play stops
1. Press [DIRECT NAVIGATOR] to exit the screen.
2. Press [g].
Notes
• “Chasing Playback” and “Simultaneous Rec and Play” can only be
used with programmes of the same encoding system (PAL/NTSC).
• Depending on the state of the unit, playback may not be possible.
(➔ 116)
and hold for about 1 second.
Tips
To stop recording
Press [g].
Notes
• If you switch TV channels while using Direct TV recording during
viewing the analogue or digital terrestrial broadcasting, the Direct
TV recording stops.
37
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 37
2009/05/13 15:01:05
Advanced Recording
Operation during Recording
To check the recording programme
Press [STATUS
].
e.g., while 2 programmes simultaneous recording
Recording programme
displayed on the TV screen
Recording programme not
displayed on the TV screen
HDD
REC1
108 BBC HD
002 BBC TV REC2
To display the recording programme on the
TV screen
It is necessary to display the recording programme onto the TV
screen to perform operations such as pause.
If the input was switched:
Press [INPUT SELECT].
If the channel was switched: Press [1 2 CH].
To stop recording
It is necessary to display the programme you want to stop on the TV
screen. (➔ above)
Press [g].
From the start to the end of the recording is called one title.
To pause recording
It is necessary to display the programme you want to pause on the
TV screen. (➔ above)
Press [h].
Press again to restart recording.
You can also press [* REC] to restart.
(Title is not split into separate titles.)
When recording is paused, the record indicator flashes.
To switch the input
Press [INPUT SELECT].
To switch to other channels
Press [1 2 CH].
Perform 2 programmes simultaneous recording
Record other programme with steps
–
on page 27.
“REC1” and “REC2” will light.
REC1
REC2
Channel switch / input switch while performing 2 programme
simultaneous recording will switch between the 2 recording
programmes.
38
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 38
2009/05/13 15:01:05
Advanced Timer Recording HDD
Manual timer recordings
This operation will only record from the tuner to
HDD in DR mode.
– The timer icon is displayed in left column.
Preparation:
• Turn on the television and select the video input
terminal that this unit is connected to.
• Confirm that the clock on the unit’s display is set
to the correct time.
Timer Recording Remain HDD 30:30 DR
Channel Name
Schedule
Timer icon
z
– “z” lights on the unit’s display to indicate
timer recording standby has been activated.
– Check for available space on HDD, etc., when
“!” is displayed.
WED 19/08/2009 21:30
Drive/Mode
Space
ode
New Timer Programme
Space
OK
RETURN
Total 0/32
Info
DEL Delete
Turn Timer Off
Resolve overlap
e, r to select “New Timer
Programme”, then
Notes
• If “New Timer Programme” is already selected,
press [OK].
w, q to move through the items
and e, r to set the items.
Timer Recording
Remain HDD 30:30 DR
121
Start
Stop
WED 19/08 13:10
[Prog.Name] BBC News at One
Drive
Mode
HDD
DR
Channel:
Day/Date:
Tips
To exit the timer recording list
Press [PROG/CHECK].
Input Name
BBS 1 CI
RETURN
• “z” on the unit’s display flashes when the unit cannot go to timer
recording standby (e.g., HDD has no space to record).
• If three timer recording times overlap, the first and second
recordings always have priority. The third recording will start only
after the first recording has finished.
WED 19/08/2009 8:59
All Channels
Channel Day/Date
– Repeat steps – to programme other
recordings.
– Press [^] to turn the unit off.
Page UP
CH
Page Down
Recording
OK
Category/AV
– The Channel number
You can press the “Red” button to
change “Category/AV”.
You can perform this operation when
you select a box of “Channel”.
[e.g., All Channels, Radio,
Registered Favourites, AV1, AV2 etc.
(➔ 97, freesat Favourites Edit)]
– You can set date or weekly
programme (➔ right, Tips).
Start (start time) / Stop (end time):
– Hold [e] or [r] to change in 15minute increments or decrements.
Drive:
– HDD (You cannot change the drive.)
Mode:
– DR mode (You cannot change the
recording mode.) (➔ 35)
• You can change it only when you
select AV1, AV2, AV3 or AV4 in
“Channel”.
Renew:
– Auto Renewal Recording (➔ 41)
ON/OFF
• You can change its setting only
when you select weekly programme
in “Day/Date”.
Input Name – You can enter programme name.
Press [OK]. (➔ 84, Entering Text)
• “Date” Setting
Each press of [e] changes items in the order below.
(Each press of [r] changes items in the reverse order.)
Current date --- One month later
minus one day
Each press of the “Green” button changes item in the order below.
You can perform this operation when you select a box of
“Day/Date”.
Date
Weekly
Titles recorded using the same daily or weekly timer are bundled
and displayed as a “group” in the DIRECT NAVIGATOR screen (➔
45) except when using Auto Renewal Recording (➔ 41).
• You can also use the numbered buttons to enter “Channel”, “Start”
and “Stop”.
39
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 39
2009/05/13 15:01:06
Advanced Timer Recording HDD
Series recording
This operation will only record to HDD in DR mode.
You can record all the episodes of a series by setting
just one timer recording using the TV Guide system.
– You cannot change Channel, Day/Date, Drive,
and “Input Name”.
– With “Start” and “Stop” automatically set by the
“Guide Link” function, “Start” can be changed
back by up to 10 minutes and “Stop” can be
changed forward by up to 10 minutes.
– This unit automatically records the
programmes that are identified to be of the
same series by the TV Guide data.
– Titles recorded using series recording are
bundled and displayed as a “group” in the
Direct Navigator screen (➔ 45) except when
using Auto Renewal Recording. (➔ 41)
a few times and select
“freesat”, then
– The channel genre selection screen appears.
e, r,w, q to select the desired
genre, then
– The TV Guide list appears.
Channel Genre Selection
All Channels
Entertainment
News & Sport
Movies
Lifestyle
Music
Children
Special Interest
Radio
Shopping
Gaming & Dating
Series recording icon
Regional
Favourites
Tips
To check the schedule of the series
Press the “Blue” button after performing steps
OK
RETURN
Series Information
e, r,w, q to select the desired
programme, then
114 ITV2+1
115 ITV3
116 ITV3+1
117 ITV4
120 Channel4
All Types
15:00
Behind me
Crowntown
Prog. Type
S : The episode to be recorded
Deal
Page Up
Page Down
Portrait/Landscape
R : Repeat programme
CH
Channel Genre
z : Programme for which you set the timer recording
HD : HD programme
– If the same episode has already been set for
series timer recording at a different time or on
another channel, “Series Timer Rec.” will not
be selectable.
– You can select the HD programme for
recording when there are both SD and HD
programmes.
[➔ 29 Timer Recording Using the TV Guide
(freesat)]
Selection Screen
WED 19/08/2009 12:42
Media Revolution
View
Single Timer Rec.
102 BBC TWO Wales
News and Factual
WED 19/08/09
0:20 - 0:50
Series Timer Rec.
Delete
Series Info
OK
RETURN
3/6 Comedy-drama series about
R
housemates who are actually awere...
RETURN
e, r to select “Series Timer
Rec.”, then
e.g.,
3/6 Comedy-drama series about
housemates who are actually awere...
18/03WED
BBC HD 23:00 - 0:00
16:00
News Show
USO
Blue Wave Great A
In the
100 Sheep Dream
Hot Wave
Used Car
Black House
+24 hours
Contents
2/6 Comedy-drama series about
housemates who are actually awere...
17/03TUE
BBC HD 23:00 - 0:00
All Channels
15:30
Info
GUIDE
Channel Schedule
16/03MON
BBC HD 23:00 - 0:00
HD
Red Cap
News Show
Love USA
100 Sheep Dream
Heartbeat
UFO
Select Channel
OK
Select Programme
RETURN
HD
HD
.
WED 19/08/2009 13:30
TV Guide: Landscape
WED 19th
12:00-20:00 HD BBC HD Preview
Time: 14:00
14:30
108 BBC HD
BBC HD Preview
113 ITV2
Red C ap
Red Cap
S
–
WED 19/08/2009 23:28
Timer Recording Remain HDD 60:19 DR
Channel
102
WED 19/08/2009 12:42
Day/Date
Start Stop Drive Mode Renew
WED 19/08
0:20
0:50 HDD
[Prog. Name] Media Revolution
BBC TWO Wales
DR
OFF
Input Name
To cancel the series timer recording programme
1. Press [e, r, w, q] to select the programme (the timer icon is
displayed), then press [OK].
2. While “Delete” is selected, press [OK].
3. Press [w, q] to select “Yes”, then press [OK].
– The timer icon disappears.
• All programmes of the same series you select to cancel will be
cancelled at the same time.
Notes
• If the unit cannot record the first run, the unit will record the repeat
programme if it is available. However, this unit will not record the
repeat programme, if any part of the first run is recorded.
• The series recording will be cancelled if there has been no episode
of the series for 13 weeks.
• You cannot set series timer recording for the repeat programmes of
the series that you have already set series timer recording.
(Guide Link) (Series)
Genre: News
Tommorrow’s TV: The final episode of Media Revolution, a three-part series the
Money Programme, looks at the transformation of the UK TV industry. [S]
OK
RETURN
The series timer recording cannot be selected if
the selection screen does not appear.
40
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 40
2009/05/13 15:01:06
To cancel a timer recording in progress
Select the programme you want to cancel in advance when you
record 2 programmes simultaneously.
Check, Change, Delete Programmes, or
Resolve Overlapping
The timer recording list can be viewed even when the
unit is off.
While the unit is on
, then e, r to select the
programme.
– Confirmation screen appears.
Icons
w to select “Yes”, then
Timer Recording Remain HDD 30:30 DR
Channel Name
Schedule
WED 19/08/2009 21:30
Drive/Mode
Space
Notes
108 BBC HD
The Maharajas’ Motor Car:
MON 09/03
22:00 - 23:00
HDD
DR
OK
103 ITV1 Wales
Harry Hill’s TV Burp
MON 09/03
23:05 - 23:35
HDD
DR
OK
Recording stops and the timer programme is deleted. (Daily, weekly
and series timer programmes remain and timer recording will start
from the next time the timer recording is set.)
102 BBC TWO Wales
Programme Name
MON 09/03
23:15 - 23:30
HDD
DR
MON 09/03
23:20 - 23:50
HDD
DR
102 BBC TWO Wales
Media Revolution
Auto Renewal Recording
e, r to select the programme,
then
w, q to select “Renew” column.
e, r to select “ON”, then
Timer Recording
Remain HDD 30:30 DR
WED19/08/2009 8:59
Weekly
Channel Day/Date
21
Start
Stop
Drive
Mode
WED 19/18 13:10
13:50
HDD
DR
[Prog.Name] BBC News at One
Renew
ON
Input Name
BBS 1 CI
OK
RETURN
Notes
• If a programme set for Auto Renewal Recording is protected
or while playback is taking place from the HDD, or while
copying, the programme will not be overwritten. Instead the
programme set for recording will be saved as a separate
programme, and this programme will be the one to be
overwritten when the next Auto Renewal Recording takes
place.
• When there is not enough space on the HDD, the
programme may not be recorded completely.
If the “Overlapped Timer Recording”
screen appears
If you set a timer recording that will overlap with other
timer recordings using the TV Guide system, the
“Overlapped Timer Recording” screen appears to help
you eliminate the overlapping.
Follow the on-screen instructions.
OK
RETURN
Total 4/32
Info
DEL Delete
Turn Timer Off
Resolve overlap
Page UP
CH
Page Down
Icons
z:
Red: Timer recording standby is activated.
Grey: Timer recording standby is not activated.
Currently recording
*:
You stopped a daily, weekly or series timer recording.
Q:
The icon disappears when the next timer recording starts
recording.
:
Timer programmes set to Auto Renewal Recording (➔
left).
Drive:
Recording drive is set to HDD
OK:
Recordable
➔ (Date): For daily, weekly or series timer recordings, the display
will show until when recordings can be made (up to one
month ahead from the present time) based on the time
remaining on the HDD.
!:
It may not be possible to record because:
– there is no more space left.
– the number of possible titles has reached its maximum.
– programmes are overlapped.
– you stopped a daily, weekly or series timer recording.
:
Programmes are overlapped. Recording of the
programme with the later start time starts when the
earlier programme finishes recording.
:
freesat programme is selected
:
Other Sat. programme is selected
:
Guide Link (➔ 28)
:
Split Programme (➔ 28)
:
Series Timer Recording (➔ 28)
2a
DEL
Recording
This operation will only record to HDD in DR mode.
If you record a programme onto HDD repeatedly
everyday or every week using timer recording, the unit
will record the new programme over the old one.
This function can be used only when daily, weekly
or series timer recording is selected.
!
New Timer Programme
to delete.
– You cannot delete programmes that are
currently being recorded.
to modify the programme.
2b
e, r, w, q to make changes,
then
2c When a programme with
is selected
then follow the on-screen
instructions to resolve overlapping.
(Green)
– If the on-screen instructions do not appear,
change or delete the overlapped programme.
41
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 41
2009/05/13 15:01:06
Advanced Timer Recording HDD
Tips
• You can enter up to 32 programmes a month in advance.
(Each daily, weekly or series timer recording is counted as one
programme.)
To exit the timer recording list
Press [PROG/CHECK].
Notes
• Recording may fail if there are changes to the station’s programming.
• “z” disappears from the unit’s display when no timer programme is
set or when all timer programmes are deactivated.
• “-------” is displayed on a series recording item if there will be no
episode of the series for the next 8 days. We recommend you
delete the “-------” item after you confirm the last episode of the
series is recorded.
• The “Guide Link” function may not work if you manually change the
start/end time by over 10 minutes.
• The “Guide Link” function may not work if you manually change the
start time later or the stop time earlier than the original time.
• Programmes that failed to record are deleted from the timer
recording list at 4 a.m. two days later.
To deactivate timer programme
(e.g. to interrupt a daily or weekly timer
programming)
Notes on timer recording
• Timer recording will not be performed if the clock is not set.
• During recording, timer recording standby or EXT LINK
standby, this unit cannot play discs or titles that do not
match the “TV System” setting. It is recommended “TV
System” be set to match the discs or title before playing
them. But to prevent the failure of the timer recording,
change back the settings before the recording starts. (➔
104)
• Timer recordings are activated regardless of whether the
unit is turned on/in standby.
• Timer recordings begin when the set time is reached even
when playing.
• Timer recordings do not begin while copying in normal
speed mode.
• If the unit is turned on when timer recording begins, it
remains turned on after recording finishes. It does not
turn off automatically. You can turn the unit off during timer
recording.
• When you programme successive timer recordings to start
immediately one after the other, the unit cannot record the
part at the beginning of the later programmes.
Programme
Not recorded
Recorded
After performing step
(➔ Previous page)
(Red)
– “z” on the timer recording list turns gray.
– Press the “Red” button again to activate timer
programme.
Programme
Recorded
• The “Overlapped Timer Recording” screen may be displayed
immediately after you turn on this unit, if new overlapping
occurred. Refer to “Check, Change, Delete Programmes, or
Resolve Overlapping” (➔ 41).
42
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 42
2009/05/13 15:01:07
TV Guide system (freesat)
What is the TV Guide system?
The TV Guide system gives you an overview of digital satellite television and radio programmes up to 7 days in
advance. For many of these programmes, you can select additional information provided by the stations. You can
search the programme preview according to various topics such as sport, films etc., according to categories such
as TV or radio. You can easily find the desired programmes and set timer recording.
Landscape view:
The TV Guide system offers detailed
information as if you see a TV programme
magazine. This is convenient to check the
status of timer recording.
Landscape view
WED 19/08/2009 13:30
TV Guide: Landscape
All Types
WED 19th
12:00-20:00 HD BBC HD Preview
Time: 14:00
14:30
108 BBC HD
BBC HD Preview
113 ITV2
Red Cap
Red Cap
114 ITV2+1
115 ITV3
116 ITV3+1
117 ITV4
120 Channel4
15:00
News Show
Love USA
100 Sheep Dream
Heartbeat
UFO
Behind me
Select Channel
OK
Select Programme
RETURN
All Channels
15:30
16:00
Red Cap
Black House
S Crowntown
Portrait/Landscape
+24 hours
Deal
Page Up
Page Down
Info
GUIDE
Portrait view:
This is convenient to narrow down channels
to search for the programme you want to
watch.
News Show
USO
Blue Wave Great A
In the
100 Sheep Dream
Hot Wave
Used Car
Prog. Type
CH
GUIDE
Channel Genre
Series icon
( 40)
Timer icon
( 29, 39)
Selected
programme
WED 19/08/2009 13:00
TV Guide: Portrait
GUIDE
z : Timer Recording
S : Series Recording
TUE 10th
113 ITV2
1:55 –
2:50 –
3:30 –
6:00 –
6:30 –
7:00 –
7:30 –
2 :50
3 :30
6 :00
6 :30
7 :00
7 :30
8 :15
Select Programme
OK
Select Channel
RETURN
-24 hours
To view a
programme list for
another day
To change the page
of the TV Guide list
All Types
All Channels
116 ITV3+1 117 ITV4
114 ITV2+1 115 ITV3
Jack Osbourne: Celebrity Adrenaline
Sex, Love &nSecrets
Teleshopping
Coronation Street
Coronation Street
Emmerdate
The Montel Williams Shoe
Page Up
Page Down
Info
GUIDE
Portrait/Landscape
+24 hours
Prog. Type
CH
Channel Genre
Portrait view
Tips
Using the TV Guide list
To change channels
To switch between Landscape view and
Portrait view
Press [GUIDE].
Recording
Broadcast date
Broadcast time
Landscape view
Press [e, r] to select a channel.
Portrait view
Press [w, q] to select a channel.
The TV Guide list appears for this channel.
• Jump ahead 24 hours
Press the “Green” button to jump ahead
by one day.
• Jump back 24 hours
Press the “Red” button.
You can only jump back to the current
date. Past information cannot be viewed.
When displays the empty TV Guide list:
WED 19/08/2009 13:00
TV Guide: Portrait
TUE 10th
113 ITV2
1:55 –
2:50 –
3:30 –
6:00 –
6:30 –
7:00 –
7:30 –
2 :50
3 :30
6 :00
6 :30
7 :00
7 :30
8 :15
Select Programme
OK
Select Channel
RETURN
-24 hours
114 ITV2+1 115 ITV3
All Types
All Channels
116 ITV3+1 117 ITV4
Jack Osbourne: Celebrity Adrenaline
Sex, Love &nSecrets
The “empty” field
Coronation Street
Coronation Street
Emmerdate
The Montel Williams Shoe
Page Up
Page Down
Info
GUIDE
Portrait/Landscape
+24 hours
Prog. Type
CH
Channel Genre
• Some digital broadcast may not send programme information.
• Set the timer recording manually (➔ 39, Manual timer recordings).
Press [1, 2 CH].
To see programme
Press [STATUS
information
(programme name,
programme duration,
broadcast time,
description)
(Programmes with the
symbol)
TV Guide: Portrait
].
WED 19/08/2009 13:00
TUE, 10 March 2009
Jack Osbourne: Celebrity Adrenaline...
ITV2
1:55 - 2:50, 55 min.
Genre: Entertainment
...Junkie Lack Osbourne, Bez, Charlie Brooks and Jody Latham perform a terrifying
leap from one cable car to another in the Alps, and take on Europe’s most
dangerous motor recing circuit.
OK
Return to list
RETURN
• Press [e] and [r] to scroll up and down.
To show other pages
Press [1 CH] (Previous) or [2 CH] (Next).
To return to the TV Guide list
Press [STATUS ].
To return to the
previous screen
Press [BACK/RETURN ].
To exit the screen
Press [EXIT].
Notes
• The TV Guide system setup will not work if the clock is not set
correctly or the wrong postcode is selected.
43
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 43
2009/05/13 15:01:07
TV Guide system (freesat)
Selecting the programme from the desired
channel genre or programme type
– A list appears with all programmes of the
selected item.
– When you select the landscape view, the
programmes that belong to the selected
channel genre are highlighted.
This function lets you display a TV Guide list sorted by
genre (e.g. All Channels, Radio) or programme type
(e.g. Movies, Sport).
a few times to select
TV Guide:Landscape
WED 19/08/2009 23:32
All Channels
MON 9th
23:30-0:00
Lifestyle
The Wedding Planner
Time: 23:30
0:00
0:30
1:00
1:30
402 WEDDING
The Wedding Getting better
Help! I Need Date Me Mar
403 WEDDING
Love
Real Weddin The Wedding For Better or For Worse
406 info TV
PokerHeaven PokerHeaven.com Europea Red Cap
450 M and M
Fre Police 10/7 Police 10/7 Freddie Starr Soldier, Soldier
451 Audi
The Science The Science Your Audi:T D The A Beh P T I How T
“freesat”, then
Channel Genre Selection
All Channels
Entertainment
News & Sport
Movies
Lifestyle
Music
Children
Special Interest
Radio
Shopping
Gaming & Dating
Regional
Favourites
Select Channel
OK
Select Programme
RETURN
GUIDE
Info
Portrait/Landscape
+24 Hours
Prog. Type
e.g., channel
Genre,
“Lifestyle”
is selected
in step of
Landscape
view.
Channel Genre
e, r, w, q to select the desired
programme.
OK
– To view the programme. (➔ 24)
– To record the programme. (➔ 28)
RETURN
e, r, w, q to select the desired
genre, then
Tips
– The TV Guide list appears.
WED 19/08/2009 13:30
TV Guide: Landscape
All Types
WED 19th
12:00-20:00 HD BBC HD Preview
Time: 14:00
14:30
108 BBC HD
BBC HD Preview
113 ITV2
Red Cap
Red Cap
114 ITV2+1
115 ITV3
116 ITV3+1
117 ITV4
120 Channel4
Behind me
Select Channel
OK
Select Programme
RETURN
Black House
15:30
GUIDE
Crowntown
Deal
Page Up
Page Down
Portrait/Landscape
to display the list
of channel genre.
16:00
Red Cap
News Show
USO
Blue Wave Great A
In the
100 Sheep Dream
Hot Wave
Used Car
Info
+24 hours
(Blue)
15:00
Love USA
News Show
100 Sheep Dream
Heartbeat
UFO
All Channels
Prog. Type
CH
Channel Genre
Channel Genre
All Channels
All Channels
Entertainment
News & Sport
Movies
Lifestyle
Music
Children
Special Interest
Radio
Shopping
e, r to select the desired item.
To display the programme type
Press the “Yellow” button in step .
To return to the previous TV Guide list before you have selected
the channel genre or programme type
Select “All Channels” of channel genre or “All Types” of the
programme type in step .
To Exit
Press [BACK/RETURN ].
Notes
• The broadcasters allocate individual programmes to topic areas.
This function does not work properly unless the information which
distinguishes the channel genre and programme type sent from
broadcast stations is correct.
• If the unit is disconnected from the AC mains, all programme data
are lost.
• The programme list is available if this unit has found a digital station
and loaded the information in the memory. This process can take a
while depending on the particular station.
• The programme list data are continuously downloaded in the
background when the unit is turned on. That means that the
programme list can sometimes change while you are looking at it.
44
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 44
2009/05/13 15:01:07
Advanced Playback
Switching the DIRECT NAVIGATOR appearance
Selecting Titles to Play
You can easily select and play recorded programmes
by using DIRECT NAVIGATOR.
HDD BD-RE BD-R RAM -R -R DL -RW(V) +R +R DL
+RW -RW(VR)
“Grouped Titles”/“All Titles” HDD
While the DIRECT NAVIGATOR screen is displayed
Press [OPTION].
Press [e, r] to select the item, then press [OK].
e. g.,
While stopped
Release Grouping
DIRECT NAVIGATOR Grouped Titles
Time Remaining
HDD
PICTURE
Time
Title Name
25/05
01/06 AV2
01/06 AV1
12:36 Born And Bred: A Wrathful
1:35
1:13
MUSIC
2
1
1
0:00(DR)
Not viewed
Page 01/01
RETURN
OPTION
VIDEO
Select
PICTURE
PICTURE / MUSIC
Titles
Rec time
OK
“Grouped Titles” or “All Titles” HDD
All Titles
45:54 DR VIDEO
Date Channel
MUSIC
HDD BD-RE RAM
When “VIDEO” is not selected, press the “Red”
button to select “VIDEO”.
Grouped Titles screen
Two or more titles recorded in
the Day/Date or series timer
recording mode are bundled
and displayed as one item.
DIRECT NAVIGATOR Grouped Titles
Time Remaining
HDD
Date
45:54 DR VIDEO
Channel
25/05
01/06 AV2
01/06 AV1
Time
PICTURE
Title Name
MUSIC
DIRECT NAVIGATOR All Titles
Time Remaining
HDD
No. Date Day
Titles
12:36 Born And Bred: A Wrathful
1:35
1:13
001
002
003
004
2
1
1
Rec time
Rec time
0:00(DR)
e, r to select the title you want
to watch, then
All Titles screen
Displays all titles.
25/05
25/05
01/06
01/06
45:54 DR VIDEO PICTURE
Channel Time
0:00(DR)
Not viewed
Not viewed
Page 01/01
Page 01/01
OK
RETURN
MUSIC
Title Name
12:36 Born And Bred: A Wrathful
12:37 Play School: Food Friday
1:35
1:13
SAT
SAT
SUN AV2
SUN AV1
OPTION
VIDEO
Select
PICTURE
OK
MUSIC
RETURN
OPTION
VIDEO
Select
PICTURE
MUSIC
Tips
Recording
Select the item marked
with
, then press [OK] to
display the bundled titles.
Press [u, i].
To exit the DIRECT NAVIGATOR screen
Press [DIRECT NAVIGATOR].
DIRECT NAVIGATOR screen icons
Protected.
Not recorded due to recording protection (Digital
broadcasts, etc.)
×
*
It cannot be played because data is damaged, etc.
Title that was recorded but has not yet been
played ( HDD only)
0
Playback the title that was viewed once HDD
You can choose to start the playback from the point you have
last stopped, or from the beginning when the resume play
function (➔ 26) is operating.
While the DIRECT NAVIGATOR screen is displayed
Press [OPTION].
Press [e, r] to select “Play”, then press [OK].
Press [w, q] to select “Last Stopped” or
“Beginning”, then press [OK].
Currently recording.
Groups of titles ( HDD only)
1
Playing Back
To view other pages
Titles that can be copied in HD quality once
Titles that cannot be copied in HD quality anymore
Titles that cannot be copied
Titles with guidance information (➔ 100, Parental
Control) or title with child lock (➔ 99, Child Lock)
Radio programme
(NTSC) Title recorded using a different encoding system
(PAL) from that of the TV system currently selected on
the unit.
• Alter the “TV System” setting on this unit to suit
(➔ 104).
To sort the titles for easy searching
HDD (All Titles screen only)
This function is convenient when searching for one title to
playback from many titles.
Press [OPTION].
Press [e, r] to select “Sort”, then press [OK].
Press [e, r] to select the item, then press [OK].
If you select an item other than “No.”
• The DIRECT NAVIGATOR screen will reappear
after playback of the selected title has finished. (You
cannot play titles continuously.)
• Skip and Time Slip will function only with the title
currently being played back.
• If you exit the DIRECT NAVIGATOR screen, or
switch to another DIRECT NAVIGATOR screen, the
sort will be cancelled.
45
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 45
2009/05/13 15:01:08
Advanced Playback
To play grouped titles HDD
Skip
Press [e, r] to select the group, then press [OK].
Press [e, r] to select the title, then press [OK].
Play the titles continuously (Grouped Playback)
While the Grouped Titles screen is displayed,
Press [e, r] to select the group and press [q] (PLAY).
To edit the group of titles HDD
HDD (Grouped Titles screen only)
Press [e, r] to select a title or a group, then press
[h].
A check mark is displayed. Repeat this step until you
select all necessary titles.
• Press [h] to cancel.
Press [OPTION].
Press [e, r] to select the option, then press [OK].
Create Group:
Press [w, q] to select “Create”, then press [OK].
Selected titles are bundled to form a group.
Release Grouping:
Press [w, q] to select “Release”, then press [OK].
• When a group of titles has been selected, all the titles in
the group are released.
• When a title in a group has been selected, the title is
removed from the group.
Regarding the group name
The name of the first title in the group is used as the group
name.
DIRECT NAVIGATOR Grouped Titles
Time Remaining
HDD
Date
45:54 DR VIDEO
Channel
25/05
01/06 AV2
01/06 AV1
Time
PICTURE
Title Name
12:36 Born And Bred: A Wrathful
1:35
1:13
MUSIC
DIRECT NAVIGATOR Grouped Titles
Time Remaining
HDD
Titles
Date
2
1
1
25/05
25/05
45:54 DR VIDEO
Channel
Time
PICTURE
MUSIC
Title Name
12:36 Born And Bred: A Wrathful Go
12:37 Play School: Food Friday
0:00(DR)
0:00(DR)
Not viewed
Not viewed
Page 01/01
Page 01/01
OK
RETURN
OPTION
VIDEO
Select
PICTURE
OK
MUSIC
q Play
During playback or while paused
OPTION
Select
RETURN
To change the group name
1 Press [e, r] to select the group, then press [OPTION].
2 Press [e, r] to select “Edit”, then press [OK].
3 Press [e, r] to select “Enter Title Name”, then press [OK].
4 Enter the name. (➔ 84, Entering Text)
• Even if the group name is changed, the title names in the
group will not be changed.
Notes
• This function is only available for videos and not available
for music and still pictures.
Search
During playback
or
– There are 5 search speeds. Each press increases the
search speed. ( +R +R DL +RW Up to 3 speeds)
– Press [q] (PLAY) to restart normal playback.
– BD-V Only primary video is played while
performing this operation.
Tips
or
– Each press increases the number of skips.
– DivX: Press [u] to return to the beginning of the
title currently playing.
Quick View (Play x1.3)
Except -RW(V) (It will not work even if it is finalised)
-RW(VR) , DivX
Allows you to increase the play speed slightly without
distorting the audio.
During playback PLAY/x1.3
(Press and hold.)
– Press again to return to normal speed.
– Image may not be played back smoothly in case of
DR, HG, HX, HE, HL mode titles or BD-V AVCHD .
– BD-V Only primary video is played while
performing this operation.
Direct Play
During playback, you can access specific titles or
scenes through direct entry of the numbered buttons.
1
Rec time
Rec time
You can skip to the beginning (or the end) of Title/
Chapter. Skip is operated for each chapter.
2abc 3def
4ghi 5jkl 6mno
7qrs 8tuv 9wxyz
p
0
• BD-V AVCHD
Input a 3-digit number.
e.g.,
5:
[0] ➔ [0] ➔ [5]
15:
[0] ➔ [1] ➔ [5]
• DVD-V
Input a 2-digit number.
e.g.,
5:
[0] ➔ [5]
15:
[1] ➔ [5]
Slow-motion Play
Except DivX
While paused
or
– There are 5 slow-motion speeds. Each press
increases the speed.
– Press [q] (PLAY ) to restart normal playback.
Notes
• If continued for approx. 5 minutes, slow-motion play pauses
automatically (except BD-V DVD-V AVCHD ).
• BD-V AVCHD allows slow-motion in the forward direction only.
• BD-V Only primary video is played while performing this operation.
• You cannot perform this operation when you playback the radio
programme.
Depending on the disc, search may not be possible.
46
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 46
2009/05/13 15:01:08
Frame-by-Frame Viewing
Except DivX
While paused
Display the subtitle during play
HDD BD-RE BD-R
OK
– Each press shows the next or previous frame.
– Press and hold to advance or reverse frame-byframe in succession.
– Press [q] (PLAY) to restart normal playback.
It is possible to display the subtitles during the playback
if the programme with subtitle is recorded with DR
mode.
– It will switch between On/Off every time it is
pressed.
Notes
• BD-V AVCHD allows Frame-by-Frame in the forward direction only.
• BD-V Only primary video is played while performing this operation.
• You cannot perform this operation when you playback the radio
programme.
BD-V DVD-V AVCHD DivX
Display with “Subtitles” in the Disc menu
(➔ 88, Subtitles).
Time Slip
Except BD-V DVD-V AVCHD , DivX
e, r to select the time, then
– Each time you press [e, r], the time
increases [e] or decreases [r] by 1 minute
intervals.
– Press and hold [e] or [r] for 10-minute
intervals.
Manual Skip
Except DivX
Skips approx. 1 minute forward with each press.
During playback
Create Chapters
HDD BD-RE BD-R RAM
When creating chapters in your favourite scenes, you
can easily reach the head of scene using [u, i]
(SKIP) or play on Chapter View (➔ 56).
Notes
When playing DVD-R DL (Dual Layer, single-sided) and +R DL
(Double Layer, single-sided)
DVD-R DL (Dual Layer, single-sided) and +R DL (Double Layer,
single-sided) discs have two writable layers on one side. If there
is not enough space on the first layer to record a programme,
the remainder is recorded on the second layer. When playing
a title recorded on both layers, the unit automatically switches
between layers and plays the title in the same way as a normal
programme. However, video and audio may momentarily cut out
when the unit is switching layers.
Playing Back
During playback
When switching layers:
Video and audio may momentarily cut
Second recordable layer
The available
space
First recordable layer
Title 1
(Inner
section of
the disc)
Title 2
Playback direction
(Outer section
of the disc)
DVD-R DL
+R DL
During playback
Tips
Chapters cannot be created during EXT LINK standby (➔ 64).
47
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 47
2009/05/13 15:01:09
Playback of the High Definition Video (AVCHD) and playlists
Playback of the High Definition Video
(AVCHD)
AVCHD
It is possible to playback the high definition video
(AVCHD) recorded on the Panasonic’s video camera,
etc. on the disc or SD card.
Insert a disc or SD card.
e, r to select “Play Video
(AVCHD)”, then
e.g., RAM
Notes
• Set “Play Video (AVCHD) on BD-RE/BD-R” to “On” in the Setup
menu for the disc that has high definition video (AVCHD) recorded
by Panasonic’s video camera, etc. and other video format such as
those recorded on this unit. (➔ 100)
• Multiple titles may not playback continuously depending on the disc.
Press [DIRECT NAVIGATOR], and playback by selecting the title.
• It may pause for a few seconds on the break of images when
editing such as partial deletion is performed.
• High definition video (transfer rate of 24 Mbps or faster) cannot be
played back correctly if it was recorded on a DVD compatible to
double speed or slower.
Playback of the playlists created on
other equipment
BD-RE BD-R RAM -RW(VR)
Creation or editing of playlists cannot be done on this unit.
DVD-RAM ( AVCHD )
Play Video ( AVCHD )
Copy Video ( AVCHD )
Play Pictures ( JPEG )
This disc is play-only and cannot be recorded or
copied to.
Preparation:
• Insert a disc.
• Press [DRIVE SELECT] to select the BD drive.
OK
RETURN
e.g., SD
SD Card
With the unit stopped
Play Video ( AVCHD )
Copy Video ( AVCHD )
Copy Video ( MPEG2 )
Play Pictures ( JPEG )
Copy Pictures ( JPEG )
e, r to select “Others”,
then
SD card is inserted.
OK
RETURN
– Display items differ depending on what is
recorded in each media.
– If the top menu of the disc or SD card to play
was
Display the top menu
• Created:
Display the “DIRECT
• Not created:
NAVIGATOR” screen
It may not be able to display the “DIRECT
NAVIGATOR” screen depending on the
equipment used to record.
FUNCTION MENU
DVD-RAM
Time Remaining
Rec time
00:00.07
Playlists
DV Automatic Recording
Copy
Recording via AV3 input
TV Guide
Network
Others
DVD Management
Setup
OK
RETURN
e, r to select “Playlists”,
then
e, r, w, q to select the playlist,
then
e.g., SD DIRECT NAVIGATOR screen
No. Date Day Time
Ext Link Standby
Recording
Delete
e, r w, q to select the title,
then
DIRECT NAVIGATOR Video (AVCHD)
SD CARD
4:00 EP
Playback
VIDEO
Playlists
Playlist View
DVD-RAM
Title Name
001 15/12 SAT 19:36 Fantasista
002 07/12 FRI 12:35 2007.12.07
-----------------
--
01
02
05.06(THU) 0:12.12
05.07(MON) 0:07:31
--
--
--
Page 01/01
OK
RETURN
OPTION
Previous
VIDEO
OK
Page 01/01
Next
OPTION
RETURN
Operation during play (➔ 45 to 47, Advanced
Playback)
Tips
To exit the screen
Press [EXIT].
To display the top menu
Press [DIRECT NAVIGATOR].
When the top menu or “DIRECT NAVIGATOR” is not displayed
Refer to “Direct Play” (➔ 46) to playback.
Operation during play (➔ 45 to 47, Advanced Playback)
Tips
To return to the previous screen
Press [BACK/RETURN ].
To exit the screen
Press [EXIT].
48
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 48
2009/05/13 15:01:09
To enjoy the BD Video which supports BONUSVIEW or BD-Live
• These discs may not be on sale in certain regions.
• The usable functions and the operating method may
vary with each disc, please refer to the instructions on
the disc and/or visit their website.
Playing secondary video (picture-inpicture) and secondary audio
Secondary video can be played from a disc compatible
with the picture-in-picture function.
For the playback method, refer to the instructions for
the disc.
Image of the secondary video
e.g.,
Secondary video
Primary video
When the secondary video does not display
Turn “Video” and “Soundtrack” to “On” in “Secondary
Video” in “Signal Type” in the Disc menu. (➔ 88)
• To output the audio of the secondary video, set “BDVideo Secondary Audio” to “On” in the Setup menu
(➔ 103).
Enjoying BD-Live discs with Internet
Many BD-Live compatible discs require content to be
downloaded onto an SD card (➔ 139, Local storage) in
order to access the available BD-Live features.
• An SD card with 1 GB or more of free space (SD
Speed Class Rating 2 or higher) needs to be inserted
prior to inserting the BD-Live compatible disc.
Some BD-Live content available on the Blu-ray discs
may require an Internet account to be created in order
to access the BD-Live content. Follow the screen
display or instruction manual of the disc for information
on acquiring an account.
Preparation:
• Connect to the network. (➔ 115)
• Set “Network Settings” in the Setup menu. (➔ 110)
Insert an SD card (➔ 117).
• If the SD card menu screen is displayed, press
[DRIVE SELECT] on the remote control, select
“BD”.
Insert the disc (➔ 117).
• For operation method, refer to the instructions on
the disc.
To use the above functions, it is recommended that you
format the card on this unit. (➔ 95)
Playing Back
BD-V
What is BONUSVIEW?
BONUSVIEW allows you to enjoy functions such as
picture-in-picture or secondary audio etc., with BDVideo supporting BD-ROM Profile 1 version 1.1/Final
Standard Profile.
What is BD-Live?
In addition to the BONUSVIEW function. BD-Video
supporting BD-ROM profile 2 that has a network
extension function allows you to enjoy more functions
such as subtitles, exclusive images and online games
by connecting this unit to the Internet. In order to use
the Internet feature, you must have this unit connected
to a broadband network. (➔ 115)
Notes
• While using this feature, do not remove the SD card. Doing so will
cause playback to stop.
• A message may be displayed when SD card doesn’t have enough
storage capacity for BD-Live content. Please make space available
on the current SD card, or insert another SD card.
• The unit must be connected to the Internet and set up (➔ 109) to
use the BD-Live functions. “BD-Live” may need to be changed for
certain discs (➔ 100).
• When discs supporting BD-Live are played back, the player or disc
IDs may be sent to the content provider via the Internet.
• The unit is connected to the Internet when BD-Live functions are
used, generating communication charges.
• The playback may be paused depending on the communication
environment. Some functions may be disabled to prevent skipping
to sections that have not been downloaded, etc.
Notes
• Discs may not always be played back according to the settings on
this unit, as certain playback formats are prioritized on certain discs.
• Only the primary video is played during search/slow-motion or
frame-by-frame.
• When the secondary video is turned off, the secondary audio is not
be played.
49
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 49
2009/05/13 15:01:10
To enjoy High Bit rate Audio and Video
Enjoying High Bit rate Audio with 7.1ch speaker
This unit can decode high bit rate audio (Dolby Digital Plus, Dolby TrueHD, DTS-HD High Resolution Audio and
DTS-HD Master Audio) adopted in BD-Video.
To enjoy 7.1ch surround sound, the following conditions are necessary (Part shown in the shaded area of table
given below).
• Connect an amplifier/receiver with 7.1ch speaker supporting HDMI (High Bit rate Audio) using a High Speed HDMI
cable. (➔ 101)
• Set “BD-Video Secondary Audio” to “Off” in the Setup menu. (➔ 103)
• Set “Dolby D/Dolby D +/Dolby TrueHD” or “DTS/DTS-HD” to “Bitstream” or “PCM” in the Setup menu. (➔ 103)
About audio from audio output terminal
Connect an amplifier/receiver and confirm the desired audio type and necessary settings (“BD-Video Secondary
Audio”, “Dolby D/Dolby D +/Dolby TrueHD” or “DTS/DTS-HD”).
• The number of channels listed is the maximum possible number of output channels.
• Also, depending on the specifications or the settings of the amplifier/receiver, the results of the output may vary.
Terminal
“Dolby D/Dolby D +/
Dolby TrueHD”/
“DTS/DTS-HD”
“BD-Video
Secondary Audio”
Dolby Digital/
Dolby Digital EX
5
Dolby Digital Plus
Dolby TrueHD
DTS Digital
Surround/
DTS-ES 5
DTS-HD High
Resolution Audio
DTS-HD Master
Audio
7.1ch LPCM
1
2
3
4
5
6
HDMI AV OUT
“Bitstream”
“On”
2
Dolby Digital/
Dolby Digital
EX 6
Dolby Digital
DTS Digital
Surround/DTSES 6
DTS Digital
Surround
Down-mixed
5.1ch PCM
DIGITAL AUDIO OUT
“PCM”
1
“Off”
Dolby Digital/
Dolby Digital EX
Dolby Digital Plus
Dolby TrueHD
DTS Digital
Surround/
DTS-ES
DTS-HD High
Resolution Audio
DTS-HD Master
Audio
7.1ch PCM
3
“On”
“Off”
7.1ch PCM
2
DVD-V
BD-V
5.1ch PCM
7.1ch PCM
7.1ch PCM
Down-mixed
5.1ch PCM 2
“PCM”
“On”/“Off”
“On”/“Off”
Dolby Digital/
Dolby Digital
EX 6
5.1ch PCM
5.1ch PCM
“Bitstream”
4
4
7.1ch PCM
Dolby Digital
DTS Digital
Surround/
DTS-ES 6
Down-mixed 2ch
PCM
DTS Digital
Surround
Down-mixed 2ch
PCM
When the connected equipment is not supported with these audio format, the audio is output as Dolby Digital bitstream, DTS Digital Surround
bitstream or down-mixed 2ch PCM (e.g., TV)
BD-V : When playing BD-Video without secondary audio or clicking sound, the audio is output as the same format as if “BD-Video Secondary
Audio” was set to “Off” in the Setup menu.(➔ 103)
When the connected equipment is not supported with multi channel surround, the audio is output as down-mixed 2ch PCM.
BD-V : When the connected equipment is supported with 7.1 channel surround, the audio output is amplified from 5.1ch or 6.1ch to 7.1ch
depending on the DTS, Inc. specifications.
With PCM output, Dolby Digital EX becomes PCM audio decoded as Dolby Digital, DTS-ES recorded to DVD-Video becomes PCM audio
decoded as DTS Digital Surround, and DTS-ES recorded to BD-Video becomes PCM audio decoded as DTS-ES.
BD-V : When “BD-Video Secondary Audio” is set to “On” in the Setup menu, Dolby Digital EX is output as Dolby Digital and DTS-ES is output
as DTS Digital Surround, however if playing BD-Video without secondary audio or clicking sound, the audio is output as the original format.
Notes
• When setting “BD-Video Secondary Audio” to “Off” in the Setup menu, the clicking sound on the menu and audio with secondary video in
picture-in-picture mode (➔ 49) cannot be output.
Regarding 24p output
Many BD-Video movie contents are recorded in 24 frames/second in accordance with the film materials. However,
they will normally be output in 60 frames/second in accordance with the display format.
These can be output in 24p as the original. Therefore, high-quality video can be enjoyed, such as the improved
clarity, enhanced perspective, etc.
Preparation:
• Connect to a TV supporting 1080/24p input via an HDMI cable.
• Set “BD-Video 24p Output” to “On” in the Setup menu. (➔ 105)
50
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 50
2009/05/13 15:01:10
Playing DivX
Playing DivX video contents
If the menu screen (➔ left) is not displayed, display it by
performing the following operation.
-R -R DL CD USB
-R -R DL CD USB
DivX is a digital video format created by DivX, Inc. This is
an official DivX Certified device that plays DivX video.
You can play DivX video contents recorded with a computer
onto DVD-R, DVD-R DL, CD-R/CD-RW and USB memory.
®
1 Press [FUNCTION MENU].
2 -R -R DL CD
Press [e, r] to select “Playback”, then press [OK].
USB
Press [e, r] to select “Others”, then press [OK].
Insert a disc or USB memory.
Display items differ depending on what is
recorded in each media.
-R -R DL CD USB
e.g., CD
CD
Play Video (DivX)
Play Pictures (JPEG)
Play/Copy Music (MP3)
Press [e, r] to select “USB device”, then press [OK].
Notes
• Picture sizes set at the recording time may prevent the unit from
showing pictures in the adequate aspect. You may be able to adjust
the aspect through the TV.
• Successive play is not possible.
• Playback is not possible if recording is performed on the HDD drive
or the BD drive.
Using the tree screen to find a folder
CD is inserted.
While the file list is displayed
Press [OPTION].
OK
RETURN
Press [e, r] to select “Select Folder”.
automatically if it is only DivX
DivX Menu
CD (DivX)
USB
USB device
Play Video ( DivX )
Copy Video ( AVCHD )
Copy Video ( MPEG2 )
Play Pictures ( JPEG )
Copy Pictures ( JPEG )
Play / Copy Music ( MP3 )
OK
Select Folder
12_02_2009
Image001
Image002
Image003
Image004
Image005
Image006
Image007
Image008
Image009
Image010
F 1/21
RETURN
Page 01/01
F: Selected folder no./
Total folder no. including
DivX title.
You cannot select
folders that contain no
compatible files.
Playing Back
• It will go to step
that is recorded.
Press [e, r] to select a folder, then press [OK].
The file list for the folder appears.
USB device is inserted.
OK
RETURN
e, r to select “Play Video
(DivX)”, then
e.g., CD
Tips
To return to the previous screen
Press [BACK/RETURN ].
Operation during play (➔ 45 to 47, Advanced Playback)
DivX Menu
CD (DivX)
DivX
Title Name
No.
001
ABC.divx
OK
RETURN
Select a folder from OPTION menu.
Page 01/01
OPTION
• Files are treated as titles.
e, r to select the title, then
Play starts on the selected title.
Tips
To stop playing
Press [g].
To show other pages
Press [u, i].
To exit the screen
Press [DIRECT NAVIGATOR].
51
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 51
2009/05/13 15:01:10
Playing DivX
Regarding DivX VOD content
ABOUT DIVX VIDEO-ON-DEMAND:
This DivX® Certified device must be registered in order to play DivX
Video-on-Demand (VOD) content.
First generate the DivX VOD registration code for your device and
submit it during the registration process. [Important: DivX VOD
content is protected by a DivX DRM (Digital Rights Management)
system that restricts playback to registered DivX Certified devices. If
you try to play DivX VOD content not authorized for your device, the
message “Authorisation Error.” will be displayed and your content will
not play.]
Learn more at www.divx.com/vod.
Display the unit’s registration code.
( 107, “DivX Registration” in “Others” menu)
Others
DivX Registration
Automatic Standby
Remote Control
DivX® Video On Demand
Clock
Owner ID
PIN Entry
Your registration code is : XXXXXXXX
Power Save
System Update
8 alphanumeric characters
To learn more visit www.divx.com/vod
DivX Registration
Initialize
OK
RETURN
• After playing DivX VOD content for the first time, another
registration code is then displayed in “DivX Registration”. Do not
use this registration code to purchase DivX VOD content. If you use
this code to purchase DivX VOD content, and then play the content
on this unit, you will no longer be able to play any content that you
purchased using the previous code.
• If you purchase DivX VOD content using a registration code
different from this unit’s code, you will not be able to play this
content. (“Authorisation Error.” is displayed.)
Regarding DivX content that can only be played a set number of
times
Some DivX VOD content can only be played a set number of times.
When you play this content, the remaining number of plays is
displayed. You cannot play this content when the number of
remaining plays is zero. (“Rental Expired.” is displayed.)
When playing this content
• The number of remaining plays is reduced by one if
– you press [^].
– you press [g].
– you press [DIRECT NAVIGATOR].
– you press [u] or [t, y] etc. and arrive at another content or
the start of the content being played.
– timer recording starts on the HDD.
– you press [DRIVE SELECT] to change the drive.
• Resume functions work. The number of plays is not reduced when
you restart by resume play function.
52
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 52
2009/05/13 15:01:11
Titles−Editing
HDD BD-RE RAM
BD-R -R -R DL -RW(V) +R +R DL (You can not edit
finalised discs.)
+RW
-RW(VR) Only “Properties” is possible.
You can edit titles on the DIRECT NAVIGATOR screen:
deleting unwanted parts of titles such as commercials,
changing Thumbnail, dividing and deleting titles, etc.
Title Operations
Delete
HDD BD-RE BD-R RAM -R -R DL -RW(V) +R +R DL
+RW
Use to delete unneeded titles.
Important: Once deleted, contents cannot be recovered.
Perform steps
Accessing the Title View
Press [w] to select “Delete”, then press [OK] to
confirm.
Press [DIRECT NAVIGATOR].
HDD BD-RE RAM When “VIDEO” is not selected,
press the “Red” button to select “VIDEO”.
Press [e, r] to select a title.
– Multiple editing (➔ below, Tips)
Press [OPTION] to display the menu list.
• To view more options
– Press [e, r] to select “Edit”, then press [OK].
• Items that cannot be selected are grey.
Enter Title Name
Set up Protection
HDD BD-RE RAM Deleting an item increases the
available disc space by the amount of space taken by
the item deleted.
• BD-R -R -R DL +R +R DL Available disc space does not
increase after deletion.
• -RW(V) +RW Available disc space increases when you
delete the last title (the recording space may increase
slightly when other titles are deleted).
• Available disc space may not increase after erasing a
short title.
Delete
Divide Title
Properties
Change Thumbnail
Edit
DR File Conversion
Chapter View
Edit or playback the chapter (➔ 56)
To edit the group of titles HDD (➔ 46)
Refer to “Title
operations”
(➔ right).
Switching the DIRECT NAVIGATOR
appearance (➔ 45)
• Playing still pictures (➔ 70)
• Playing music recorded on HDD
(➔ 78)
HDD BD-RE BD-R RAM -R -R DL -RW(V) +R +R DL
+RW -RW(VR)
Title information is shown (e.g., date, time).
Perform steps
−
of “Accessing the Title View” (➔ left).
Press [e, r] to select “Properties”, then press
[OK].
Play
Properties
Delete
Not Going Out
Properties
No.
Date
Channel
Edit
Notes
• Restricted recording information remains even after editing
(e.g. dividing a title etc).
• You cannot edit during recording or copying, etc.
• BD-R +R +R DL Management information is recorded in
unused sections when you edit discs. The available space on
these discs decreases each time you edit their contents.
We recommend that you edit on the HDD and then copy to disc.
Tips
To return to the previous screen
Press [BACK/RETURN ].
To exit the menu screens
Press [DIRECT NAVIGATOR].
To view other pages
Press [u, i].
Editing
Partial Delete
PICTURE / MUSIC
•
Properties
Cancel Protection
Play
All Titles
Notes
Playing Back
Press [DRIVE SELECT] to select the drive.
Release Grouping
of “Accessing the Title View” (➔ left).
Press [e, r] to select “Delete”, then press [OK].
Preparation:
• BD-RE BD-R RAM Release protection (➔ 94, Setting
Protection).
Create Group
−
Chapter View
001
Time
9/ 3/2009 MON Rec time
BBC TWO Wales
22:07
0:04(DR)
OK
Create Group
RETURN
Release Grouping
All Titles
Enter Title Name
HDD BD-RE BD-R RAM -R -R DL -RW(V) +R +R DL
+RW
You can give a name for the title.
Perform steps
−
of “Accessing the Title View” (➔ left).
Press [e, r] to select “Enter Title Name”, then
press [OK].
Entering Text (➔ 84)
– HDD Even if the group name is changed, the title
names in the group will not be changed (➔ 46,
Regarding the group name).
Multiple editing
(Only Delete, Set up Protection/Cancel Protection)
Select with [e, r], then press [h]. (Repeat.)
– A check mark appears. Press [h] again to cancel.
53
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 53
2009/05/13 15:01:11
Titles−Editing
Press [q] (PLAY) and [h] to set the point you want to
divide.
Set up Protection/Cancel Protection
HDD BD-RE BD-R RAM +R +R DL +RW
Use to prevent accidental erasure of titles.
Perform steps
−
Set up Protection
of “Accessing the Title View” (➔ 53).
25/05
01/06 AV
01/06 AV
Important: Once deleted, the parts cannot be recovered.
of “Accessing the Title View” (➔ 53).
Press [e, r] to select “Partial Delete”, then press [OK].
DIRECT NAVIGATOR Partial Delete
Time Remaining 20:08 DR VIDEO PICTURE
HDD
008
PLAY
- -:- -.- OK
RETURN
Press [e, r] to select “Divide”, then press[OK].
– For quicker editing (➔ 55, Tips)
– Selecting “Preview” then pressing [OK] plays the title from
10 seconds prior, to 10 seconds after the division point.
– To change the point to divide at:
Perform steps −
again.
Date
Set up Protection
0:43.21
Divide
DR File Conversion
HDD BD-RE BD-R RAM
Use to remove unwanted parts of titles, such as commercials.
Enter Title Name
Preview
Change Thumbnail
DIRECT NAVIGATOR Group
Time Remain
HDD
MUSIC
Divide
Continue
Divide Title
Partial Delete
−
PLAY
Partial Delete
Press [w] to select “Yes”, then press [OK].
Perform steps
008
Cancel Protection
Press [e, r] to select “Set up Protection” or
“Cancel Protection”, then press [OK].
The lock symbol
appears when the title
is protected.
DIRECT NAVIGATOR Divide Title
Time Remaining 20:08 DR VIDEO PICTURE
HDD
Enter Title Name
MUSIC
8
Press [e, r] to select “Continue”, then press [OK].
9
Press [w] to select “Divide”, then press [OK].
– The title is divided at that point.
Notes
• A short amount of video and audio just before and after
the division point get cut out.
• You cannot divide a title when the resulting parts are too short.
• HDD Divided titles form a group of titles.
Start
End
Cancel Protection
Next
Partial Delete
Continue
Change Thumbnail
0:43.21
Divide Title
Change Thumbnail
OK
DR File Conversion
Start
End
- -:- -.- -
- -:- -.- -
Please set the start
point with playback
operation and skip.
Press RETURN to end Partial Delete function.
RETURN
Press [q] (PLAY) and [h] to set the start point of
the section you want to erase.
Press [e, r] to select “Start”, then press [OK].
8
Press [q] (PLAY) and [h] to set the end point of
the section you want to erase.
9
Press [e, r] to select “End”, then press [OK].
– For quicker editing (➔ 55, Tips)
– To delete multiple sections:
Press [e, r] to select “Next”, and repeat steps
9 .
– Up to 20 sections can be set.
HDD RAM -R -R DL -RW(V) +R +R DL +RW
-R -R DL -RW(V) +R +R DL It is possible to change the
image displayed on the top menu after finalising.
+RW It is possible to change the image displayed on the top
menu after creating Top Menu.
HDD Settings for “Change Thumbnail” is saved when high
speed copy is performed to DVD-R, DVD-R DL, DVD-RW
(DVD-Video format), +R, +R DL or +RW.
Perform steps
−
−
of “Accessing the Title View” (➔ 53).
Press [e, r] to select “Change Thumbnail”, then
press [OK].
Enter Title Name
Press [e, r] to select “Continue”, then press [OK].
Set up Protection
Press [w] to select “Delete”, then press [OK] to confirm.
Cancel Protection
DIRECT NAVIGATOR Change Thumbnail
Time Remaining 20:08 DR VIDEO PICTURE
HDD
Change
Partial Delete
Notes
Divide Title
• You may not be able to specify start and end points
within 3 seconds of each other.
• Available disc space may not increase after erasing
short parts of titles.
DR File Conversion
MUSIC
h
008
Finish
0:00.00
Change
- -:- -.- -
Change Thumbnail
Start play and select the image of
a thumbnail.
OK
RETURN
Divide Title
HDD BD-RE BD-R RAM
You can divide a title into two.
Once divided, titles cannot be recombined.
Perform steps
−
of “Accessing the Title View” (➔ 53).
Press [e, r] to select “Divide Title”, then press [OK].
54
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 54
2009/05/13 15:01:11
Press [e, r] to select “Change”, then press [OK].
– For quicker editing (➔ below, Tips)
– To change the thumbnail:
Perform steps − again.
8
Press [e, r] to select “Finish”, then press [OK].
Tips
For quicker editing
• Use Search (➔ 46) or Time Slip (➔ 47) to find the desired point.
• To skip to the start or end of a title, press [u] (start) or
[i] (end).
• For better precision, use Slow-motion (➔ 46) and
Frame-by-Frame (➔ 47).
DR File Conversion
HDD
DR File Conversion is a function to convert the recording
mode of the title in DR mode. The converted title will be
copied to HDD. It will take about the same time as playback
of the title to convert the recording mode.
Perform steps − of “Accessing the Title View” (➔ 53).
– Select HDD in step .
Press [e, r] to select “DR File Conversion”, then
press [OK].
DR File Conversion
Enter Title Name
Set up Protection
Convert the selected title by changing its recording mode.
Please select recording mode and other options, then press OK.
Cancel Protection
Recording Mode
Partial Delete
Subtitles
Divide Title
Audio Description
Timing
HG -- High Quality
Off
Off
During standby
Change Thumbnail
OK
DR File Conversion
RETURN
Press [w, q] to select the recording mode, then
press [r].
Press [w, q] to select “Automatic” or “Off”, then
press [r].
8
Press [w, q] to select “Automatic” or “Off”, then
press [r].
9
Press [w, q] to select when to start the
conversion, then press [OK].
“Now”
Conversion begins immediately.
Recording and playback are not available
during conversion. Note also that timer
recording will not be performed during
conversion.
Press [w, q] to select “Start”, then press
[OK].
“During standby” The conversion will be performed a short
time after switching off the power in a
time slot for which no timer recording is
set. If the power is switched on during
the conversion, the conversion will be
cancelled, and start from the beginning
when the power is next switched off.
• If a title with the “HD No Copy” or “HD
Copy Once” restriction was selected, the
confirmation screen appears to inform
you that the original title will be deleted
after conversion. Press [w, q] to select
“Yes”, then press [OK].
• To cancel the conversion “During standby”
After performing steps −
Press [w, q] to select “Yes” and press [OK].
• Conversion begins after the unit is put into standby, when
“During standby” is selected.
“COPY” on the unit’s display remains lighted during conversion.
[Only when “Unit’s Display” in the Setup menu is set to “Bright”
(➔ 104).]
When “DR file will be
converted in standby” is
displayed in the
DIRECT NAVIGATOR,
the conversion has not
finished.
DIRECT NAVIGATOR Grouped Titles
Time Remaining 45:54 DR VIDEO PICTURE MUSIC
HDD
Date Channel
Time
Title Name
25/05 BBC 1 Wales 12:36 Born And Bred: A Wrathful
01/06 BBC 1 Wales 1:35
Titles
2
1
1
Rec time
0:00(DR)
DR file will be
converted in
standby
Not viewed
Page 01/01
OK
RETURN
OPTION
VIDEO
Select
PICTURE
MUSIC
Tips
In order to save HDD capacity, it is recommended that you
delete the original titles (in DR mode) after converting, if they
remains after conversion. (➔ 32, Deleting Titles)
Notes
• To use “DR File Conversion”, the HDD needs enough storage
capacity. Please make space available on the HDD.
• The original data (DR mode) with “HD No Copy” or “HD Copy
Once” restriction will be deleted after converting them to HG,
HX, HE or HL mode using “DR File Conversion”. (➔ 34)
The original data remains after conversion if there is no copyrestriction.
• The size of the converted programme may increase for some
combinations of programme and recording mode.
• If the power is switched on during the conversion, the
conversion will be cancelled, and start from the beginning
when the power is next switched off.
• The converted version of a programme including multiple video
and audio content will contain only single video and audio
content. The “Audio Mode for Digital Broadcast” setting in the
Setup menu (➔ 103) is applied.
• During Normal Speed Copy with “Subtitles” set to “Automatic”,
you cannot turn off the subtitle displayed on the television.
• When converting to XP mode, select the audio to record with
“Audio Mode for XP Recording” before converting the recording
mode. (➔ 103)
• Select the audio to record when converting to “HG”, “HX”,
“HE”, or “HL” modes. (➔ 103, Audio Channels for HG/HX/HE/
HL Recording)
• In titles with the Auto Renewal Recording function (➔ 41) set, a
programme may be unintentionally converted while in “During
standby”. So it is recommended to convert the recording mode
by selecting “Now”.
• If converted to the “HG”, “HX”, “HE”, or “HL” mode, an image of
the aspect ratio 4:3 becomes the aspect ratio set in “Aspect for
Recording” in the Setup menu. (➔ 101)
Editing
Press [q] (PLAY) and [h] to set the point you want
to use as the thumbnail.
• Regarding titles recorded from radio service
The data size of the title recorded from radio service will be
larger after converted for copy.
It is recommended that you keep them in DR mode.
55
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 55
2009/05/13 15:01:12
Create/Playback/Edit of the Chapter
HDD BD-RE BD-R RAM
Editing and playing chapters
Creating/Playback/Editing is possible.
Press [DRIVE SELECT] to select the drive.
-R -R DL -RW(V) -RW(VR) +R +R DL +RW
Press [DIRECT NAVIGATOR].
HDD BD-RE RAM When “VIDEO” is not selected, press
Only playback of chapter is possible.
the “Red” button to select “VIDEO”.
Regarding Chapters
Programmes are recorded as a single title consisting
of one chapter.
Press [e, r] to select the title, then press
[OPTION].
Press [e, r] to select “Chapter View”, then press
[OK].
Title
Start
Press [w, q] to select the chapter.
To start play: Press [OK].
To edit: Step .
To create: Press the “Green” button. (➔ below, Create
Chapter)
End
HDD BD-RE BD-R RAM
You can divide a title into multiple chapters. Each
section between the division points (Chapter Marks)
becomes a chapter.
DIRECT NAVIGATOR
Chapter View
Time Remaining 15:08 DR VIDEO
HDD
007
Chapter
Chapter
MUSIC
Press OK to start playing from
the selected chapter.
Selected chapter can be edited
via OPTION.
Press RETURN to go back to
previous menu.
Title
Chapter
PICTURE
Play
SOCCER
Chapter
0:00.00
001
0:00.00
Page 001/001
OK
RETURN
Chapter Mark
OPTION
Select
Chapter View
Edit Chapter Mark
Press [OPTION], then press [e, r] to select the
operation, then press [OK].
• The maximum number of items on a disc:
(Depends on the state of recording.)
HDD : Approx. 1000 per title
BD-RE BD-R RAM :Approx. 1000
Refer to “Chapter
operations” (➔ below).
Delete Chapter
Combine Chapters
Notes
Tips
• HDD You will not be able to perform the Resume play function
(➔ 26) or “Change Thumbnail” (➔ 54) with a title with the maximum
number of chapters.
• HDD Chapter Marks created will be maintained when copied or
used “DR File Conversion”. But, it will not maintain the exceeded
amount if it exceeds the maximum chapter numbers.
To return to the previous screen
Press [BACK/RETURN ].
To exit the screen
Press [EXIT].
Create Chapter Mark
During the playback or pause
Press [CREATE CHAPTER].
Chapter operations
After performing steps − (➔ above)
Select the point where you want to start a
Create
new chapter while viewing the title.
Chapter
– Chapters are divided at the point pressed.
DIRECT NAVIGATOR
Edit Chapter Mark
Time Remaining 15:08 DR VIDEO
HDD
007 SOCCER
PICTURE
MUSIC
Play
To insert chapter position,
press OK at selected time.
Press RETURN to go to
Chapter View.
0:00.00
OK
RETURN
Tips
To delete the Chapter Mark
1. While paused
Press [u, i] and skip to the location you want to delete.
2. Press [CREATE CHAPTER].
3. Press [w, q] to select “Yes”, then press [OK].
56
Chapter View
Edit Chapter Mark
1Press [OK] at the point you want to
divide.
• Repeat this step to divide at other points.
2Press [BACK/RETURN ] to go to
Chapter View screen.
Chapter has been created.
After performing steps
−
(➔ above)
Delete
Chapter
Press [w, q] to select “Delete”, then press [OK].
• Once deleted, the recorded contents are lost
and cannot be restored. Make certain before
proceeding.
• Select “Combine Chapters” (➔ below) when you
only want to delete the division point between
chapters. (The recorded contents will not be
deleted.)
Combine
Chapters
Press [w, q] to select “Combine”, then press
[OK].
• The selected chapter and following chapter are
combined.
Multiple editing (➔ 53) is possible.
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 56
2009/05/13 15:01:12
Copying Titles
There are following copying methods.
Copy Title Playing
Copy
Copy AVCHD
Copy the playing title on the HDD to the disc. (➔ 60)
Make a copying list and then copy.
You can set the unit to copy titles in the way you want. (➔ 61)
High definition video (AVCHD format) can be copied from disc, SD card or USB. (➔ 68)
Copy direction
Copy source
HDD
Copy destination
BD-RE BD-R RAM -R
-R DL -RW(V) +R +R DL
+RW
Possible copying method
Copy Title Playing
Copy
Copy speed
The high speed copy may not be
possible depending on the
destination disc or the title to copy.
(➔ 59, When is high speed copy
not possible?)
BD-RE
BD-R
HDD
Copy
Normal speed
RAM
-RW(VR)
HDD
Copy
High speed
+RW
HDD
Copy
Normal speed
HDD
Copy
Normal speed
HDD
RAM
Copy
High speed
Before finalise
-R
-R DL
-RW(V)
+R
+R DL
Cannot copy
DVD-V
SD Video (MPEG2 format)
From an SD card or
Panasonic’s video camera,
etc. (from USB)
HD Video (AVCHD format)
From discs
HD Video (AVCHD format)
From an SD card or
Panasonic’s video camera,
etc. (from USB)
BD-RE BD-R -R -R DL
-RW(V) +R +R DL +RW
Cannot copy
HDD
Copy AVCHD
High speed
HDD
BD-RE BD-R
Copy AVCHD
High speed
RAM -R -R DL -RW(V)
+R +R DL +RW
Copying
-R
-R DL
-RW(V)
+R
+R DL
Editing
After finalise
Cannot copy
Almost all DVD-Video on sale have been treated to prevent illegal copying. Any software that has been so treated cannot be recorded using this unit.
57
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 57
2009/05/13 15:01:13
Copying Titles
Copy speed
( : Possible, –: Impossible)
Features
High speed mode
Normal speed mode
Copy with shorter time than the recorded time of the
title with same quality (recording mode).
It will take same or longer time as the recorded time
of the titles to be copied.
Even if you select a recording mode with better
picture quality than the original, the picture quality
does not improve.
Are chapters maintained?
Are thumbnails
maintained?
Recording and Playing
while Copying
1
1
2
–
3
Position of the chapter might shift slightly.
It will not maintain the exceeded amount if it exceeds the maximum chapter numbers on a disc.
– BD-RE BD-R RAM -R -R DL -RW(V) : Approx. 1000
– +R +R DL +RW : Approx. 254
(Depends on the state of recording.)
2
Position of the thumbnails might shift slightly. (May not be maintained depending on the state of recording.)
3
Possible only with titles on the HDD
[However it is not possible when copying with finalisation/creating top menu or when copying SD Video (MPEG2 format) or when
copying HD Video (AVCHD format).]
–You cannot perform chasing play or edit, etc. while copying.
–Still pictures or music cannot be played.
1
Copying speed when copying from the HDD to BD-R in High Speed Copy
Approx.
Recording Mode
HL
HDD
Recorded programme
1 hour
q
6X Speed BD-R (DL, 50 GB/SL, 25 GB)
Required time
Speed
1 min. 24s.
43x
Notes
• The above rate in the list indicates the shortest time and fastest speed required for copying one-hour title from HDD to the disc
by High-Speed copying.
• The required amount of time and speed may vary depending on the conditions such as the area where information is written or
unique feature on the disc.
Copy restrictions
Some programmes on freesat channels are copy-restricted and the number of times you can copy in DR, HG, HX, HE, HL mode
is assigned by the broadcaster.
0
Titles with the “HD No Copy” restriction
You cannot select High Speed, HG, HX, HE, HL mode when copying to BD-RE or BD-R.
1
Titles with the “HD Copy Once” restriction
After copying in High Speed, HG, HX, HE, HL to BD-RE or BD-R, the original title and the copied one will be indicated with the icon 0
You cannot copy from them in high definition quality (DR, HG, HX, HE, HL) any more.
.
Copying list icons and functions
Depending on the icon, you may be informed about the on-screen display.
Titles that cannot be copied in high speed mode
1
Titles that can be copied in HD quality once
0
Titles that cannot be copied in HD quality
anymore
Titles with guidance information (➔ 34, Parental
Control) or titles recorded from channels with
child lock (➔ 99, Child Lock)
You have to enter your PIN when you select
these titles.
Title contains still picture(s).
• Still picture(s) cannot be copied.
Title recorded using a different encoding system
from that of the TV system currently selected on
(NTSC) the unit.
(PAL)
• Titles displaying these marks cannot be
selected.
58
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 58
2009/05/13 15:01:13
Frequently Asked Questions
When is high speed copy not possible?
It will copy at normal speed in following cases:
Copying XP, SP, LP, EP or FR mode title to BD-RE BD-R
Copying to RAM -R -R DL -RW(V) +R +R DL +RW in following conditions:
– Titles in DR, HG, HX, HE, HL mode
– Title of the AVCHD copied to the HDD
Copying to -R -R DL -RW(V) +R +R DL +RW in following conditions:
– Copy including a title that was recorded to HDD with “Recording Format for DVD” set to
“VR format”
– Titles that contain many deleted segments.
– Titles that have been copied to the HDD from an SD card or a Panasonic’s video camera,
etc. with HDD (SD Video) (➔ 69).
– +R +R DL +RW Titles recorded in “EP” mode and “FR (recordings 5 hours or longer)”
mode.
– +R +R DL +RW Titles recorded in 16:9 aspect
– -R -R DL -RW(V) Titles recorded in 16:9 aspect using “EP” mode or “FR (recordings
5 hours or longer)” mode
Setting “Recording Mode” to anything but “High Speed”
Copying from BD-RE, BD-R, +RW to HDD
-R -R DL -RW(V) +R +R DL When copying from the finalised disc to HDD
When copying titles in high speed mode
to high speed recording compatible discs
The sound of the disc rotating becomes louder than normal.
If you want copy to perform more quietly, select “Normal (Silent)” in “BD/DVD Speed for High
Speed Copy” in the Setup menu (➔ 101).
-R -R DL -RW(V) +R +R DL +RW
When not copying in high speed mode, titles are temporarily copied at normal speed to the
HDD and then copied at high speed to the disc. The titles that were temporarily copied to the
HDD are then deleted.
You cannot copy to the disc in the following cases.
– When there is not enough free space on the HDD. (When copying to a new blank disc, if
you intend to fill a new disc when copying to it, the equivalent of up to 4 hours of free
space in SP mode is needed on the HDD.)
– When the number of titles recorded to the HDD and the number of titles to be copied to
the disc is greater than 499 in total.
When copying to disc in normal speed
mode
When stopping the copy during copy
When High-speed copying
All titles that have completely copied at the point cancelled are copied.
When Normal Speed copying
Copies until the point cancelled.
Copying
-R -R DL -RW(V) +R +R DL +RW If copy is cancelled during the step while
temporarily copying to the HDD, then nothing will be copied. However, if copy is cancelled
during the step while copying to disc from the HDD, then only titles completely copied at the
point cancelled are copied.
Even if the title was not copied to the BD-R, DVD-R, DVD-R DL, DVD-RW (DVD-Video
format), +R, +R DL or +RW, the amount of remaining writable disc space becomes less.
Is it possible to copy to the disc, SD card,
or USB memory after copying HD video
(AVCHD format) to the HDD?
It can be copied to the disc.
– BD-RE BD-R It can be copied with HD quality.
– RAM -R -R DL -RW(V) +R +R DL +RW It will be copied with SD quality. (It
cannot be copied as it is in HD picture quality.)
It cannot be copied to SD card or USB memory.
MPEG-2 or AVCHD files are not
recognised
Only MPEG-2 or AVCHD on a Panasonic’s video camera, etc. will be recognised. MPEG-2
or AVCHD copied to USB memory or an SD card will not be recognised.
Regarding titles recorded in DR mode
from radio service
Picture data will be added to the titles recorded in DR mode from radio service when
copying them in HG, HX, HE, HL, XP, SP, LP, EP, FR mode or converting them to these
recording modes using “DR File Conversion”. Therefore, the data size will be larger after
copying or “DR File Conversion”.
– If you are going to copy the titles to disc with least audio degradation
It is recommended that you select LP mode.
– If you are going to copy the titles to disc with least data size
It is recommended that you select them to EP (8 hours) mode.
Title recorded from radio service cannot be copied in DR mode.
59
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 59
2009/05/13 15:01:14
Copying Titles
Copy Title Playing
Copy the playing title on the HDD to the disc.
• It will start copying from the beginning of the title
regardless of the playing position.
Speed and recording mode when copying
Titles in DR, HG, HX, HE or HL mode
Copy destination
Copy speed
Recording mode
BD-RE BD-R
High speed
Same as title to be
copied 1
RAM
-R -R DL -RW(V)
+R +R DL +RW
Normal speed
HDD → BD-RE BD-R RAM -R -R DL -RW(V) +R +R DL
+RW
Playback the title to copy.
1
1
FR
When copying over the available space on the disc, one from HG,
HX, HE or HL modes will be selected to match the available space,
and it will be copied with normal speed.
Titles in XP, SP, LP, EP or FR mode
Copy destination
Copy speed
Recording mode
BD-RE BD-R
Normal speed
Recording mode of
playing back title 1
RAM
High speed
1
Same as title to be
copied 1
-R -R DL -RW(V)
+R +R DL +RW
High speed
1
When copying the title in DR mode with multiple
audio and subtitles
BD-RE BD-R
– When copying at high speed, audio and
subtitles can be copied as is.
– When copying at normal speed, only the audio
selected in “Multi Audio/AD” in the Disc menu
will be copied for the multiple audio. (➔ 88)
– When copying at normal speed, subtitle
displayed during playback will be copied.
(➔ 47)
RAM -R -R DL -RW(V) +R +R DL +RW
– Only the audio selected in “Multi Audio/AD” in
the Disc menu will be copied for the multiple
audio. (➔ 88)
– Subtitle displayed during playback will be
copied. (➔ 47)
e, r to select “Copy Title
Playing”, then
1
2
2
Same as title to be
copied 1
When the copy destination (disc) does not have enough space,
copy will perform at normal speed in FR mode.
Titles that were recorded with “Recording Format for DVD” (➔ 101)
set to “VR format” will be copied with normal speed. In the
following cases, even if “Recording Format for DVD” is set to
“Video format”, copy will perform at normal speed.
+R +R DL +RW When the copying source was recorded in “EP”
or “FR (recordings 5 hours or longer)” mode.
When the copy destination (disc) does not have enough space.
When the title aspect for the copying source and “Aspect for
Recording” do not match.
When the title aspect for the copying source is 16:9:
– +R +R DL +RW
– -R -R DL -RW(V) copying source was recorded in “EP” or
“FR (recordings 5 hours or longer)” mode.
To play DVD-R, DVD-R DL, DVD-RW (DVD-Video format), +R
and +R DL on other players, it is necessary to finalise them after
copy (➔ 96). To play +RW on other players, we recommend you
“Create Top Menu” (➔ 96), but they may not play on all DVD
players.
w, q to select “Start”, then
Tips
To stop copying
Press and hold [BACK/RETURN ] for 3 seconds.
To return to the previous screen
Press [BACK/RETURN ].
Recording and playing while copying
You can record and play using the HDD while high speed copying.
• Still pictures and music recorded on the HDD cannot be played.
• To confirm the current progress
Press [STATUS ].
60
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 60
2009/05/13 15:01:14
Set other settings.
Copying using the copying list
—Copy
– If you are not going to change these settings, press [r]
twice (➔ step )
Press [e, r] to select “Other Settings”, then press [q].
“Subtitles”
(Only when copying titles in DR mode and the recording
mode other than High Speed is selected)
Press [e, r] to select “Subtitles”, then press [OK].
Press [e, r] to select “Automatic” or “Off”, then press [OK].
• If “Automatic” is selected
Subtitle selected in “Preferred Subtitles” in the Setup
menu (➔ 99) will be copied. (The copied subtitle cannot
be switched during playback.)
• If “Off” is selected
Subtitle in the source titles will not be copied.
“Finalise” or “Create Top Menu”
HDD ↔ BD-RE BD-R RAM +RW
-RW(VR) → HDD
HDD → -R -R DL -RW(V) +R +R DL
You can order titles as desired for copy to disc.
Press [FUNCTION MENU].
Press [e, r] to select “Copy”, then press [OK].
FUNCTION MENU
30:00 DR
Copy
Playback
Recording
Cancel All
Source
Delete
HDD
Direction
1 Copy
HDD
BD / DVD
Copy
Destination
TV Guide
2
Copy Mode
3
Create List
Others
OK
VIDEO High Speed
BD / DVD
Information of the copy destination
( HDD → -R -R DL -RW(V) +R +R DL +RW only)
Press [e, r] to select “Finalise” or “Create Top Menu”,
then press [OK].
Press [e, r] to select “On” or “Off”, then press [OK].
If “On” is selected
– -R -R DL -RW(V) +R +R DL After finalising, the
discs become play-only and you can also play them on other
DVD equipment. However, you can no longer record or edit.
– +RW Create the Top Menu. Top Menu is a convenient
function. We recommend you create the menu before
playing a +RW disc on other equipment.
“Audio Description”
(Normal Speed Copy only)
- DVD-RAM
- Copy restricted title can be
copied on to disc
0
RETURN
Start Copying
Select the copy direction.
RETURN
– If you are not going to change each setting, press [r]
several times (➔ step ).
Set the copy direction.
– If you are not going to change the copying direction, press
[r] (➔ step ).
Press [e, r] to select “Copy Direction”, then press [q].
Press [e, r] to select “Source”, then press [OK].
Press [e, r] to select the drive, then press [OK].
If you select “HDD”, “Destination” is automatically set to
“BD/DVD” or vice versa. (➔ step )
Press [e, r] to select “Destination”, then press [OK].
Press [e, r] to select the drive, then press [OK].
The same drive as the copy source cannot be selected.
Press [w] to confirm.
Press [e, r] to select “Audio Description”, then press [OK].
Press [e, r] to select “Automatic” or “Off”, then press [OK].
• If “Automatic” is selected
If title recorded in DR mode includes Audio Description,
the title will be copied with Audio Description.
• If “Off” is selected
Title recorded in DR mode will be copied without Audio
Description.
Set the recording mode.
– If you are not going to change the recording mode, press
[r] twice (➔ step ).
Press [e, r] to select “Copy Mode”, then press [q].
Press [e, r] to select “Format”, then press [OK].
Press [e, r] to select “VIDEO”, then press [OK].
Press [e, r] to select “Recording Mode”, then press
[OK].
Press [e, r] to select the mode, then press [OK].
Press [w] to confirm.
Register titles for copy.
– If you are going to copy a registered list without making
any changes to it, press [r] twice (➔ step ).
Press [e, r] to select “Create List”, then press [q].
Press [w] to confirm.
Press [e, r] to select “Start Copying”, then press [OK].
8 Press [w] to select “Yes”, then press [OK] to start copying.
Copying
HDD
Time Remaining
Edit the copying list
Select the item after step
Press [OPTION].
–
(➔ left).
Delete All
Add
Delete
Move
Copy
Cancel All
Direction
1 Copy
HDD
BD / DVD
2
Copy Mode
3
Create List
Destination Capacity: 4366 MB
Size:
0 MB ( 0%)
No.
Title
Size
New item (Total=0)
Delete All
VIDEO High Speed
0
Start Copying
OK
OPTION
Page 01/01
Create copy list.
RETURN
Press [e, r] to select “New item”, then press [OK].
Press [e, r] to select the title, then press [h].
A check mark is displayed. Repeat this step until you
select all necessary items.
– Press [h] again to cancel.
– The items will be copied in the order of the copying list.
If you want to specify the order, repeat selecting one
item at a time.
– To view other pages
Press [u, i].
Press [OK].
– To edit the copying list (➔ right)
You cannot start copying when the value of the “Size”
exceeds 100% (“Destination Capacity” is not sufficient)
(➔ 62, About the data size for copying).
Press [w] to confirm.
Add
Delete
Move
Delete all items registered on the copying list.
1. Press [e, r] to select “Delete All”, then
press [OK].
2. Press [w, q] to select “Yes”, then press [OK].
Add new items to the copying list.
1. Press [e, r] to select “Add”, then press [OK].
2. Press [e, r] to select the title, then press
[h].
A check mark is displayed. Repeat this
step until you select all necessary items.
• Press [h] again to cancel.
3. Press [OK].
Delete the selected items.
1. Press [e, r] to select “Delete”, then press [OK].
2. Press [w, q] to select “Yes”, then press [OK].
Move selected items or change the order of
items on the copying list.
1. Press [e, r] to select “Move”, then press [OK].
2. Press [e, r] to select the destination, then
press [OK].
61
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 61
2009/05/13 15:01:14
Copying Titles
Cancel all registered copying setting and lists
After performing steps
−
(➔ 61)
Press [e, r] to select “Cancel All”, then press
[OK].
Press [w] to select “Yes”, then press [OK].
• The settings and lists may be cancelled in the following
situations.
– When a title, still picture, etc. has been recorded or deleted
at the copy source
– When steps have been taken, for instance, to turn off
the unit, remove the card open the tray, change the copy
direction, etc.
About the data size for copying
Data size of each registered item
Destination Capacity: 4343MB
Size:
0MB (0%)
No.
Title
Size
New item (Total=0)
Page 01/01
Data size recorded to the copy destination
• When copying at normal speed, the
total data size will change according to
the recording mode.
• The total data size shown may be
larger than the sum of the data sizes
for each registered item, because of
data management information being
written to the copy destination, etc.
To check the properties of a title and sort Copying list
After performing − (➔ 61)
Press [e, r] to select the title, then press
[OPTION].
Properties
Sort
Tips
To return to the previous screen in steps
Press [BACK/RETURN ].
–
To view other pages in step −
Press [u, i].
While copying (after step 8 )
To stop copying
Press and hold [BACK/RETURN ] for 3 seconds.
(You cannot stop while finalising.)
When you stop High-speed copying
All titles that have completely copied at the point
cancelled are copied.
When you stop Normal Speed copying
Copies until the point cancelled.
– -R -R DL -RW(V) +R +R DL +RW If copy is cancelled
during the step while temporarily copying to the
HDD, then nothing will be copied. However, if copy is
cancelled during the step while copying to disc from
the HDD, then only titles completely copied at the
point cancelled are copied.
Even if the title was not copied to the BD-R, DVD-R,
DVD-R DL, DVD-RW (DVD-Video format), +R, +R DL
or +RW, the amount of remaining writable disc space
becomes less.
Recording and playing while copying
You can record or play using the HDD while high
speed copying. (Only when high speed copying without
finalising or creating Top Menu)
– Still pictures and music recorded on the HDD cannot be
played.
Press [OK] to cancel the screen display.
– To confirm the current progress
Press [STATUS ].
Grouped Titles
Press [e, r] to select “Properties” or “Sort”, then
press [OK].
Properties:
The name, recording date, channel etc. of the selected title are
shown. (You cannot select this item if a title has a check mark.)
Sort (All Titles screen only):
Press [e, r] to select the item, then press [OK].
This changes the way that titles are displayed. You can select to
display titles by No., Date, Day, Channel, Start Time and Title Name.
(You cannot select this item if a title has a check mark.) If you close
the Copying list screen, the display order is cancelled.
Notes
• Titles in the grouped titles and other titles cannot be
registered simultaneously.
• To play DVD-R, DVD-R DL, DVD-RW (DVD-Video
format), +R and +R DL on other players, it is necessary
to finalise them after copy. To play +RW on other
players, we recommend you “Create Top Menu” (➔ 94), but
they may not play on all DVD players.
62
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 62
2009/05/13 15:01:15
8
When the top menu is displayed
Press [e, r, w, q] to select the title you want to
start copying, then press [OK].
My favourite
DVD-V → HDD
You can copy the content of finalised DVD-R, DVD-R DL,
DVD-RW (DVD-Video format), +R, and +R DL to the HDD
and re-edit the content copied to the HDD.
While playing a disc, the content being played is copied to the
HDD according to the set time.
• When “Recording Format for DVD” (➔ 101) is set to “Video
format” and you make a copy, the copy will be made using
the picture size selected in “Aspect for Recording” (➔ 101)
of the Setup menu.
• Operations and on screen displays during copy are
also recorded.
• Almost all DVD-Video on sale have been treated to prevent
illegal copying, and cannot be copied.
• The following cannot be copied:, Video CD, Audio CD and
so on.
Preparation:
• Insert the finalised disc (➔ 117).
After performing steps − (“Format” is automatically set to
“DVD-Video”) (➔ 61, Copying using the copying list−Copy)
Set “Copy Time”.
– If you are not going to change the setting
(➔ step ).
Setting the unit to copy according to the set time
Press [e, r] to select “Copy Time”, then press [q].
Press [e, r] to select “Time Setting”, then press [OK].
– Setting the unit to copy all the content on the disc
Press [e, r] to select “Off”, then press [OK].
Press [w] to confirm.
Copy will continue until there is not enough available
recording space on the HDD.
– Setting the copying time
Press [e, r] to select “On”, then press [OK].
Press [e, r] to select “Copy Time”, then press [OK].
01/02
01
Chapter 1
02
Chapter 2
03
Chapter 3
04
Chapter 4
05
06
While playing in order, all the titles after the selected
title are recorded until the set time. (After the last
title on the disc has finished playing the top menu is
recorded until the set time is reached.)
Tips
To return to the previous screen in steps
Press [BACK/RETURN ].
−
To stop copying after step
Press [g].
You can also press and hold [BACK/RETURN ] for 3
seconds to stop copying.
• If stopped partway, copying will be up to that point.
Notes
• The screen on the right is recorded at the beginning.
• The content is recorded as 1 title from the start of copy to
the end.
• If play does not begin automatically
or if the top menu does not display
automatically, press [q] (PLAY) to start.
• Even if you copy a high quality video/audio
DVD, the original picture and audio quality
cannot be exactly replicated.
• If you want to copy a title from a DVD-RW (DVD Video
Recording format), create a copying list and then copy (➔
61, Copying using the copying list−Copy).
Copying
Copying a finalised DVD-R, DVD-R DL,
DVD-RW (DVD-Video format), +R and +R
DL
Copy
Cancel All
Direction
1 Copy
BD / DVD
HDD
2
Copy Mode
3
Copy Time
2
Hour
00
Min.
DVD-Video SP
Set the time a few minutes longer.
2:00
Press [w, q] to select “Hour” or “Min.”, then press
[e, r] to set the recording time.
Press [OK].
Press [w] to confirm.
Copying to the HDD continues for the set time even
after the content being played finishes.
– Set a few minutes longer than the source title, in order to
include the operation time before play begins.
Press [e, r] to select “Start Copying”, then press
[OK].
Press [w] to select “Yes”, then press [OK] to start
copying.
– The disc top menu is displayed.
– Disc play automatically begins from title 1 when “Title 1” is
selected from the “Auto-Play Select” menu when finalising
the disc (➔ 96).
63
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 63
2009/05/13 15:01:16
Recording from a Satellite or Cable Receiver
HDD
Manual Recording
Preparation:
• Connect a satellite or cable receiver to this unit’s
input terminals (➔ 112).
• When the output signal from the external
equipment is NTSC, change the “TV System” to
“NTSC” in the Setup menu (➔ 104).
With the unit stopped
Linked timer recordings with
external equipment (SKY Digital
STB, satellite/cable receiver)–EXT LINK
To record programmes from a SKY Digital STB,
satellite/cable receiver using timer programming
Preparation:
• Make sure you connect the AV2 input terminal of this
unit to “VCR Scart Terminal” of a SKY Digital STB,
satellite/cable receiver with a 21-pin scart cable (➔ 112).
• Set the “AV2 Input” and “Ext Link” to match the
connected equipment in the Setup menu (➔ 105).
to select “AV2” for the
Make timer programming on SKY
Digital STB, satellite/cable
receiver.
satellite or cable receiver you
have connected.
to select the HDD drive.
– Refer to the equipment’s operating instructions.
to select the HDD drive.
to select the recording mode.
–DR, HG, HX, HE, HL, FR mode cannot be
selected.
– “EXT-L” lights on the unit’s display to indicate
timer recording standby has been activated.
– The guidance information of EXT LINK appears.
Select the channel on the satellite
or cable receiver.
to start recording.
Tips
To skip unwanted parts
Press [h] to pause recording. (Press again to restart recording.)
To stop recording
Press [g].
Tips
To set external link standby using the FUNCTION MENU display
Perform step
(➔ above)
1. Press [FUNCTION MENU].
2. Press [e, r] to select “Others”, then press [OK].
3. Press [e, r] to select “Ext Link Standby”, then press [OK].
4. Press [w, q] to select “Yes”, then press [OK].
To cancel the external control
Turn on this unit.
Press [EXT LINK] to stop recording or to cancel linked timer
recording standby (“EXT-L” disappears.).
Notes
64
• During EXT LINK standby mode or recording, you cannot press
[INPUT SELECT] to select external input other than AV2.
• In order to prevent accidental operation, press [EXT LINK] to cancel
the setting after recording is finished.
• This function does not work when “TV System” is set to “NTSC” in
the Setup menu (➔ 104).
• This function does not work with some equipment. Refer to the
equipment’s operating instructions.
• The beginnings of recordings may not be recorded correctly in
some cases.
• When “Ext Link” is set to “Ext Link 2”, this function does not work if
the input signal is NTSC system.
• Programmes are recorded as one title on this unit when the end
time of the earlier timer recording and the start time of the later
timer recording are close to each other.
To divide the titles, go to “Divide Title” (➔ 54).
• While the unit is in EXT LINK standby mode or recording, AV1
output terminal outputs the signal which is input from the AV2 input
terminal irrespective of “AV1 Output” setting (➔ 105).
• EXT LINK recording is available on HDD only.
• During EXT LINK standby mode or recording, playback is available
on both HDD and BD drive. However, during EXT LINK recording,
BD-Video, still pictures or music cannot be played back.
• When “EXT-L” lights on the unit’s display, Direct TV Recording is
unavailable.
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 64
2009/05/13 15:01:17
Recording from an External Device
Tips
To skip unwanted parts
Press [ h ] to pause recording. (Press again to restart recording.)
This unit
AV3 IN
DV IN
S VIDEO
VIDEO
L/MONO - AUDIO- R
To stop recording
Press [ g].
The confirmation screen appears. Press [OK].
Notes
DV cable
(IEEE 1394, 4-pin)
S Video
cable
Audio/Video
cable
Other video equipment
Connect to Audio/Video output terminals.
The S VIDEO terminal achieves a more vivid picture than the
VIDEO terminal.
• If the audio output of the external device is monaural, connect to
L/MONO on the AV3 input terminals at the front.
• If DV cable is connected, the S Video and Audio/Video cable are
not required.
• When timer recording starts while recording from an external
device, timer recording takes priority. Recording from the external
device stops:
– When a timer recording from an external device starts.
– When another timer recording using this unit’s tuner starts.
• If video is copied from another piece of equipment to this unit, then
the video quality will be degraded.
• Almost all videos and DVD-Video on sale have been treated to
prevent illegal copying. Any software that has been so treated
cannot be recorded using this unit.
• During EXT LINK standby mode or recording, you cannot press
[INPUT SELECT] to select external input other than AV2.
Recording from a VCR, etc.
HDD
Preparation:
• Press [DRIVE SELECT] to select the HDD drive.
• When the output signal from the external device is
NTSC, change the “TV System” to “NTSC” in the
Setup menu (➔ 104).
a few times to select the
input where your external device
is connected, then
With Other
Equipment
– Select “AV3” for connection with S Video or
Audio/Video cable.
– Select “DV” for connection with DV cable.
a few times to select the
recording mode.
– DR, HG, HX, HE, HL, FR mode cannot be
selected.
Start play on the external device.
at the point you want to
start recording.
65
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 65
2009/05/13 15:01:17
Recording from an External Device
Recording from a DV Camcorder
HDD BD-RE BD-R RAM -R -RW(V) +R +RW
Preparation:
• Turn on this unit.
• If you record to a disc, insert a disc (➔ 117).
• BD-RE RAM If the disc is protected, release
protection (➔ 94).
• When the output signal from the external device is
NTSC, change the “TV System” to “NTSC” in the
Setup menu (➔ 104).
• This unit connects to DV camcorder with DV cable.
Turn on the DV equipment and
pause play at the point you want
to start recording.
The following screen appears.
DV Automatic Recording
Notes
• Only one piece of DV equipment (e.g., Panasonic’s video camera,
etc.) can be connected to the unit via the DV input terminal.
• It is not possible to operate the unit from the connected DV
equipment.
• The DV input on this unit is for use with DV equipment only.
(It cannot be connected to a computer, etc.)
• The DV equipment name may not be shown correctly.
• Depending on the DV equipment, the images or audio may not be
input properly.
• Date and time information is not recorded, even if displayed on the
DV camcorder.
• You cannot record and play simultaneously.
-R It may not be able to record after repeating about 30 times of
step
or recording or editing.
-R -RW(V) After finalising, chapters for every 5 minutes will be
created.
+R After finalising, chapters for every 8 minutes will be created.
+RW Regardless of creating the top menu, chapters for every 8
minutes will be created.
Tips
When recording finishes
The confirmation screen appears.
Press [OK] to finish DV camcorder recording.
Record from the DV unit?
Rec to HDD
Rec to Blu-ray Disc/DVD
To stop recording
Press [■].
The confirmation screen appears. Press [OK].
OK
RETURN
When the screen does not appear
If the DV camcorder recording function does not work properly, check
the connections and DV equipment settings, and turn the unit off and
back on. If that does not work, follow the instructions on page 65.
Perform step
(➔ above).
1. Press [FUNCTION MENU].
2. Press [e, r] to select “Others”, then press [OK].
3. Press [e, r] to select “DV Automatic Recording”, then press
[OK].
You can proceed to step
(➔ below).
e, r to select “Rec to HDD” or
“Rec to Blu-ray Disc/DVD”, then
– It may take a while for the next screen to
display while preparing to record.
to select the recording mode.
– DR, HG, HX, HE, HL, FR mode cannot be
selected.
w to select “Start”, then
66
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 66
2009/05/13 15:01:18
Recording via AV3 Input
Flexible Recording via AV Input
BD-RE BD-R RAM -R -RW(V) +R +RW
HDD
It is possible to record to disc from equipment
connected to the AV3 input terminals.
Recording mode is FR mode.
The title is recorded to the size of a new DVD (4.7GB)
by automatically selecting optimal quality betwen XP
and EP (8 hours).
Preparation:
• Press [DRIVE SELECT] to select the BD drive.
Select “BD” for any discs.
• When the output signal from the external
equipment is NTSC, change “TV System” to
“NTSC” in the Setup menu (➔ 104).
Preparation:
• When the output signal from the external
equipment is NTSC, change “TV System” to
“NTSC” in the Setup menu (➔ 104).
With the unit stopped
With the unit stopped
e, r to select “Others”, then
e, r to select “Others”, then
e, r to select “Flexible Recording
via AV Input”, then
e, r to select “Recording via
AV3 Input”, then
– It may take a while for the next screen to
display while preparing to record.
– It may take a while for the next screen to
display while preparing to record.
Flexible Recording via AV input
Record in FR mode.
Maximum recording time
8 hour 00 min.
Recording via AV3 input
Set recording time
Please set recording time. Record in FR mode.
OK
8 Hour
00 Min.
Start
Cancel
Maximum recording time
RETURN
8 hour 00 min.
Set recording time
8 Hour
00 Min.
Start
Cancel
w, q to select “Hour” and “Min.”
and e, r to set the recording time.
RETURN
w, q to select “Hour” and “Min.”
and e, r to set the recording time.
– You can also set the recording time with the
numbered buttons.
– You can also set the recording time with the
numbered buttons.
Start play on the other equipment.
Start play on the other equipment.
With Other
Equipment
OK
When you want to start recording,
w, q to select “Start”, then
When you want to start recording,
w, q to select “Start”, then
Tips
Tips
To return to the previous screen without recording
Press [BACK/RETURN ].
To exit the screen without recording
Press [EXIT].
To stop recording partway
Press [g].
To show the remaining time
Press [STATUS ].
Notes
-R It may not be able to record after repeating about 30 times of
step
recording or editing.
-R -RW(V) After finalising, chapters for every 5 minutes will be created.
+R After finalising, chapters for every 8 minutes will be created.
+RW Regardless of top menu, chapters for every 8 minutes will be created.
To return to the previous screen without recording
Press [BACK/RETURN ].
To exit the screen without recording
Press [EXIT].
To stop recording partway
Press [g].
To show the remaining time
Press [STATUS ].
Notes
You cannot record more than 8 hours.
67
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 67
2009/05/13 15:01:18
Copying HD Video (AVCHD format)
It is possible to copy the HD video (AVCHD format)
recorded on the Panasonic’s video camera, etc. to the
HDD or disc.
From an SD card or Discs
AVCHD
AVCHD
From a video equipment
HDD of Panasonic’s video camera, etc. p HDD BD-RE BD-R
You cannot playback HD Video in the HDD of Panasonic’s video camera, etc. with this unit.
You must copy the files to the HDD or disc.
(Disc) p HDD
(SD card) p HDD BD-RE BD-R
HDD
HDD
BD-RE BD-R
HDD
BD-RE BD-R
Insert a disc or card.
Preparation:
• Turn on both this unit and the Panasonic’s video camera, etc.
e.g., SD
SD Card
Play Video ( AVCHD )
Copy Video ( AVCHD )
Copy Video ( MPEG2 )
Play Pictures ( JPEG )
Copy Pictures ( JPEG )
SD card is inserted.
Display items differ
depending on what
is recorded in each
media.
OK
RETURN
e, r to select “Copy Video
(AVCHD)”, then
Connect the Panasonic’s video
camera, etc. to this unit.
Select the appropriate mode that makes
the Panasonic’s video camera, etc. ready
for data transfer (such as “PC CONNECT”)
on the Panasonic’s video camera, etc.
– Refer to the camera’s operating instructions for detail.
When copying from an SD card
USB device
Copy Video ( AVCHD )
e, r to select “Copy to HDD” or
“Copy to Blu-ray Disc”, then
Copy Video ( MPEG2 )
Play Pictures ( JPEG )
Copy Pictures ( JPEG )
Play / Copy Music ( MP3 )
USB device is inserted.
Display items differ
depending on what
is recorded in the
USB device.
OK
e, r to select the title, then
– A check mark is displayed. Repeat this step
until you select all necessary titles.
• Press [h] again to cancel. (All the recordings
on the same date become a title.)
w, q to select “Start”, then
RETURN
e, r to select “Copy Video
(AVCHD)”, then
e, r to select “Copy to HDD” or
“Copy to Blu-ray Disc”, then
e, r to select the title, then
– A check mark is displayed. Repeat this step
until you select all necessary titles.
• Press [h] again to cancel. (All the recordings
on the same date become a title.)
w, q to select “Start”, then
Tips
Notes
To stop copying
Press and hold [BACK/RETURN ] for 3 seconds.
• Record, playback or timer recording cannot be executed while copying.
• Copy cannot be executed while recording or playback.
• An AVCHD title with more than 100 scenes will be divided into titles
every 99th scene and copied.
• Copied video will be displayed as “AVCHD” in the “Channel” column
of the DIRECT NAVIGATOR screen.
• Depending on the recording condition with the high definition camera, scenes
recorded on same day might have different titles (“-1”, “-2” appended to date).
• See the instructions of the equipment used to record.
68
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 68
2009/05/13 15:01:18
Copying SD Video (MPEG2 format)
It is possible to copy the SD video (MPEG2 format)
recorded on the Panasonic’s video camera, etc. to the
HDD or disc.
From a video equipment
HDD of Panasonic’s video camera, etc. p HDD RAM
(All the recordings on the same date become a title.)
From an SD card
SD p HDD RAM
(All the recordings on the same date become a title.)
HDD
DVD-RAM
HDD
DVD-RAM
Insert a card.
USB connection cable
(specified cable such as accessory of
the USB equipment)
SD Card
Play Video ( AVCHD )
Copy Video ( AVCHD )
Copy Video ( MPEG2 )
Play Pictures ( JPEG )
Copy Pictures ( JPEG )
SD card is inserted.
OK
Preparation:
• Turn on both this unit and the Panasonic’s video
camera, etc.
RETURN
– Display items differ depending on what is
recorded in the card.
e, r to select “Copy Video
(MPEG2)”, then
e, r to select “Start Copying”,
then
SD Video on an SD card are automatically
registered on the copy list.
Connect the Panasonic’s video
camera, etc. to this unit.
Select the appropriate mode that
makes the Panasonic’s video
camera, etc. ready for data transfer
(such as “PC CONNECT”) on the
Panasonic’s video camera, etc.
– Refer to the camera’s operating instructions
for detail.
w, q to select “Yes”, then
USB device
Copy Video ( AVCHD )
Copy Video ( MPEG2 )
Play Pictures ( JPEG )
Copy Pictures ( JPEG )
Play / Copy Music ( MP3 )
USB device is inserted.
OK
RETURN
With Other
Equipment
– Display items differ depending on what is
recorded in the USB device.
e, r to select “Copy Video
(MPEG2)”, then
e, r to select “Start Copying”,
then
SD Video on the Panasonic’s video camera, etc.
are automatically registered on the copy list.
w, q to select “Yes”, then
Tips
To stop copying
Press and hold [BACK/RETURN ] for 3 seconds.
Notes
• You cannot playback SD Video on an SD card or in the HDD of
Panasonic’s video camera, etc. with this unit. You must copy the
files to the HDD or a DVD-RAM.
• You cannot playback or record while copying SD Video.
69
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 69
2009/05/13 15:01:19
Playing still pictures
HDD BD-RE RAM -R -R DL CD USB SD
You can play still pictures recorded with a computer onto a BD-RE,
DVD-R, DVD-R DL, CD-R/CD-RW, USB memory and SD card.
You cannot play still pictures while recording or copying.
Preparation
BD-RE RAM -R -R DL CD USB SD Insert a disc, USB memory
or SD card.
Press [DRIVE SELECT] to select the drive.
Select “BD” for any discs.
With the unit stopped
HDD BD-RE RAM
The display below automatically appears when you insert an SD
card, USB memory or the discs while stopped.
Press [e, r] to select “Play Pictures (JPEG)”, then press [OK].
Then go to step
(➔ right).
-R -R DL CD It will go to step
(➔ right) automatically if it is
only still pictures that is recorded.
When “PICTURE” is not selected, press the “Green”
button to select “PICTURE”.
To switch the display method
Still pictures copied from SD cards and USB memories
are grouped by the shooting date on Pictures by Date
screen.
Switching the DIRECT NAVIGATOR appearance
1 Press [OPTION].
2 Press [e, r] to select “Album View” or “Pictures by
Date”, then press [OK].
Disc
e.g., CD
CD
Play Video ( DivX )
Play Pictures ( JPEG )
Play/Copy Music ( MP3 )
CD is inserted
DIRECT NAVIGATOR
Album View
Time Remaining 20:08 DR
OK
VIDEO
PICTURE
DIRECT NAVIGATOR
Pictures by Date
Time Remaining 20:08 DR VIDEO PICTURE
MUSIC
001
002
001
002
Album01
Total 19
Album02
Total 9
08/09/2006
Total 19
04/02/2007
Total 9
MUSIC
RETURN
e.g., USB
Press OK to display pictures.
OPTION
OK
RETURN
USB device
VIDEO
h
Press OK to display pictures.
Page 01/01
Select
PICTURE
MUSIC
OK
RETURN
q Slideshow
Album View screen
Copy Video ( AVCHD )
Copy Video ( MPEG2 )
OPTION
VIDEO
h
Page 01/01
Select
PICTURE
MUSIC
q Slideshow
Pictures by Date screen
Play Pictures ( JPEG )
Copy Pictures ( JPEG )
DIRECT NAVIGATOR screen icons
Play / Copy Music ( MP3 )
USB device is inserted.
OK
Picture and Album protected.
RETURN
e.g., SD
HDD
Date that has not yet been viewed
(Only still pictures copied with “Copy All
Pictures” or “Copy New Pictures”)
SD Card
Play Video ( AVCHD )
Copy Video ( AVCHD )
Copy Video ( MPEG2 )
Play Pictures ( JPEG )
To show other pages
Press [u, i].
Copy Pictures ( JPEG )
SD card is inserted.
OK
RETURN
e, r, w, q to select the album or
date, then
Display items differ depending on what is recorded in each
media.
If the menu screen (➔ above) is not displayed, display it by
performing the following operation.
-R -R DL CD USB SD
DIRECT NAVIGATOR Picture (JPEG) View
Time Remaining 20:08 DR VIDEO PICTURE
04/02/2007
1 Press [FUNCTION MENU].
2 -R -R DL CD SD
Press [e, r] to select “Playback”, then press [OK].
e.g., HDD
MUSIC
USB
1 Press [e, r] to select “Others”, then press [OK].
2 Press [e, r] to select “USB device”, then press [OK].
Page 001/001
OK
RETURN
OPTION
h
Select
q Slideshow
e, r, w, q to select the still
picture, then
– Press [w, q] to display the previous or next
still picture.
– Useful functions during still picture play
(➔ 71)
Tips
To return to previous screen
Press [BACK/RETURN ].
To exit the screen
Press [DIRECT NAVIGATOR].
70
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 70
2009/05/13 15:01:20
Useful functions during still picture play
Start
Slideshow
You can display still pictures one by one at a constant interval.
–2 (➔ 70)
After performing steps
1 Press [e, r, w, q] to select the album of “Album View” or the date of “Pictures by Date”.
2 Press [q] (PLAY).
You can also start Slideshow with following steps.
After performing step 1 (➔ above)
1 Press [OPTION].
2 Press [e, r] to select “Start Slideshow”, then press [OK].
To end the slideshow
Press [BACK/RETURN ].
Slideshow
Settings
After performing steps
–2 (➔ 70)
1 Press [e, r, w, q] to select the album of “Album View” or the date of “Pictures by Date”.
2 Press [OPTION].
Start Slideshow
3 Press [e, r] to select “Slideshow Settings”, then press [OK].
Slideshow Settings
To change the display interval
Slideshow Settings
After performing steps 1–3
Please set the following functions.
1 Press [e, r] to select “Display interval”.
Display interval
Normal
2 Press [w, q] to select the desired interval.
Transition Effect
Fade
3 Press [e, r, w, q] to select “Set”, then press [OK].
Repeat Play
On
Soundtrack
Off
To change the transition effect
Select Soundtrack Sample Soundtrack
After performing steps 1–3
Set
Cancel
1 Press [e, r] to select “Transition Effect”.
2 Press [w, q] to select the transition effect.
“Fade”
: Pictures are changed by fading out and fading in.
“Motion” : Pictures are changed by fading out and fading in, while it is enlarged, reduced, or moved up or down.
“Random” : In addition to the “Motion”, pictures are changed by various methods.
3 Press [e, r, w, q] to select “Set”, then press [OK].
To set repeat play
After performing steps 1–3
1 Press [e, r] to select “Repeat Play”.
2 Press [w, q] to select “On” or “Off”.
3 Press [e, r, w, q] to select “Set”, then press [OK].
To playback the music
Sample music in this unit or music stored on the HDD (My Favourites or Playlist) (➔ 78) can be played during the playback of the slideshow.
After performing steps 1–3
Select Soundtrack
Please select music playlist for soundtrack.
1 Press [e, r] to select “Soundtrack”.
2 Press [w, q] to select “On”.
Sample Soundtrack
My Favourites
3 Press [e, r, w, q] to select “Set”, then press [OK].
RETURN
Rotate
To change the music to playback
After performing steps 1–3
1 Press [e, r] to select “Select Soundtrack”, then press [OK].
2 Press [e, r] to select storage location of soundtrack, then press [OK].
3 Press [e, r] to select the music playlist, then press [OK].
4 Press [e, r, w, q] to select “Set”, then press [OK].
While playing
01
02
03
OK
RETURN
1 Press [OPTION].
2 Press [e, r] to select “Rotate RIGHT” or “Rotate LEFT”, then press [OK].
Rotate RIGHT
Rotation information will not be stored in the following cases.
Rotate LEFT
– -R -R DL CD USB Still pictures
– When disc or card is protected
– When played on other equipment
– When copying pictures
– When changing date
If you remove the SD card while the DIRECT NAVIGATOR screen is displayed, picture rotation information may not
be properly stored. Remove the SD card after you exit the DIRECT NAVIGATOR screen.
While playing
Still Picture
OK
RETURN
Zoom in
Zoom out
Properties
1 Press [OPTION].
2 Press [e, r] to select “Zoom in”, then press [OK].
Rotate RIGHT
Rotate LEFT
Press [e, r] to select “Zoom out” in step 2, then press [OK] to resume the display size of the still picture.
When zooming in, the picture may be cut off.
The Zoom in information will not be stored.
This function is only available for small-sized still pictures.
Information (e.g., time and date) is shown.
After performing steps
–2 (➔ 70)
1
2
3
4
Zoom in
OK
RETURN
Press [e, r, w, q] to select the album or date, then press [OK].
Press [e, r, w, q] to select the still picture.
Press [OPTION].
Press [e, r] to select “Properties”, then press [OK].
While playing
Press [STATUS
] twice.
To exit the picture properties screen
Press [STATUS ].
e.g., HDD .
2:00 01/01/2009.
g Remain HDD 30:30 DR
Folder - Picture No. 103 - 0006
No.
Date 01/01/2009
Shooting date
3/9
71
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 71
2009/05/13 15:01:21
Editing still pictures
Editing still pictures (JPEG)
e, r to select the operation, then
HDD BD-RE RAM SD
Editing can be done in units of pictures, albums, or dates.
You cannot edit still pictures recorded on DVD-R, DVD-R DL, CD-R/
CD-RW and USB memory.
(e.g., HDD Pictures by Date)
Preparation:
• Press [DRIVE SELECT] to select the drive. Select
“BD” for any discs.
• BD-RE RAM SD Release protection (disc ➔ 94,
card ➔ 23).
Album View
Useful functions during still picture
play (➔ 71)
Start Slideshow
Slideshow Settings
Copy
Change Date
Copy to Album
Copy to New Album
Delete
Copy to Disc
VIDEO / MUSIC
With the unit stopped
Still pictures operation (➔ 73)
(e.g., HDD Album View)
Useful functions during still picture
play (➔ 71)
Pictures by Date
Start Slideshow
Copy to Album
HDD BD-RE RAM
Slideshow Settings
When “PICTURE” is not selected, press the “Green” button
to select “PICTURE”.
Copy to New Album
Copy Album
Copy to Disc
Edit Album
HDD BD-RE RAM
To switch the display method
1 Press [OPTION].
2 Press [e, r] to select “Album View” or “Pictures by
Date”, then press [OK].
DIRECT NAVIGATOR
Pictures by Date
Time Remaining 20:08 DR VIDEO PICTURE
001
002
08/09/2006
Total 19
04/02/2007
Total 9
MUSIC
e.g., HDD
Pictures by Date screen
Enter Album Name
Delete Album
Set up Protection
VIDEO / MUSIC
Cancel Protection
Still pictures operation (➔ 73)
(e.g., HDD Picture (JPEG) View)
Start Slideshow
Useful functions during still picture
play (➔ 71)
Slideshow Settings
Press OK to display pictures.
OK
RETURN
OPTION
h
VIDEO
Page 01/01
Properties
Select
PICTURE
MUSIC
q Slideshow
Copy Pictures
Copy to Album
Editing an album or date:
Edit Pictures
Copy to New Album
Select the album or date to be
edited, then
Delete Pictures
Pictures by Date
Set up Protection
Cancel Protection
Editing a still picture:
1 Select the album or date which contains
the still picture to edit, then press [OK].
DIRECT NAVIGATOR Picture (JPEG) View
Time Remaining 20:08 DR VIDEO PICTURE
04/02/2009
Change Date
Still pictures operation (➔ 73)
(e.g., SD Album View)
e.g., HDD
Useful functions during still picture
play (➔ 71)
Start Slideshow
MUSIC
Slideshow Settings
Enter Album Name
Edit Album
Set up Protection
Delete Album
Cancel Protection
Page 001/001
OK
RETURN
OPTION
h
Select
q Slideshow
Still pictures operation (➔ 73)
2 Select the still pictures to edit, then press
[OPTION].
(e.g., SD Picture (JPEG) View)
To show other pages
Press [u, i].
Multiple editing
Select with [e, r, w, q], then press [h]. (Repeat.)
A check mark appears. Press [h] again to cancel.
Useful functions during still picture
play (➔ 71)
Start Slideshow
Slideshow Settings
Properties
Edit Pictures
Set up Protection
Cancel Protection
Delete Pictures
Album View
Still pictures operation (➔ 73)
Tips
72
To return to the previous screen
Press [BACK/RETURN ].
To exit the screen
Press [DIRECT NAVIGATOR].
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 72
2009/05/13 15:01:21
Still pictures operation
After performing steps
−
(➔ 72).
Copy to Album
HDD BD-RE RAM
Copy to New Album
HDD BD-RE RAM
Copy the selected album, date or pictures to an existing album.
1 Press [w, q] to select “Start”, then [OK].
2 Press [e, r, w, q] to select the destination album, then [OK].
The destination album with protect setting cannot be copied to.
After copying, the screen shows the Album View automatically.
Copy the selected album, date or pictures to new album.
1 Press [w, q] to select “Start”, then [OK].
2 Press [OK].
3 Press [w, q] to select “Yes” or “No”, then [OK].
If “Yes” is selected:
You can give a name to the album. (➔ 84, Entering Text)
If “No” is selected:
Date of the first recorded picture in the album becomes the album name automatically. (If
there is no information about the recording date, it will become “--.--.----”.)
After copying, the screen shows the Album View automatically.
Copy to Disc
Press [w, q] to select “Start”, then [OK].
If you carry out the “Copy to Disc”, insert a disc advance.
HDD
Copy to HDD
BD-RE RAM
Change Date
HDD BD-RE RAM
(Pictures by Date only)
Enter Album Name
HDD BD-RE RAM
SD
(Album View only)
Set up Protection
Cancel Protection
HDD BD-RE RAM SD
[Album View and Picture (JPEG) View only]
Delete
Delete Album
Delete Pictures
HDD BD-RE RAM SD
Change the date of a folder and move the picture in it into the folder of the changed date.
1 Press [w, q] to select the item, then [e, r] to change.
2 Press [OK].
You can also change the date of a picture.
Date folder of the original is maintained even if all original pictures were deleted after
changing the date of folder. Delete it if unrequired.
If there is no folder with the changed date, a new folder will be created.
You can give a name to the album.
(➔ 84, Entering Text)
Album names input using this unit may not be displayed on other equipment.
If set, this will protect the still picture or album from accidental deletion.
Press [w, q] to select “Yes”, then [OK].
The lock symbol appears when the still picture or album is protected.
Even if the protection setting is used by this unit to protect an album, the album may be
deleted by another unit.
Press [w, q] to select “Delete”, then [OK].
Once deleted, the recorded contents are lost and cannot be restored. Make certain before
proceeding.
BD-RE RAM SD If there is a file other than DCF format or other folder exists in the date or
album, only the pictures will be deleted, and the date or the album itself will not be deleted.
Multiple editing is possible.
[Copy to Album, Copy to New Album, Change Date : Only when the “Picture (JPEG) View” screen is displayed]
Notes
Still Picture
• Timer recordings do not start when performing “Copy to Album”, “Copy to New Album”, “Change Date”, “Copy to Disc” or “Copy to HDD”.
73
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 73
2009/05/13 15:01:22
Copying still pictures
HDD BD-RE RAM USB SD
Pictures copied from SD card and USB memory will be categorised
according to the shooting date. Pictures without shooting date will
be categorised using the creation date.
You cannot copy pictures recorded to DVD-R, DVD-R DL, CD-R/
CD-RW or USB memory.
If the space on the destination drive runs out or the number of files/
folders to be copied exceeds the maximum (➔ 135), copying will
stop partway through.
You cannot copy the information about the picture rotation.
Timer recording will not start while copying still pictures.
Copying all the still pictures on the USB
memory—Copy All Pictures
USB
p HDD
If the menu is not displayed (➔ 70)
Copy from
USB
Copy to
HDD
Play Pictures ( JPEG )
Copy Pictures ( JPEG )
Play / Copy Music ( MP3 )
Copy all pictures ( JPEG ) by date.
USB device is inserted.
OK
Copy
Cancel
RETURN
OK
RETURN
– Display items differ depending on what is recorded in the
USB memory.
Press [e, r] to select “Copy Pictures (JPEG)”,
then [OK].
Press [w, q] to select “Copy”, then [OK].
–
Tips
To stop copying during copy
Press and hold [BACK/RETURN ] for 3 seconds.
Notes
Copying using the copying list
Copy All Pictures ( JPEG )
Copy Video ( AVCHD )
Copy Video ( MPEG2 )
If “Copy & Delete” is selected
Copied pictures in the SD card will be deleted after copying.
If “Copy Only” is selected
Pictures will not be deleted.
– will be displayed on the Pictures by Date screen of the
Direct Navigator for the added pictures.
This unit saves the information on up to 12,000 still pictures and
30 SD cards. If additional still pictures are imported, then the older
information will be deleted.
While stopped
Insert the USB memory.
The menu is automatically displayed.
USB device
Press [w, q] to select “Copy & Delete” or “Copy
Only”, then [OK].
will be displayed on the Pictures by Date screen of the
Direct Navigator for the added pictures.
HDD ' BD-RE RAM SD
SD ' BD-RE RAM
USB p HDD BD-RE RAM
While stopped
Press [FUNCTION MENU].
Press [e, r] to select “Copy”, then press [OK].
Copy
Cancel All
Source
BD/DVD
Direction
1 Copy
BD/DVD
HDD
Destination
2
Copy Mode
3
Create List
HDD
PICTURE High Speed
0
Start Copying
Select the copy direction.
Tips
RETURN
– If you are not going to change the registered list press [r]
several times (➔ step ).
To stop copying during copy
Press and hold [BACK/RETURN ] for 3 seconds.
Set the copy direction.
– If you are not going to change the copying direction, press
[r] (➔ step ).
Notes
The structure of folders on the USB memory may not be the same at
the copy destination.
Copying new still pictures on the SD
card—Copy New Pictures
SD p HDD
This unit saves information about imported still pictures. Therefore, if
still pictures are imported from the same SD card, then only new still
pictures will be imported.
While stopped
Insert the SD card.
The menu is automatically displayed.
SD Card
Copy New Pictures ( JPEG )
Copy Video ( AVCHD )
Copy from
SD CARD
Play Pictures ( JPEG )
Copy to
Copy Pictures ( JPEG )
HDD
Play / Copy Music ( MP3 )
SD card is inserted.
Copy added pictures ( JPEG ) by date.
OK
Copy
Set the copy mode.
– If you are not going to change the copy mode, press [r]
twice (➔ step ).
Press [e, r] to select “Copy Mode”, then press [q].
Press [e, r] to select “Format”, then press [OK].
Press [e, r] to select “PICTURE”, then press [OK].
“Recording Mode” is automatically set to “High Speed”.
Press [w] to confirm.
If the menu is not displayed (➔ 70)
Copy Video ( MPEG2 )
Press [e, r] to select “Copy Direction”, then press [q].
Press [e, r] to select “Source”, then press [OK].
Press [e, r] to select the drive, then press [OK].
Press [e, r] to select “Destination”, then press [OK].
Press [e, r] to select the drive, then press [OK].
The same drive as the copy source cannot be copied.
Press [w] to confirm.
Cancel
RETURN
OK
Register still pictures for copy.
– If you are going to copy a registered list without making
any changes to it, press [r] twice (➔ step ).
– Pictures from different dates or albums will not be
registered to same list.
RETURN
Copy
Cancel All
– Display items differ depending on what is recorded in the
SD card.
Press [e, r] to select “Copy Pictures (JPEG)”,
then [OK].
Press [w, q] to select “Copy”, then [OK].
– Protection of the card is
• Set: Copy will start
• Not set: Go to step
Destination Capacity: 4343MB
Direction
1 Copy
BD / DVD
HDD
2
Copy Mode
3
Create List
New Item
No.
By Picture ( Date )
Size
Title
New item (Total=0)
PICTURE High Speed
0
Page 01/01
Start Copying
Create copy list.
RETURN
74
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 74
2009/05/13 15:01:22
■Select the units to register
Press [e, r] to select “Create List”, then press [ q].
Press [e, r] to select “New Item”, then press [OK].
Destination Capacity: 4343MB
No
Select the item after step
Press [OPTION].
–
Delete
Title
Press [e, r] to select the item, then press [OK].
e.g., SD
e.g., HDD
By Picture ( Date )
Picture
By Picture ( Album )
Album
Delete All
By Date Folder
By Album
Add
Register with “By Picture (Date/Album)”/“Picture”
1. Press [e, r] to select “New item”, then press [OK].
2. Press [e, r, w, q] to select the still picture, then
press [h]. A check mark is displayed. Repeat this step
until you select all necessary items.
– Press [h] again to cancel.
– Press [u, i] to show other pages.
– The items will be copied in the order of the copying
list. If you want to specify the order, repeat selecting
one item at a time.
– To select another folder (➔ right)
3. Press [OK].
– To edit the copying list (➔ right)
4. Press [w] to confirm.
Register with “By Date Folder”/“By Album”/“Album”
1. Press [e, r] to select “New item”, then press [OK].
2. Press [e, r, w, q] to select the folder, then press [h].
A check mark is displayed. Repeat this step until you
select all necessary items.
– Press [h] again to cancel.
– Press [u, i] to show other pages.
– The items will be copied in the order of the copying
list. If you want to specify the order, repeat selecting
one item at a time.
3. Press [OK].
– To edit the copying list (➔ right)
4. Press [w] to confirm.
Press [e, r] to select “Start Copying”, then press
[OK].
–Only when copied with “By Picture (Album)” from HDD
to BD-RE RAM SD or from BD-RE RAM to HDD SD
When specifying another album as the copying destination,
select “Album”.
Album
Ti
Delete All
Add
By Picture ( Date )
Size
– 3 (➔ left).
New album
di
i
t
Press [w, q] to select “Yes”, then press [OK] to
start copying.
Delete
Delete all items registered on the copying list.
1. Press [e, r] to select “Delete All”, then
press [OK].
2. Press [w, q] to select “Yes”, then press
[OK].
Add new items to the copying list.
1. Press [e, r] to select “Add”, then press
[OK].
2. Press [e, r, w, q] to select the still
picture or folder, then press [h].
A check mark is displayed. Repeat this
step until you select all necessary items.
• Press [h] again to cancel.
3. Press [OK].
Delete the selected items.
1. Press [e, r] to select “Delete”, then press
[OK].
2. Press [w, q] to select “Yes”, then press
[OK].
Cancel all registered copying setting and lists
After performing steps
copying list)
−
(➔ 74, Copying using the
Press [e, r] to select “Cancel All”, then press
[OK].
Press [w] to select “Yes”, then press [OK].
• The settings and lists may be cancelled in the following
situations.
– When a title, still picture, etc. has been recorded or deleted
at the copy source
– When steps have been taken, for instance, to turn off the
unit, open the tray, change the copy direction, etc.
Select another folder
After performing step –3–1 [➔ left, Register with “By Picture
(Date/Album)”/“Picture”]
Press [OPTION].
Press [OK].
Press [e, r, w, q] to select the folder, then press [OK].
–The still pictures of different folders cannot be registered on the
same list.
Still Picture
New Item
Edit the copying list
Tips
To return to the previous screen in steps
Press [BACK/RETURN ].
to
To stop copying after step
Press and hold [BACK/RETURN ] for 3 seconds.
Notes
• The sequence in which the still pictures are registered on the copy
list may not be the same at the copy destination.
• If still pictures are already contained inside the copy destination
folder, the new still pictures are recorded following the existing still
pictures.
75
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 75
2009/05/13 15:01:23
Deleting still pictures
Once deleted, the recorded contents are lost and cannot be
restored. Make certain before proceeding.
HDD BD-RE RAM SD
Preparation:
• Press [DRIVE SELECT] to select the drive. Select
“BD” for any discs.
• BD-RE RAM SD Release protection (disc ➔ 94,
card ➔ 23).
Tips
To return to the previous screen
Press [BACK/RETURN ].
To exit the screen
Press [EXIT].
While stopped
e, r to select “Delete”, then
HDD BD-RE RAM
When “PICTURE” is not selected, press the
“Green” button to select “PICTURE”.
HDD BD-RE RAM
1 Press [OPTION].
2 Press [e, r] to select “Album View” or
“Pictures by Date”, then press [OK].
DELETE Navigator
Pictures by Date
Time Remaining 20:08 DR VIDEO PICTURE
001
002
08/09/2006
Total 19
04/02/2007
Total 9
Press OK to display pictures.
OK
RETURN
OPTION
VIDEO
h
MUSIC
Page 01/01
Select
PICTURE
MUSIC
Deleting a still picture
1 Press [e, r, w, q] to select the item which
contains the still picture to delete, then press
[OK].
2 Press [e, r, w, q] to select the still picture,
then press [OK].
Deleting the album/date folder
1 Press [e, r, w, q] to select the album/date
folder you want to delete.
2 Press [DEL].
You can confirm the still picture that you
have selected using the option menu. (➔ 71,
Properties, step 2)
To show other pages
Press [u, i].
Multiple deleting
Select with [e, r, w, q], then press [h].
(Repeat.)
A check mark appears. Press [h] again to
cancel.
w, q to select “Delete”, then
The item is deleted.
76
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 76
2009/05/13 15:01:24
Playing music
Playing MP3 files
e, r, w, q to select a folder, then
-R -R DL CD USB
You can play MP3 files recorded with a computer onto a
DVD-R, DVD-R DL, CD-R/CD-RW and USB memory.
• You cannot play MP3 files on the USB memory while recording.
While stopped
Insert a disc or USB memory.
CD
USB device
Copy Video ( AVCHD )
Play Video ( DivX )
Play Pictures ( JPEG )
Play/Copy Music ( MP3 )
CD is inserted.
The Music List for the folder appears.
Tips
To return to the previous screen
Press [BACK/RETURN ].
Copy Video ( MPEG2 )
Notes
Play Pictures ( JPEG )
Copy Pictures ( JPEG )
Play / Copy Music ( MP3 )
OK
USB device is inserted.
RETURN
OK
RETURN
– Display items differ depending on what is
recorded in each media.
– -R -R DL CD Playback will automatically
start if only MP3 is recorded.
e, r to select “Play/Copy Music
(MP3)”, then
– Playback will automatically start.
e.g., CD
DIRECT NAVIGATOR
CD ( MP3 )
Music List
0001
0002
0003
0004
0005
Playing music CD
CD
While stopped
Insert a music CD.
0.09
March Moon
The unit starts accessing the Gracenote® Database
(➔ 82) and searches for the title information.
Folder: Mexican pops
Track Name
Artist
No.
Playing track
When this unit is not operated for approximately 5 minutes
during music playback, the screen saver is displayed [only
when “Screen Saver” in the Setup menu is set to “On”
(➔ 104)]. To return to the previous screen, press
[BACK/RETURN ].
March Moon
Do this flower open?
Go to there from here
Good by SAKURA
If eastern wind has gone
Leon I
Leon I
Leon I
Leon I
Leon I
POWERED BY
OK
RETURN
OPTION
Slideshow
Copy All
to HDD
Playing different track
Press [e, r] to select the track, then press [OK].
If search results indicate that multiple titles
were found
Press [e, r] to select the appropriate title, then
[OK].
– Playback will automatically start.
Tips
To exit the screen
Press [EXIT].
Playback of track will stop.
If the menu screen (➔ above) is not displayed, display it
by performing the following operation.
1 Press [FUNCTION MENU].
2 -R -R DL CD
Press [e, r] to select “Playback”, then press [OK].
USB
1 Press [e, r] to select “Others”, then press [OK].
2 Press [e, r] to select “USB device”, then press [OK].
DIRECT NAVIGATOR
CD
e, r to select “Select Folder”, then
Selected folder No. /Total folders
If the folder has no track, “– –” is
displayed as folder number.
DIRECT NAVIGATOR
CD ( MP3 )
Select Folder
0.09
March Moon
MP3 music
OK
RETURN
001 My favorite
001 Brazilian pops
002 Chinese pops
003 Czech pops
004 Hungarian pops
005 Liner notes
006 Japanese pops
007 Mexican pops
008 Philippine pops
009 Swedish pops
001 Momoko
002 Standard number
001 Pi
l
F 7/27
You cannot select
folders that contain
no compatible files.
0.09
4.30
March Moon
01
02
03
04
05
Track Name
Artist
March Moon
Do this flower open?
Go to there from here
Good by SAKURA
If eastern wind has gone
Leon I
Leon I
Leon I
Leon I
Leon I
Still Picture
No.
Playing track
OK
Using the tree screen to find a folder
RETURN
Slideshow
Retry access
Copy All
to HDD
Playing different track
Press [e, r] to select the track, then [OK].
Reacquire the CD title
Press the “Yellow” button.
Music
While the Music List is displayed
Music List
Do this flower open?
Tips
To exit the screen
Press [DIRECT NAVIGATOR].
Playback of track will stop.
Notes
When this unit is not operated for approximately 5 minutes during
music playback, the screen saver is displayed [only when “Screen
Saver” in the Setup menu is set to “On” (➔ 104)]. To return to the
previous screen, press [BACK/RETURN ].
77
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 77
2009/05/13 15:01:24
Playing music
Playing music recorded on HDD
e, r to select the track, then
Copying music to HDD (➔ 82)
Preparation:
• Press [DRIVE SELECT] to select the HDD drive.
DIRECT NAVIGATOR
Music List
0.09
4.30
March Moon
HDD
Do this flower open?
Playing track
While stopped
No.
Track Name
0001
0002
0003
0004
0005
March Moon
Do this flower open?
Go to there from here
Good by SAKURA
If eastern wind has gone
OK
RETURN
Artist
Leon I
Leon I
Leon I
Leon I
Leon I
OPTION
Slideshow
Add to My
Favourites
Playing different track
Press [e, r] to select the track, then [OK].
When “MUSIC” is not selected, press the
“Yellow” button to select “MUSIC”.
DIRECT NAVIGATOR Music Menu
HDD
Total Tracks 53
VIDEO
PICTURE
MUSIC
Artists
Albums
Tips
To return to the previous screen
Press [BACK/RETURN ].
To exit the screen
Press [DIRECT NAVIGATOR]. Playback of track will stop.
Notes
My Favourites
Playlists
Frequently Played
Random Play
OK
RETURN
OPTION
Please select to access music.
VIDEO
PICTURE
MUSIC
e, r to select the item, then
Artists
1
Albums
2
My Favourites
3
Playlists
4
Frequently Played
5
Random Play
6
• You cannot play music tracks on HDD while copying.
• When this unit is not operated for approximately 5 minutes during
music playback, the screen saver is displayed [only when “Screen
Saver” in the Setup menu is set to “On” (➔ 104)]. To return to the
previous screen, press [BACK/RETURN ].
1 Categorise by artist
2 Categorise by album
3 Tracks registered in “My Favourites”
4 Tracks registered in “Playlists”
5 Tracks played most within 200 tracks played
recently (up to 30 Tracks)
6 Random playback of all tracks
■When “Artists” is selected
1 Press [w, q] to select the initial of the artist.
2 Press [e, r] to select the name of the artist, then
[OK].
3 Press [e, r] to select the album, then press [OK].
■When “Albums” is selected
1 Press [w, q] to select the initial of the album.
2 Press [e, r] to select the album, then press [OK].
78
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 78
2009/05/13 15:01:25
Useful functions during music play
HDD -R -R DL CD USB
Operations during play
Stop
Pause
Press [g].
Search
Press [t] or [y].
Press [q](PLAY) to restart play.
During play or while paused,
press [u] or [i].
Skip to the track you want to play.
Each press increases the number of skips.
While Music List screen is displayed
Press [e, r] to select the track, then press the “Green” button.
Up to 99 tracks can be registered.
Skip
Register a track to
“My Favourites”
HDD
Properties
HDD
Repeat Play
Random
Re-master
Display Still
Pictures
(Slideshow)
Press [h].
Press [h] again or [q] (PLAY) to restart play.
While Music List screen is displayed
1 Press [OPTION].
2 Press [e, r] to select “Properties”, then press [OK].
To exit the Properties screen, press [OK].
1 Press [DISPLAY].
2 Press [e, r] to select “Play”, then press [q].
3 Press [e, r] to select “Repeat Play” or “Random”, then press [q].
4 Press [e, r] to select the item.
Repeat Play
“All”: Repeatedly playback the selected album, etc.
“Track”: Repeatedly playback the selected track
“Off”
Random
“On”: Randomly playback the selected album, etc.
“Off”
This feature gives you a more natural sound by adding higher frequency signals not recorded on the track.
1 Press [DISPLAY].
2 Press [e, r] to select “Sound”, then press [q].
3 Press [e, r] to select “Sound Effects”, then press [q].
4 Press [e, r] to select “Re-master1” or “Re-master2”.
This function is effective for audio from the HDMI terminal or the DIGITAL AUDIO OUT terminal only when
“Dolby D”, “Dolby D +”, “Dolby TrueHD”, “DTS”, “DTS-HD” or “MPEG” is set to “PCM”. (However, in this case,
audio is output as 2 ch from the DIGITAL AUDIO OUT terminal.)
Sample pictures in this unit or pictures stored on “Album View” of the HDD can be played back as slideshow during
playback of the music.
While playing the music
Press the “Red” button.
Change the pictures to display
1 Press [OPTION].
2 Press [e, r] to select “Select Picture Album”, then press [OK].
3 Press [e, r] to select the album, then press [OK].
Select Picture Album
Please select the album to start slideshow.
Sample Pictures
My Favourites
My Travel
While playing music a picture slideshow
can be displayed.
OK
RETURN
Music
Playing music
continuously
even after turning
off power to the
television
To end the slideshow
Press [BACK/RETURN ].
It will also end when the music is stopped.
When the unit is connected to a Panasonic TV (VIERA) that supports HDAVI Control 2 or later and the unit is
turned in standby if the power to the television is turned in standby, since “Power off link” (➔ 86) operates.
The following operations make it possible to keep the power of the unit ON and to play music continuously.
While playing music
1 Press [OPTION].
2 Press [e, r] to select “TV Power Off”, then press [OK].
Sound may be discontinued for several seconds when the power to the television is turned in standby.
If the operation mentioned above is executed while audio is output from the television, the sound may not be
output from the amplifier/receiver. It is recommended to set the amplifier/receiver beforehand so that audio will be
output from the amplifier/receiver.
79
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 79
2009/05/13 15:01:25
Editing music/playlist
Editing music
Album and track operation
HDD
After performing step
Preparation:
• Press [DRIVE SELECT] to select the HDD drive.
While stopped
When “MUSIC” is not selected, press the
“Yellow” button to select “MUSIC”.
– When doing “Delete All Tracks”, “Clear My Favourites”
or “Clear Frequently Played” (➔ go to step )
DIRECT NAVIGATOR Music Menu
HDD
Total Tracks 53
VIDEO
PICTURE
MUSIC
Artists
Albums
My Favourites
Playlists
Random Play
OK
RETURN
OPTION
Please select to access music.
VIDEO
PICTURE
MUSIC
e, r to select item, then
■When “Artists” is selected
1 Press [w, q] to select the initial of the artist.
2 Press [e, r] to select the name of the artist, then
press [OK].
3 Press [e, r] to select the album.
To edit the track, press [OK], and select the track
with [e, r].
■When “Albums” is selected
1 Press [w, q] to select the initial of the album.
2 Press [e, r] to select the album.
To edit the track, press [OK], and select the track
with [e, r].
(➔ left)
Delete all tracks in the HDD.
Delete All Tracks
1 Press [w, q] to select “Yes”, then
While displaying Music
press [OK].
Menu screen
2 Press [w, q] to select “Delete”,
then press [OK].
Once deleted, the recorded
contents are lost and cannot be
restored. Make certain before
proceeding.
All
tracks in the selected Artist or
Delete All Tracks
While displaying “Artists” Album are deleted in case of “Delete
All Tracks” or “Delete Album”.
screen
Press [w, q] to select “Delete”, then
Delete Album
press [OK].
While displaying
Once deleted, the recorded
“Albums” screen
contents are lost and cannot be
Delete
restored. Make certain before
proceeding.
Edit Album Name
Edit Track Name
Edit Artist Name
Clear My
Favourites
While displaying Music
Menu screen
Frequently Played
–
Clear Frequently
Played
While displaying Music
Menu screen
Remove
While displaying “My
Favourites” or
“Frequently Played”
screen
(➔ 84, Entering Text)
Remove all tracks in “My Favourites”.
Tracks themselves are not deleted
from the HDD.
Press [w, q] to select “Clear”, then
press [OK].
Remove all tracks in “Frequently
Played”. Tracks themselves are not
deleted from the HDD.
Press [w, q] to select “Clear”, then
press [OK].
Selected track is removed. Track itself
is not deleted from the HDD.
Press [w, q] to select “Remove”,
then press [OK].
e, r to select item, then
e.g., while selecting album
Delete Album
(➔ 81)
Add to Playlist
Edit Album Name
Album and track
operation (➔ right)
e.g., while selecting artist
Delete All Tracks
Edit Artist Name
Album and track
operation (➔ right)
e.g., while selecting track
(➔ 81)
Delete
Add to Playlist
Edit Track Name
Edit Artist Name
(➔ 79)
Album and track
operation (➔ right)
Properties
Tips
80
To return to the previous screen
Press [BACK/RETURN ].
To exit the screen
Press [DIRECT NAVIGATOR].
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 80
2009/05/13 15:01:26
Register track to Playlist
HDD
You can register your favourite albums and tracks into 10 preset playlists.
• Name of the playlist can be changed. (➔ right)
• New playlist cannot be added.
• Up to 999 tracks can be registered to each playlist.
Editing Playlist
HDD
While stopped
Preparation:
• Press [DRIVE SELECT] to select the HDD drive.
While stopped
When “MUSIC” is not selected, press the
“Yellow” button to select “MUSIC”.
e, r to select “Playlists”, then
When “MUSIC” is not selected, press the
“Yellow” button to select “MUSIC”.
DIRECT NAVIGATOR Music Menu
HDD
VIDEO PICTURE MUSIC
Total Tracks 53
Artists
3a Edit the track in the playlist
1 Press [e, r] to select the playlist, then press
[OK].
2 Press [e, r] to select the track, then press
[OPTION].
e.g., while selecting the track in playlist
Albums
My Favourites
Playlists
Frequently Played
Random Play
OK
Please select to access music.
VIDEO
RETURN
PICTURE
MUSIC
■When “Albums” is selected
1 Press [w, q] to select the initial of the album.
2 Press [e, r] to select the album.
To register the track, press [OK], and select the
track with [e, r].
e, r to select “Add to Playlist”,
then
e, r to select the playlist to
register, then
DIRECT NAVIGATOR
Playlists
HDD
Playlist Name
My Favourites
Playlist 01
Playlist 02
Playlist 03
Playlist 04
Playlist 05
Playlist 06
Playlist 07
Playlist 08
Playlist 09
OK
Please select playlist to add to.
RETURN
Add to Playlist
(➔ left)
Edit Track Name
(➔ 80)
Edit Artist Name
e, r to select item, then
■When “Artists” is selected
1 Press [w, q] to select the initial of the artist.
2 Press [e, r] to select the name of the artist, then press [OK].
3 Press [e, r] to select the album.
To register the track, press [OK], and select the
track with [e, r].
(➔ below)
Properties
3b Edit the playlist
1 Press [e, r] to select the playlist, then press
[OPTION].
e.g., while selecting playlist
Remove All Tracks
(➔ below)
Edit Playlist Name
e, r to select item, then
Tips
To return to the previous screen
Press [BACK/RETURN ].
To exit the screen
Press [DIRECT NAVIGATOR].
Playlist operation
After performing step
Remove All Tracks
Remove
–
(➔ above, Editing Playlist)
Remove all tracks in the selected
playlist. Tracks themselves are not
deleted from the HDD.
Press [w, q] to select “Remove”,
then press [OK].
Selected track is removed. Track itself
is not deleted from the HDD.
Press [w, q] to select “Remove”,
then press [OK].
Tips
To return to the previous screen
Press [BACK/RETURN ].
To exit the screen
Press [DIRECT NAVIGATOR].
(➔ 79)
Music
OPTION
Remove
Edit Playlist Name
(➔ 84, Entering Text)
81
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 81
2009/05/13 15:01:26
Copying music to HDD
You can store the two formats of music data in this unit’s
HDD.
While stopped
Insert a disc or USB memory.
Music CD (CD-DA)
When inserting music CDs, this unit makes access to the
internal Gracenote® Database to obtain title information.
The album name, track name and artist name are assigned
automatically allowing you find the track easily when playing
back.
CD (Music CD)
The unit starts accessing the Gracenote®
Database and searches for the title information.
POWERED BY
MP3
You can copy MP3 files from the DVD-R, DVD-R DL, CD or
USB memory.
The track name and artist name will be displayed on this unit
if the information is contained in ID3 tag of the MP3 file.
If search results indicate that multiple titles
were found
Press [e, r] to select the appropriate title, then
press [OK].
-R -R DL CD USB (MP3)
The menu is automatically displayed.
Press [e, r] to select “Play/Copy Music
(MP3)”, then press [OK].
About the Gracenote® Database
The Gracenote® Database is a database used to search and
retrieve music CD title information.
When a music CD is inserted, the unit will automatically
search for and obtain information about the inserted music
CD.
The Gracenote® Database comes pre-installed on this unit,
so titles and artist information can be obtained. This unit has
an internal database containing information for approximately
350,000 album titles.
e.g., CD USB (MP3)
USB device
Copy Video ( AVCHD )
If the title of the newly released music CD is not in the built-in
database, it is possible to acquire the title automatically by
connecting to the network via the Internet. (➔ 115)
Copy Video ( MPEG2 )
Play Pictures ( JPEG )
Copy Pictures ( JPEG )
Play / Copy Music ( MP3 )
USB device is inserted.
OK
RETURN
If there are music CDs with very similar title information,
then the incorrect title information may be obtained. If no title
suggestions are found, it is displayed as “Unknown Artist”,
“Unknown Album”.
CD
Play Video ( DivX )
Play Pictures ( JPEG )
Play/Copy Music ( MP3 )
CD is inserted.
In these cases, enter the music CD title information manually,
after recording to the HDD has completed.
OK
RETURN
– Display items differ depending on what is
recorded in each media.
Copying music from a disc or a USB
memory
(Blue)
-R -R DL CD USB p HDD
• CD (Music CD): All tracks in the CD will be recorded.
• -R -R DL CD USB (MP3) : All tracks in the folder will be
recorded. (Cannot record track-by-track.)
e.g., CD (Music CD)
DIRECT NAVIGATOR
CD
Music List
0.09
4.30
March Moon
Do this flower open?
No.
Playing track
• It will be recorded as 1 album to the HDD in 1 recording.
• Audio quality
CD (Music CD): LPCM,
-R -R DL CD USB (MP3): MP3
• The maximum number of tracks on HDD: 40000
(Depends on the remaining capacity.)
If titles or pictures are recorded, then the number of albums
that can be recorded will be reduced.
01
02
03
04
05
Track Name
Artist
March Moon
Do this flower open?
Go to there from here
Good by SAKURA
If eastern wind has gone
Leon I
Leon I
Leon I
Leon I
Leon I
OK
RETURN
Slideshow
Retry access
Copy All
to HDD
w, q to select “Copy”, then
Recording starts.
Tips
To return to the previous screen
Press [BACK/RETURN ] in steps
to .
To stop copying
Press and hold [BACK/RETURN ] for 3 seconds in step
.
Notes
82
• While copying, no other operations can be performed. Timer
recordings will not proceed.
• Tracks recorded on the HDD cannot be transferred to a disc, USB
memory or SD card.
• CDs which have SCMS (Serial Copy Management System)
restrictions cannot be recorded to the HDD.
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 82
2009/05/13 15:01:27
Deleting music
Once deleted, the recorded contents are lost and cannot be
restored. Make certain before proceeding.
HDD
While stopped
e, r to select “Delete”, then
When “MUSIC” is not selected, press the “Yellow”
button to select “MUSIC”.
DELETE Navigator
HDD
Music Menu
Total Tracks 53
VIDEO
PICTURE
MUSIC
Artists
Albums
My Favourites
Playlists
Frequently Played
OK
RETURN
OPTION
Please select to access music.
VIDEO
PICTURE
MUSIC
Deleting an artist/album (music)
1 Press [e, r] to select the item, then press [OK].
2 Press [e, r, w, q] to select the item, then press
[DEL].
Deleting a track
1 Press [e, r] to select the item, then press [OK].
2 Press [e, r, w, q] to select the item, then press
[OK].
3 Press [e, r] to select the track, then press [OK].
You can confirm the item that you have selected using the
option menu. (➔ 80, step )
w, q to select “Delete”, then
The item is deleted.
Tips
To return to the previous screen
Press [BACK/RETURN ].
Music
To exit the screen
Press [EXIT].
83
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 83
2009/05/13 15:01:28
Entering Text
You can give names to recorded titles, etc.
When viewing the Enter Title
Name screen, etc.
e.g., Entering a title name for a title on -R
Name field : shows the text you have entered
Enter Title Name
_
Top Menu Preview
Delete
g
Set
OK
RETURN
1 1
2
3
5
6
7
8
9
0
2 A
B
C
a
b
c
+ –
3 D
E
F
d
e
f
/
= %
*
4
g
h
i
#
$
&
K
L
j
< >
@
O
m
k
n
l
6 M N
o
[
]
_
7 P
Q
R
p
q
r
s
(
8 T
U
V
t
u
v
{
}
)
-
9 W X
0 . ,
Y
Z
w
x
?
!
"
'
y
:
z
;
\
`
|
^
4 G
H
5 J
I
S
0 –– 9
SPACE
e, r, w, q to select a character,
then press
– Repeat this step to enter other characters.
when you’ve finished
entering text.
Tips
Using the numbered buttons to enter characters
e.g.: entering the letter “R”
1. Press [7] to move to the 7th row.
2. Press [7] twice to highlight “R”.
3. Press [OK].
To delete a character
Press [h] on a character in the name field.
To cancel in the middle
Press [BACK/RETURN ].
Characters will not be saved.
Notes
Enter Title Name
_
Chapter
1_
Top Menu Preview
1 1
2
3
5
6
7
8
9
0
Chapter 1
2 A
B
C
a
b
c
+ –
3 D
E
F
d
e
f
/
*
= %
4 G
H
I
g
h
i
#
$
4
&
If you enter a long name, only part of it is shown in the Top
Menu after finalisation (➔ 96). When entering a title name,
the name that will appear in the Top Menu can be previewed
in “Top Menu Preview” window.
84
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 84
2009/05/13 15:01:28
Enjoying VIERA CASTTM
You can access a selection of Internet services from the
Home screen with VIERA CAST, for example YouTube,
Picasa Web Albums. (Current as of February 2009)
• VIERA CAST requires a broadband Internet connection.
Dial-up Internet connections cannot be used.
Preparation:
• Network connection (➔ 115)
• Network setting (➔ 109)
– Message is displayed. Please read these
instructions carefully and then press [OK] to
start VIERA CAST function.
Welcome to Network Service
Notes
• VIERA CASTTM home screen is subject to change without notice.
• The services through VIERA CASTTM are operated by their
respective service providers, and service may be discontinued
either temporarily or permanently without notice. Therefore,
Panasonic will make no warranty for the content or the continuity of
the services.
• All features of websites or content of the service may not be
available.
• Some content may be inappropriate for some viewers.
• Some content may only be available for specific countries and may
be presented in specific languages.
• Depending on the usage conditions, it may take a while to read all
the data.
• The connection to the Internet may take time or the Internet may
not be connected depending on the connection environment.
• The unit is connected to the Internet when VIERA CAST is used,
generating communication charges.
• If timer recording starts, VIERA CAST will stop.
Your Panasonic Network Service allows you to access web-based content on your Player/Recorder.
Network Service is subject to change without notice. The Service through Network Service is operated by
their respective service providers, and service may be discontinued either temporarily or permanently
without notice. Therefore, Panasonic will make no warranty for the content or the continuity of the
services. All features of websites or content of the service may not be available. Some content may be
inappropriate for some viewers and may only be available for specific countries and may be presented in
specific languages. You may disable the Network Service feature by following the instructions found in
your Operating Instructions.
Don’t show this message again
ENTER
It's recommanded your player/recorder is connected to Full HD display with HDMI. The display of the
contents may be truncated, depending on your TV. You may reduce to screen size by following the
instructions found in your Operating Instructions.
Images are for illustration purpose, message
may change without notice.
e, r, w, q to select the item
– You can operate VIERA CAST using the following
buttons on the unit’s remote control. [e, r, w, q], [OK],
[BACK/RETURN ], [OPTION], coloured buttons and
numbered buttons
– To access more features on YouTube or Picasa Web
Albums site, enter your user ID and password that you
have previously set up with these sites through the
internet on your PC. However, not all features may be
accessible through VIERA CAST.
VIERA CAST Home screen;
After you access YouTube or
Picasa Web Albums from the
VIERA CAST Home screen
and add your favourite videos
or albums to VIERA CAST,
you can choose them easily
from the Home screen.
Images are for illustration change without notice.
Regarding “Settings”
Set VIERA CAST Home screen.
• My Account: You can remove your account from the unit.
• Lock:
Enter a password to lock YouTube and
Picasa Web Albums.
• Notices
New York, NY
Settings 20°
Featured Videos
Weather
NNW7
mph
Panasonic Select
Tips
Convenient
Functions
To return to VIERA CAST Home screen
Press [VIERA CAST].
To exit
Press [EXIT].
Set “Network Lock” to “On” to restrict using VIERA CAST. (➔ 106)
Set “Automatic Volume Control” to “Off” when the audio is warped
while using VIERA CAST. (➔ 110)
When display of the contents is truncated, set “Picture Zoom” to
“Out”. (➔ 110)
85
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 85
2009/05/13 15:01:29
Linked Operations with the TV (VIERA Link “HDAVI Control™”/Q Link)
You can enjoy linked operations with the TV and
receiver by using VIERA Link or Q Link.
What is VIERA Link “HDAVI Control” ?
VIERA Link “HDAVI Control” is a convenient function that
offers linked operations of this unit, and a Panasonic TV
(VIERA) or receiver under “HDAVI Control”. You can use this
function by connecting the equipment with the HDMI cable.
See the operating instructions for connected equipment for
operational details.
• VIERA Link “HDAVI Control”, based on the control functions
provided by HDMI which is an industry standard known as HDMI
CEC (Consumer Electronics Control), is a unique function that
we have developed and added. As such, its operation with other
manufacturers’ equipment that supports HDMI CEC cannot be
guaranteed.
• This unit supports “HDAVI Control 4” function.
“HDAVI Control 4” is the newest standard (current as of
December, 2008) for Panasonic’s VIERA Link compatible
equipment.
This standard is compatible with Panasonic’s conventional
HDAVI equipment.
• Please refer to individual manuals for other manufacturers’
equipment supporting VIERA Link function.
Preparation:
1. Connect this unit to your TV using an HDMI cable and a fully
wired 21-pin Scart cable (➔ 10), or to your receiver using an
HDMI cable (➔ 114).
2. Set “VIERA Link” to “On” (➔ 105). (The default setting is “On”.)
3. Set the “HDAVI Control” operations on the connected
equipment (e.g., TV).
• Set the input channel on VIERA to suit the terminal to be
used as “HDAVI Control”.
4. Turn on all “HDAVI Control” compatible equipment and select
this unit’s input channel on the connected TV so that the
“HDAVI Control” function works properly.
Also when the connection or settings are changed, repeat
this procedure.
What is Q Link?
Q Link is a convenient function that offers linked operations of
this unit and a Panasonic TV. You can use this function by
connecting the equipment with a fully wired 21-pin Scart cable.
Preparation:
Connect this unit to your TV with a fully wired 21-pin Scart cable
(➔ 10,11,112).
Notes
The following systems from other manufacturers have similar
function to Q Link from Panasonic.
For details, refer to your television’s operating instructions or consult
your dealer.
• Q Link (registered trademark of Panasonic)
• DATA LOGIC (registered trademark of Metz)
• Easy Link (registered trademark of Philips)
• Megalogic (registered trademark of Grundig)
• SMARTLINK (registered trademark of Sony)
Notes
• These functions may not work normally depending on the
equipment condition.
• About “VIERA Link” function, read the manual of the connected
equipment (e.g., TV) too.
86
(When the TV is on) Easy playback
VIERA Link
Q Link
When the TV is on and the following operations are
performed, the TV’s input will automatically switch to
HDMI input mode ( VIERA Link ) or AV input mode
( Q Link ) and the TV displays the corresponding
action. (Picture or sound may not be available for the
first few seconds.)
Press [FUNCTION MENU] 1, [q] (PLAY) 2, [DIRECT
NAVIGATOR], [GUIDE], [PROG/CHECK] etc.
(When the TV is off) Power on link
VIERA Link
Q Link
When the TV is off and the following operations are
performed, the TV will automatically turn on and
display the corresponding action.
(Picture or sound may not be available for the first few seconds.)
Press [FUNCTION MENU] 1, [q] (PLAY) 2, [DIRECT
NAVIGATOR], [GUIDE], [PROG/CHECK] etc.
• BD-V DVD-V CD
The TV is automatically turned on when you insert the discs.
Power off link
VIERA Link
Q Link
When you turn the TV off, the unit is also automatically
turned in standby. The unit is automatically turned in
standby even if the FUNCTION MENU screen, the status
message or the on-screen display is displayed, during
playback or when the unit is set to a timer recording.
Even if the TV is turned in standby, the unit will not be turned in
standby at the same time when recording, copying, finalising, etc.
• When this unit is connected to an “VIERA Link” compatible
Panasonic receiver with an HDMI cable, the receiver will also turn off.
About the Standby Power Save function 3
Even with “Power Save” set to “Off” (➔ 107), this unit turns to “Power
Save” states (➔ 14) when Power off link works, so it is possible to
reduce the power consumption while this unit is in standby mode.
• “Standby Power Save” setting is required to be activated on the TV.
• When turning this unit on or off without using Power off link
function, this unit will not turn to “Power Save” states.
Direct TV Recording
VIERA Link
4
Q Link
This function allows you to immediately start recording
the programme that you are viewing on the TV.
• Depending on the TV type connected with this unit, this function
may not work if you select the TV channels on this unit.
• The titles are recorded to the HDD.
• When the Digital Teletext (➔ 91) is displayed, intended image
may not be recorded.
• If you switch TV channels while using Direct TV recording, the
Direct TV recording stops.
• When “EXT-L” lights on the unit’s display (➔ 64), Direct TV
recording is unavailable.
To stop recording
Press [ g].
Playing music continuously even after turning
off power to the television VIERA Link
5
(➔ 79, Playing music continuously even after turning off power to
the television)
1 This button is available only when this unit is on.
2 When this button is pressed, the playback image is not
immediately displayed on the screen and it may not be possible
to watch the contents from where playback started.
In this case, press [u] or [t] to go back to where playback
started.
3 This function is available with the TV that supports “HDAVI
Control 4”.
4 This function is available with the TV that supports “HDAVI
Control 3” or later.
5 This function is available with the TV that supports “HDAVI
Control 2” or later.
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 86
2009/05/13 15:26:54
If you connect this unit to the TV that supports “HDAVI
Control 2” or later with an HDMI cable, you can enjoy using
more convenient functions.
You can operate this unit using the following buttons on the
TV remote control.
The buttons that you can use for this unit vary depending on
the TV. For details, refer to the operating instructions of the
TV.
Use the remote control supplied with this unit if you cannot
operate this unit using buttons on the TV remote control.
• The operation of this unit may be interrupted when you
press buttons on the TV remote control.
Using the FUNCTION MENU display to
operate this unit VIERA Link
Using the OPTION menu window to operate
this unit VIERA Link
This function is available with the TV that supports “HDAVI
Control 2” or later.
By using the TV remote control, you can play discs using the
“Control Panel” (➔ below).
e.g.,
1 Press [OPTION].
Control Panel
• You cannot use the OPTION menu while
FUNCTION MENU
Aspect
the Top Menu for DVD-Video is displayed
Play Menu
and while DVD-Video is copied.
Top Menu
2 Select an item, then press [OK].
Menu
Drive Select
OK
RETURN
Control Panel
Control Panel is displayed (➔ below).
FUNCTION MENU
FUNCTION MENU is displayed
(➔ left).
Aspect
Switch the screen mode (➔ 92).
Play Menu
Play menu is displayed (➔ 89).
Top Menu
BD-V DVD-V
Top Menu is displayed (➔ 26).
Menu DVD-V
Menu is displayed (➔ 26).
This function is available with the TV that supports “HDAVI
Control 3” or later.
Pop-up Menu BD-V
Pop-up Menu is displayed (➔ 26).
You can pause the TV programme you are watching and
resume later by temporarily saving it on the HDD. This is
useful when you have to briefly stop watching TV to run an
errand.
If you stop the Pause Live TV function, then the TV
programme temporarily saved on the HDD will be deleted.
Refer to the TV operating instructions for operating the TV.
1 When you want to pause the TV programme
Turn on the “Pause Live TV” function using the TV
remote control.
• This unit turns on automatically.
2 When you want to resume
Display the Control Panel (➔ right) , then press [OK].
• The TV programme resumes.
Drive Select
Select the HDD, BD or SD drive.
Rotate RIGHT/
Rotate LEFT (JPEG)
Rotate the still pictures (➔ 71).
Zoom in /Zoom out
(JPEG)
Enlarge or shrink the still picture
(➔ 71).
TV Power OFF
Play music continuously even after
turning off power to the television
(➔ 79).
This function is available with the TV that supports “HDAVI
Control 2” or later.
Refer to the TV operating instructions for operating the TV.
1 Display this unit’s “FUNCTION MENU” display using
the TV remote control.
• If this unit is turned in standby, this unit will turn on
automatically.
2 Select the item you want to operate with the TV remote
control, then press [OK].
Pause live TV programme
VIERA Link
Refer to “Notes” on page 93, “To pause the TV programme
you are watching—Pause Live TV”.
Tips
To stop Pause Live TV
1Press [r] while the Control Panel is displayed.
2Press [w, q] to select “Yes”, then press [OK].
Using the Control Panel
VIERA Link
Using the Control Panel, you can operate search backward,
search forward, stop, etc, with the TV remote control.
Select “Control Panel”, then press [OK] in step 2 of “Using
the OPTION menu window to operate this unit” (➔ above).
The Control Panel is displayed (➔ right).
h
Exit
• While playing a title, etc.
– [e]: Pause, [r]: Stop, [w]: Search
y
t
backward, [q]: Search forward, [OK]: Play,
q
[EXIT]: Exit the screen.
g
• While playing still pictures
– [r]: Stop, [w]: View previous picture, [q]: View next picture,
[EXIT]: Exit the screen.
Convenient
Functions
Easy control only with VIERA remote
control
■ When you want to leave the TV on and set only this unit to
standby mode
Press [^] on this unit’s remote control and set to standby mode.
■ When not using “HDAVI Control”
Set “VIERA Link” in the Setup menu to “Off” (➔ 105).
87
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 87
2009/05/13 15:01:29
Setting On-Screen Display
Subtitles
Accessing the On-Screen Display
BD-V DVD-V AVCHD
When playing discs (except for JPEG discs), you can display
and set the options including disc audio, subtitle, image
quality, sound effect, Repeat Play, etc. In addition, when
receiving the multi-channel broadcast, you can change the
audio settings.
Menu options will differ based on disc type and contents.
Press [DISPLAY].
Disc
Play
Picture
Sound
Other
Menu
Soundtrack
Digital 2/0 ch
1
Subtitles
Subtitle
Off
Audio channel
LR
Item
Setting
Press [e, r] to select a menu, then press [q].
Press [e, r] to select an item, then press [q].
Press [e, r] to select a setting.
Follow the on-screen prompts to change
individual settings.
Notes
• Some settings may not be changeable, based on the
unit’s current activity (playing, stopped, etc.) and disc
contents.
Tips
To exit the on-screen display
Press [DISPLAY].
Disc Menu
Video
AVCHD
The video recording method appears
Signal Type
• Primary Video
Video:
The video recording method appears.
Soundtrack: Select the type of audio or language.
• Secondary Video
Video:
Select on/off of images.
The video recording method appears.
Soundtrack: Select on/off of audio and the language.
Soundtrack
HDD BD-RE BD-R (except the title copied the title in DR mode
or the high definition video (AVCHD format))
Turn the subtitle on/off and select the language (➔ below,
Language).
HDD (except the title copied the title in DR mode or the high
definition video (AVCHD format))
RAM -R -R DL -RW(V) +R +R DL +RW -RW(VR)
(Only discs that contain subtitle on/off information)
Turn the subtitle on/off.
• Subtitle on/off information cannot be recorded using this unit.
DivX
Turn the subtitle on/off and select the subtitle number.
• “Text” or subtitle number is displayed even if there are not
multiple subtitles.
Multi Audio/AD HDD BD-RE BD-R (titles recorded in DR
mode, or copied from HD video (AVCHD format))
Switch in the case of multiple audio.
Subtitle Language HDD BD-RE BD-R (titles in recorded in DR
mode, or copied from HD video (AVCHD format))
Select the subtitle language in the case of multiple
languages.
Subtitle Style BD-V
Select the subtitle style recorded on the disc.
Audio channel HDD BD-RE BD-R
Change audio during playback.
LR / L / R
RAM -R -R DL -RW(V) -RW(VR)
Angle DVD-V +R +R DL +RW
Change the number to select an angle.
Sound track/Subtitle language
ENG: English
DAN: Danish
FRA: French
POR: Portuguese
DEU: German
RUS: Russian
ITA: Italian
JPN: Japanese
ESP: Spanish
CHI: Chinese
NLD: Dutch
KOR: Korean
SVE: Swedish
MAL: Malay
NOR: Norwegian VIE: Vietnamese
THA:
POL:
CES:
SLK:
HUN:
FIN:
:
Thai
Polish
Czech
Slovak
Hungarian
Finnish
Others
Audio attributes
LPCM/ Digital/ Digital+/
TrueHD/DTS/DTS-HD/MPEG:
k (kHz):
b (bit):
ch (channel):
Signal type
Sampling frequency
Number of bits
Number of channels
Notes
• You cannot make a change when there is no recording.
• Some discs allow changes to soundtracks, subtitles, and
angles only by using the disc’s menus (➔ 26).
RAM -R -R DL -RW(V) +R +R DL +RW -RW(VR)
The disc’s audio attributes appear. (➔ right, Audio attributes)
DVD-V AVCHD
Select the audio and language.
(➔ right, Audio attributes, Sound track/Subtitle language)
DivX
Select the soundtrack number.
• Soundtrack numbers are displayed even when there is only
one audio type.
88
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 88
2009/05/13 15:01:30
Play Menu
Sound Menu
Repeat Play
This function works only when the elapsed play time is
displayed.
Select the item for repeat play. Depending on the disc, the
items that can be selected will differ.
Select “Off” to cancel.
Picture Menu
Mode
Select the picture quality mode during play.
Normal:
Default setting
Soft:
Soft picture with fewer video artifacts
Fine:
Details are sharper
Cinema:
Mellows movies, enhances detail in dark
scenes. (This does not affect the titles in DR
mode.)
HD optimizer
It will compensate the mosaic noise in the video and haze
around the characters precisely.
Progressive
Select the method of conversion for progressive output to suit
the type of material being played.
(When the tray is opened, the setting will return to “Auto”.)
Auto:
Video:
Film:
Automatically detects the film and video
content, and appropriately converts it.
Select when using “Auto”, and the content is
distorted.
Select this if the edges of the
film content appear jagged or
rough when “Auto” is selected.
However, if the video content is distorted as
shown in the illustration to the above, then
select “Auto”.
Sound Effects
HDD BD-RE BD-R BD-V RAM -R -R DL -RW(V) +R
+R DL +RW DVD-V -RW(VR) CD AVCHD
• Re-master1
• Re-master2
(Discs record at 48 kHz or less)
This feature gives you a more natural sound by adding higher
frequency signals not recorded on the track.
• This function is effective for audio from the HDMI terminal
or the DIGITAL AUDIO OUT terminal only when “Dolby D”,
“Dolby D+”, “Dolby TrueHD”, “DTS”, “DTS-HD” or “MPEG” is
set to “PCM”. (However, in this case, audio is output as 2ch
from the DIGITAL AUDIO OUT terminal.)
Dialogue Enhancer
HDD BD-RE BD-R BD-V RAM -R -R DL -RW(V) +R
+R DL +RW DVD-V -RW(VR) AVCHD
(3-channel or over only, including a centre channel)
When “On”, the volume of the centre channel is raised to
make dialogue easier to hear.
Other Menu
Position
Change where this menu screen appears on your TV.
Convenient
Functions
It will work when playing DVD-V with the following settings:
– “HDMI Video Mode” is set to “Off” (➔ 105)
– “AV1 Output” is set to “Video (with component)” (➔ 105) or
“S Video (with component)” (➔ 105)
– “Component Resolution” is set to “576p/480p” (➔ 105)
89
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 89
2009/05/13 15:01:30
Information Messages
Digital Satellite Channel Information
You can display the information about programmes
(programme name, broadcast time, etc.).
To switch information of the current programme and the next
programme
Press [w, q].
• Now: current programme
• Next: next programme
With the unit stopped
to show the screen information.
When the digital satellite channel information is
being displayed,
– Press [STATUS ] again and detailed information will be
displayed (only when “For info press ” is displayed).
Digital satellite
channel information Status message ( 91)
HDD
1: 30 DR
951
BBC ONE Wales
Tips
“For info press
”
STATUS
FS 951 BBC ONE Wales 13:07 All freesat Channels
BBC News at one
13:00 – 13:30
For info press
Now
Subtitles TXT
STATUS
Detailed
information
FS 951 BBC ONE Wales 13:06 All freesat Channels
BBC News at one
13:00 - 13:30
Exit info
Now
To select the information of another channel
Press [e, r].
• Press [OK] to watch the selected channel.
To change the length of time digital satellite channel information
is displayed for
(➔ 104, On-Screen Messages)
Notes
• Every time you change the channel, digital satellite channel
information appears automatically. They disappear again after a
short time.
• If you record a digital satellite radio broadcast or a digital satellite
broadcast that is not being received correctly, digital satellite
channel information is also recorded and will remain visible during
playback.
Selecting Multi Audio
When “Multi Audio” appears in digital satellite channel
information
National and international news from the BBC, followed by Weather. [S]
Genre: News and Factual
No information
Subtitles
to show the OPTION menu.
TXT
e, r to select “Multi Audio/AD”,
then
STATUS
– Multi Audio/AD panel appears.
w, q to select the desired audio,
then
Programme name and Broadcast time
Channel and
Station Name
Category
FS 951 BBC ONE Wales
13:07 All freesat Channels
BBC News
19:00 - 19:30
For info press
Now
Encr ypted AD Subtitles TXT Multi Audio
Listening to the Audio Description
This function can aid visually-impaired viewers by adding an audio
track to describe events on-screen.
When “AD” appears in digital satellite channel information
Encrypted
AD
During scrambled broadcasting
(You cannot watch the broadcast).
Audio Description service may be available.
Subtitles
Subtitle can be displayed.
TXT
Digital TEXT is possible.
Programme is broadcast in multi-channel sound.
Personal guidance information exists.
PIN is needed to playback the title when you
record the programme with mark.
You can check the information by pressing
[STATUS ].
“AD”, “Subtitles”,
e.g.,
All freesat Channels
19:35
FS 103 ITV Wales
“TXT”, “Multi
Coronation Street
Exit info
Now
Audio” indications 19 : 30 - 20 : 00
are displayed as
[AD]
available on
AD
particular
programmes, but may not be available for all individual
programmes being broadcast. Display the extra information to
confirm availability of these functions.
to show the OPTION menu.
e, r to select “Multi Audio/AD”,
then
Multi Audio
90
– Multi Audio/AD panel appears.
w, q to select “AD”,
then
Notes
• Programmes are recorded with Audio Description when you record
them with set to “AD”.
Tips
To turn off the Audio Description
In the step 3 above, press [w, q] to select other than “AD”, then
press [EXIT].
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 90
2009/05/13 15:01:31
Showing the Digital TEXT (MHEG)
Showing Subtitles
When “TXT” appears in digital satellite channel
information
When “Subtitles” appears in digital satellite channel
information
to show the Digital TEXT.
– Press again to hide.
to show subtitles.
– Press again to hide.
Notes
Notes
• During recording the Digital TEXT function is not possible.
• The Digital TEXT function depends on respective stations.
• When subtitle is on or the digital satellite channel information is
displayed, the Digital TEXT function does not work.
• Programmes are recorded with subtitles when you record them with
the subtitles on.
Tips
To select subtitle language (➔ 99, Preferred Subtitles)
To view another page of Digital TEXT (MHEG)
Press [e, r] to select another page, then press [OK].
• You can also use the numbered buttons to select another page.
Quickly access to certain topic areas and navigation
Use colour buttons according to on-screen instructions.
Showing Teletext
Regarding Teletext
Teletext may be displayed when viewing Other Sat.
channels. (➔ 104, Teletext)
to show teletext.
e, r, the numbered buttons, or the
colour buttons to select the page.
– Follow the instruction on the screen to select the
page.
Tips
To change the teletext mode (➔ 104)
To show the sub page (Only when there are sub pages)
Press [w, q].
To store frequently viewed page (List mode only)
During the page is displayed
Press the colour button of the colour to store.
Press and hold [OK].
To change stored pages (List mode only)
Press the colour button of the colour to change.
Enter the new page number with the numbered buttons.
Press and hold [OK].
Tips
Signal Quality
No Signal
The digital satellite broadcast signal is
not being received.
No Service No broadcasts are currently available.
If “No Signal” is displayed, check the following;
• Check that the satellite dish is correctly positioned.
• Check that the current digital broadcast channel is correctly broadcasting.
Status Messages
The following messages and displays appear to let you
know what operations are being performed and the
status of the unit.
During playback and/or recording
Keep pressing to cycle through
available displays.
HDD
REC 1
951
BBC ONE Wales
Current media
Shows current recording or play status.
102 REC 2
Status of recording in background
Channel information
Remaining recording time and recording mode
(e.g.: “76:19 DR” indicates 76 hours and 19 minutes in DR mode)
• Disc remaining time may slightly differ between
different models.
The current date and time
23:28:43 09/09/2009
Remain HDD 76:19 DR
T33
0:00. 26
1 T40
2 T41
0:00.29 DR
0:00.07 DR
HDD
REC 1
951
BBC ONE Wales
102 REC 2
Elapsed recording
time and recording mode
Elapsed play time
and recording mode
23:31:33 09/09/2009
Live 23:31.33
Current time
Convenient
Functions
• When using Pause Live TV
Play 23:31.17
The time when the picture currently
displayed was broadcast
No Display
91
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 91
2009/05/13 15:01:31
Convenient Functions
FUNCTION MENU display
w, q to select the item.
By using the FUNCTION MENU display you may
access the main functions quickly and easily.
• Normal:
Normal output
• Side cut:
The black bars on the right and left sides of
the 16:9 image disappear and the image is
enlarged. Please note that the right and left
sides of the image are cut off when the black
bar is not displayed.
Functions displayed depend on the selected
drive or type of disc.
FUNCTION MENU
Time Remaining
22:30 DR
Playback
Recording
Delete
16:9 image with
black bars on
the right and left
Copy
TV Guide
Others
OK
Display as frame
on the 4:3 aspect
ratio TV screen
Enlarged display
with black bar
erased with Side
cut
Displayed with black
bars on right and left
on the 16:9 aspect
ratio TV screen
Enlarged display
with black bar
erased with Side
cut
RETURN
e, r to select an item, then
• If you select “Others”, then press [OK], the
following screen appears. Press [e,r] to
select an item, then press [OK].
Only when “TV Aspect” (➔ 104) is set to “Letterbox”.
FUNCTION MENU
HDD
Time Remaining
• Zoom:
The black bars on the top and bottom sides
of the 4:3 image disappear and the image is
enlarged. Please note that the top and bottom
sides of the image are cut off when the black
bar is not displayed.
22:30 DR
Playback
Ext Link Standby
Recording
Flexible Recording via AV input
Delete
DV Automatic Recording
Copy
Network
TV Guide
Setup
Setup
Others
OK
RETURN
• If you press [BACK/RETURN ], you can
return to the previous screen.
Tips
To exit the FUNCTION MENU display
Press [FUNCTION MENU].
4:3 image with
black bars at the
top and bottom
Displayed as frame
on the 16:9 aspect
ratio TV screen
Enlarged display
with black bar
erased with Zoom
Switch the aspect ratio of the screen
When black bars are shown at the top, bottom, left, and
right sides of the screen, you can enlarge the image to
fill the screen.
e, r to select “Aspect”, then
Notes
• The screen mode is switched to “Normal” in the following situations:
– when you change channel
– when you start or end the playback of a title
– when the unit is turned in standby or on.
• BD-V DVD-V “Side cut” does not have any effect.
• When “TV Aspect” (➔ 104) is set to “4 : 3” or “Letterbox”, the
“Zoom” effect is disabled.
Tips
To return to the previous screen
Press [BACK/RETURN ].
To exit the screen
Press [EXIT].
92
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 92
2009/05/13 15:01:32
To pause the TV programme you are
watching—Pause Live TV
You can pause the TV programme you are watching
using this unit’s tuner and resume later by temporarily
saving it on the HDD. This is useful when you have to
briefly stop watching TV to run an errand.
If you stop the Pause Live TV function, then the TV
programme temporarily saved on the HDD will be
deleted.
Turn on the television and select
the appropriate AV input to suit
the connections to this unit.
Turn on this unit and
select the channel.
Notes
• Temporary save is stopped in following cases.
– When save time exceeds 8 hours
– When there is no HDD free space
– When 2 programmes are recorded simultaneously
• The Pause Live TV function does not work
– The clock is not set.
– While 2 programmes simultaneous recording
– While watching a programme being recorded
– When DV is selected
• When paused for approximately 5 minutes the screen saver is
displayed [only when “Screen Saver” in the Setup menu is set to
“On” (➔ 104)].
To return to the previous screen, press [BACK/RETURN ].
to
When you want to pause the TV programme
HDD
PAUSE
Pause Live TV
freesat
When you want to resume
PLAY/x1.3
The programme is saved on the HDD in DR
recording mode.
– Programmes can be saved temporary up to 8
hours on the HDD. (This may vary depending
on the HDD free space.)
Operation during Pause Live TV
Search
Press [t, y].
The speed increases up to 5 steps.
• Press [q] (PLAY) to restart play.
Pause
Press [h].
• Press [q] (PLAY) to restart.
Quick View
Press and hold [q] (PLAY/×1.3).
Slow-motion
While paused, press [t] or [y].
The speed increases up to 5 steps.
• Press again to return to the normal speed.
Convenient
Functions
• Press [q] (PLAY) to restart play.
Stop Pause Live 1 Press [g].
TV
2 Press [w, q] to select “Yes”, then
press [OK].
93
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 93
2009/05/13 15:01:32
Disc and Card Management
You can manage discs through formatting, finalising
and other operations.
Setting Protection
Accessing the Management Menus
BD-RE BD-R RAM
Use to prevent accidental erasure of disc.
Preparation:
• BD-RE BD-R RAM SD Release protection (disc ➔ right,
card ➔ 23).
• Insert a disc and card.
Perform preparation steps
−
Management Menus” (➔ left).
Press [e, r] to select “Disc Protection”, then
press [OK].
Press [w] to select “Yes”, then press [OK].
With the unit stopped
Press [DRIVE SELECT] to select the BD or SD
drive.
• Select “BD” for any discs.
Press [FUNCTION MENU].
Press [e, r] to select “Others”, then press [OK].
FUNCTION MENU
DVD-RAM
Time Remaining
5:38 EP
Naming Discs
BD-RE BD-R RAM -R -R DL -RW(V) +R +R DL +RW
You can give a name for the disc.
Perform preparation steps
−
Management Menus” (➔ left).
DVD-RAM
Time Remaining
5:38 EP
Delete
Playback
Ext Link Standby
Copy
Recording
Playlists
TV Guide
Delete
DV Automatic Recording
Others
Copy
Recording via AV3 Input
TV Guide
Network
OK
RETURN
Tips
DVD Management
Others
Setup
OK
RETURN
Press [e, r] to select “Blu-ray Disc Management”,
“DVD Management” or “Card Management”, then
press [OK].
Tips
• The disc name is displayed in the Blu-ray Disc/DVD
Management window.
DVD Management
DVD-RAM
1
Files
Time Remaining 5:38 EP
Titles 1
Used 0
My favorite
•
To return to the previous screen
Press [BACK/RETURN ].
To exit the screen
Press [EXIT].
of “Accessing the
Press [e, r] to select “Disc Name”, then press
[OK].
– Entering Text (➔ 84).
FUNCTION MENU
Playback
Recording
of “Accessing the
-R -R DL -RW(V) +R +R DL With a finalised discs the name
is displayed on the Top Menu.
My favorite
01
Chapter 1
•
01/02
02
Chapter 2
+RW The disc name is displayed only if you play the disc
on other equipment after creating top menu.
94
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 94
2009/05/13 15:01:33
Deleting All Titles
Formatting Discs or Cards
You can delete all titles on the disc at once.
Important: Once deleted, contents cannot be recovered.
BD-RE RAM -RW(V) +RW -RW(VR)
BD-R +R +R DL (New disc only)
BD-RE BD-R RAM
Perform preparation steps
−
Management Menus” (➔ 94).
SD
Formatting is the process of making media recordable on
recording equipment.
of “Accessing the
Press [e, r] to select “Delete all titles”, then press
[OK].
Press [w] to select “Yes”, then press [OK].
Press [w] to select “Start”, then press [OK].
– A message appears when deleting is finished.
8
You can record or edit after formatting the finalised DVD-RW.
Important: Once formatted, contents cannot be recovered.
Perform preparation steps
−
of “Accessing the
Management Menus” (➔ 94).
Press [e, r] to select “Format Disc” or “Format
Card”, then press [OK].
Press [OK] to complete.
Press [w] to select “Yes”, then press [OK].
Notes
Press [w] to select “Start”, then press [OK].
– Formatting starts ( RAM may take up to a maximum
of 70 minutes).
– A message appears when formatting is finished.
• Still picture data (JPEG), music data or computer data
cannot be deleted.
• Deleting does not work if one or more titles are protected.
8
Press [OK] to complete.
Notes
• Do not disconnect the AC mains lead while formatting.
This can render the disc unusable.
• When a disc has been formatted using this unit, it may
not be possible to use it on any other equipment.
• -R -R DL CD Formatting cannot be performed.
• -RW(V) -RW(VR) You can format only as DVD-Video format
on this unit.
• SD The card cannot be formatted if the write-protect
switch (➔ 23) is switched to “LOCK”. Release the
protection to continue.
• The message “Unable to format” appears when trying to
format discs the unit cannot use.
Tips
To stop formatting
RAM
Convenient
Functions
Press [BACK/RETURN ].
• You can cancel formatting if it takes more than 2 minutes.
The disc must be reformatted if you do this.
95
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 95
2009/05/13 15:01:33
Disc and Card Management
Selecting the background style—Top Menu
-R -R DL -RW(V) +R +R DL +RW
The background selected here will be displayed as the DVDVideo top menu after finalising or Create Top Menu ( +RW ).
−
Perform preparation steps
Management Menus” (➔ 94).
of “Accessing the
Press [e, r] to select “Top Menu”, then press
[OK].
Press [e, r, w, q] to select the background, then
press [OK].
Top Menu List
1
2
Display after finalising
Thumbnail
(Still picture)
Title Name
4
5
3
6
01
7
8
9
• You can change thumbnails displayed in the top menu.
(➔ 54, Change Thumbnail)
Selecting Whether to Show the Top Menu
First—Auto-Play Select
-R -R DL -RW(V) +R +R DL +RW
Before finalising a disc or creating top menu, select whether
the top menu shows after finalising or creating top menu.
Perform preparation steps
−
Management Menus” (➔ 94).
of “Accessing the
Press [e, r] to select “Auto-Play Select”, then
press [OK].
Press [e, r] to select “Top Menu” or “Title 1”, then
press [OK].
• Top Menu:
The Top Menu appears first.
• Title 1:
The disc content is played without displaying the Top
Menu.
Finalising
-R -R DL -RW(V) +R +R DL
You can play these discs on compatible DVD players by
finalising it on the unit, effectively making it into DVD-Video
that complies with DVD-Video standards. Before finalising,
select the background on the “Top Menu” (➔ above). The
menu you create with the unit can also be used on most DVD
players.
BD-R
• Finalising BD-R prevents accidental recording or editing.
• BD-R that was recorded on this unit may not be played on
other Blu-ray players, etc. whether or not you finalise it.
Perform preparation steps
−
Management Menus” (➔ 94).
of “Accessing the
Press [e, r] to select “Finalise”, then press [OK].
Notes
• Do not disconnect the AC mains lead while finalising.
This can render the disc unusable.
• When finalising a high-speed recording compatible disc,
it may take longer than displayed on the confirmation
screen (approximately 4 times longer).
• After finalising
– BD-R -R -R DL +R +R DL The disc becomes play-only
and you can no longer record or edit it.
– -RW(V) You can record and edit the disc after formatting
although it becomes play-only after finalising.
– When copying in high speed, chapters will be
replicated.
– The disc finalised on the unit may not be playable
on other players depending on the condition of the
recording.
– There is a pause of several seconds between titles and
chapters during playback.
– -R -RW(V) Titles are divided into about 5-minute
( +R 8-minute) chapters, if
– the titles were directly recorded to the disc.
– the titles were copied using the normal speed mode
(excluding -R DL +R DL ).
This time varies greatly depending on the condition
and mode of recording.
Tips
After you have finished recording and try to eject the disc,
a screen asking if you want to finalise the disc appears
(➔ 121).
Create Top Menu
+RW
+RW discs contain no Top Menu data. Top Menu is a
convenient function. We recommend you create the menu
before playing a +RW disc on other equipment.
Perform preparation steps
−
of “Accessing the
Management Menus” (➔ 94).
Press [e, r] to select “Create Top Menu”, then
press [OK].
Press [w] to select “Yes”, then press [OK].
Press [w] to select “Start”, then press [OK].
– “Create Top Menu” cannot be cancelled once
started.
– “Create Top Menu” takes a few minutes.
– A message appears when “Create Top Menu” is
finished.
8 Press [OK] to complete.
Notes
• Recording or editing on the disc may delete the top
menu. In that case, create the top menu again.
• You cannot use the top menu for playing on this unit.
Press [w] to select “Yes”, then press [OK].
Press [w] to select “Start”, then press [OK].
– Finalising starts and cannot be cancelled. (may take
up to 15 minutes) ( -R DL +R DL up to 60 minutes)
– A message appears when finalising is finished.
8
Press [OK] to complete.
96
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 96
2009/05/13 15:01:34
Setup Menu
Channel Settings
You can change the unit’s settings using Setup menu.
Accessing the Setup Menu
Others
Setup
With the unit stopped
Press [FUNCTION MENU].
Press [e, r] to select “Others”, then press [OK].
(➔ left, Accessing the Setup Menu)
All factory default settings are indicated with “Underlined” text.
FUNCTION MENU
HDD
Time Remaining
Tuning
30:00 DR
Playback
Ext Link Standby
g
Recording
Flexible Recording via AV input
Delete
DV Automatic Recording
Copy
Network
TV Guide
Setup
e, r select “Tuning” ➔
Tuning
Others
OK
RETURN
Press [e, r] to select “Setup”, then press [OK].
Press [e, r] to select the menu, then press [OK].
Menus
freesat Favourites Edit
freesat Channel List
freesat Auto Setup
Other Satellite Channel List
Other Satellite Tuning Menu
Signal Condition
Child Lock
Preferred Multi Audio
Preferred Subtitles
Access
OK
Setup
RETURN
Tuning
HDD/Disc
Picture
Sound
Display
Connection
Network Settings
Others
freesat Favourites Edit
You can create Favourites of freesat channels for making viewing
and recording easier. Editing Favourites does not affect the
channel setting itself.
Favourites Editor
OK
RETURN
Press [e, r] to select the item you want to
change.
Items
Options
All freesat Channels
101 BBC 1 Wales
102 BBC Two Wales
103 ITV1 Wales
104 S4C Digidol
105 Five
106 BBC THREE
107 BBC FOUR
108 BBC HD
Favourites
Select Channel
Store
Page UP
CH
Page Down
RETURN
Others
Automatic Standby
Remote Control
Clock
Owner ID
PIN Entry
Power Save
System Update
DivX Registration
Initialize
Add
4 hours
BD 1
On
RETURN
Press [w, q] to select the option.
• Follow the instruction on the screen if the operation method
is different.
For Setting details, refer to pages 97–107, 109, 110.
Notes
Changed settings remain intact even when switching the
unit to standby mode.
Tips
To return to the previous screen
Press [BACK/RETURN ].
Press [e, r] to select “freesat Favourites Edit” and then press
[OK].
• Timer recording may not work correctly if you edit the Favourites
during timer recording standby.
• Channel numbers cannot be changed, due to broadcast
restrictions.
To add channels to Favourites
1 Press [e, r] to select the channel in the “All freesat Channels”
column to add, then press the “Green” button.
• Repeat this step to add other channels.
• Press the “Yellow” button to add all the available channels to
the Favourites. (Only when no channels have been added to
the Favourites.)
2 Press [OK] to store the Favourites.
To delete channels on Favourites
1 While the Favourites Editor screen is displayed, press [w, q] to
focus on a channel of the “Favourites” column.
2 Press [e, r] to select the channel in the “Favourites” column,
then press the “Yellow” button.
• Repeat this step to delete other channels.
• Press the “Blue” button to delete all channels from the
Favourites.
3 Press [OK] to store the Favourites.
Deleting a channel from a Favourites does not affect the
channel itself.
You can still select the channel from the “All freesat Channels”
column.
Convenient
Functions
To exit the screen
Press [EXIT].
Add all
97
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 97
2009/05/13 15:01:34
Channel Settings
freesat Channel List
You can set channel list of freesat.
1 Press [e, r] to select “freesat Channel List”, then press [OK].
Auto Setup
You can start the auto setup of the other satellite services.
(➔ 16, Tuning in Other Satellite Services)
freesat Channel List
Other Satellite Auto Setup - Satellite Selection
115
116
117
118
120
121
122
Satellite Selection
Search Mode
Channel Type
ITV3
ITV3+1
ITV4
ITV4+1
Channel 4
Channel 4+1
E4
Astra2/Eurobird
All
All
freesat and other satellite channels
Select
Hide
Page UP
CH
Page Down
RETURN
Select
Start
Change
RETURN
2 Press [e, r] to select the channel.
To hide unwanted channels
Press [OK]. The check mark disappears.
You cannot select it by pressing [1, 2 CH].
(But you can select it by pressing the numbered buttons to enter
the channel number directly.)
Press [OK] again to reveal.
Manual Tuning
You can set the channel of the other satellite manually.
Other Satellite Manual Tuning
Transpounder Frequency 10773
Polarisation
Horizontal
Symbol Rate (Ksym/s)
Auto
0 - 9 Enter Frequency
freesat Auto Setup
You can restart auto setting for freesat channels if the setup
(➔ 13) fails for some reason.
However, if you perform “freesat Auto Setup”, all channel settings
are deleted. Confirm the programme you set the timer recording
after freesat Auto Setup. Please reset it if the setting information is
not correct. Recordings on the HDD are not be deleted.
1 Press [e, r] to select “freesat Auto Setup”, then press [OK].
When the confirmation screen appears
2 Press [w] to select “Yes”, then press [OK].
Tips
Select
Start Scan
RETURN
1 Press [e, r] to select “Transpounder Frequency”
2 Press the numbered buttons to enter the transpounder
frequency.
3 Press [e, r] to select “Polarisation”.
4 Press [w, q] to select “Horizontal” or “Vertical”.
5 Press [e, r] to select “Symbol Rate (Ksym/s)”.
6 Press [w, q] to select the desired symbol rate, then press [OK].
–The scan starts.
Dish Setup
• You can also use the following method to restart freesat
Auto Setup. When the unit is turned on and stopped,
press and hold [2 CH] and [CH 1] on the main unit
simultaneously for about 5 seconds.
– freesat Auto Setup screen appears.
You can set the dish setup manually.
Dish Setup
LNB Low Band Frequency (MHz) 9750
LNB High Band Frequency (MHz) 10600
22KHz Command
On
Satellite services may not be available if changed!
Select
EXIT
Other Satellite Channel List
You can set channel list of other satellite services.
1 Press [e, r] to select “Other Satellite Channel List”, then press
[OK].
2 Press [e, r] to select the channel.
• Press the “Red” button to delete the channel.
• Press the “Green” button to swap the channel. And, press the
numbered buttons to enter the channel number you want to
swap, then press [OK].
• Press the “Yellow” button to sort channels.
• Press the “Blue” button to profile the channel.
To hide unwanted channels
Press [OK]. The check mark disappears.
You cannot select it by pressing [1, 2 CH].
(But you can select it by pressing the numbered buttons to enter
the channel number directly.)
Press [OK] again to reveal.
Other Satellite Tuning Menu
You can tune channels from other satellites.
• Press [OK] to show the following settings.
Other Satellite Tuning Menu
Auto Setup
Manual Tuning
Dish Setup
Access
0 - 9 Enter Frequency
RETURN
Reset all
1 Press [e, r] to select “LNB Low Band Frequency (MHz)”.
2 Press the numbered buttons to enter the LNB Low Band
frequency.
3 Press [e, r] to select “LNB High Band Frequency (MHz)”.
4 Press the numbered buttons to enter LNB High Band
frequency.
5 Press [e, r] to select “22KHz Command”.
6 Press [w, q] to select “On” or “Off”.
• Press the “Red” button to reset all settings.
Signal Condition
You can check the quality and strength of digital satellite broadcast
signals. Realign the dish if you are receiving a poor signal.
1 Press [e, r] to select “Signal Condition”, then press [OK].
2 Press [w, q] to select the input you want to check.
Satellite Signal Condition
Dish Input
Channel Name
Signal Quality
Signal Strength
Input 1
101 BBC 1 Wales
0
0
10
10
003B
Network ID
07FF
Transport Stream ID
Satellite Lock Indicator Not Locked
Change Input
RETURN
Channel UP 1
CH
Channel Down 2
The quality and strength of the signal are shown. Press [1, 2 CH]
to select the channel.
OK
RETURN
Signal Quality
Below 2 (display red) The signal quality is so poor that there may
be interference in the pictures and sound.
2–5 (display orange)
98
The signal quality is basically adequate, but
brief interference in the pictures and sound
is possible in isolated case.
Over 5 (display green) Optimum picture and sound quality.
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 98
2009/05/13 15:01:35
Signal Strength
The display for signal strength is grey. “0” means signal strength
0%, “10” means signal strength 100%.
• If the signal is too strong, the display will change from grey to
red. Reduce the signal amplification at your satellite dish.
• When the signal is weak:
– check that the satellite dish is correctly positioned.
– adjust the satellite dish reception.
– check that the current digital satellite broadcast
channel is correctly broadcasting.
Child Lock
You can lock a channel or AV input to prevent access to it.
Tuning
freesat Favourites Edit
Child Lock
freesat Channel List
freesat Auto Setup
Other Satellite Channel List
your 4-digit PIN, then press OK.
Other SatelliteEnter
Tuning
Menu
Signal Condition
Child Lock
Preferred Multi Audio
Preferred Subtitles
RETURN
Number 0 - 9
1 Press [e, r] to select “Child Lock”, then press [OK].
2 Press [e, r] to enter PIN.
You can also use the numbered buttons.
It will be the common PIN for “DVD-Video Ratings”, “BD-Video
Ratings”, “Child Lock”, “Parental Control” and “Network Lock”.
3 Press [OK].
Child Lock List - TV and AV
Name
Type
Lock
AV
AV
AV3
AV4
‫ޓޓ‬DV
AV
freesat
freesat
freesat
freesat
freesat
101 BBC 1 Wales
102 BBC TWO Wales
103 ITV1 Wales
104 S4C Digidol
105 Five
Select
Page Up
Page Down
Lock
RETURN
Next Type
Lock all
CH
Unlock all
4 Press [e, r] to select the channel or AV input to prevent
access to.
5 Press [OK].
• Press [OK] again to cancel.
• Press the “Yellow” button to lock all channel and AV input.
• Press the “Blue” button to unlock all channel and AV input.
• Press the “Red” button to change the channel type displayed.
AV ➔ freesat ➔ Other sat
• Should you see a lock symbol to show the channel locked. To
unlock, select the channel and press [OK]. The lock symbol will
disappear.
• To change the PIN, see page 107.
Preferred Multi Audio
You can choose the audio language for digital broadcast. If the
selected language is not available, then the original language will
be selected.
1 Press [e, r] to select “Preferred Multi Audio”, then press [OK].
2 Press [e, r] to select “Multi Audio”.
3 Press [w, q] to select the language from the followings.
[English]
[Welsh]
[Gaelic]
4 Press [e, r] to select “Audio Description”.
5 Press [w, q] to select “On” or “Off”.
Preferred Subtitles
Convenient
Functions
You can choose the subtitle language for digital broadcast. If the
selected language is not available, then the original language will
be selected.
1 Press [e, r] to select “Preferred Subtitles”, then press [OK].
2 Press [w, q] to select the language from the followings.
[English] [Welsh] [Gaelic]
[English for hearing impaired]
[Welsh for hearing impaired]
[Gaelic for hearing impaired]
99
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 99
2009/05/13 15:01:36
HDD/Disc Settings
DVD-Video Ratings
Others
Setup
(➔ 97, Accessing the Setup Menu)
All factory default settings are indicated with “Underlined” text.
HDD/Disc
e, r select “HDD/Disc” ➔
Set a ratings level to limit DVD-Video play.
Follow the on-screen instructions. Enter a 4-digit PIN with the
numbered buttons when the PIN screen is shown. It will be the
common PIN for “DVD-Video Ratings”, “BD-Video Ratings”,
“Child Lock”, “Parental Control” and “Network Lock”.
Setting ratings (When level 8 is selected)
[8 No Limit]
All DVD-Video can be played.
[1 to 7]
Prohibits play of DVD-Video with corresponding
ratings recorded on them.
[0 Lock All]
Prohibits play of all DVD-Video.
• Changing settings (When level 0 to 7 is selected)
[Unlock Recorder] [Change Level] [Temporary Unlock]
Parental Control
HDD/Disc
Settings for Playback
Settings for Recording
HDD Management
You can restrict playback of the recorded titles that may include
contents for adult. Follow the on-screen instructions. Enter a
4-digit PIN with the numbered buttons when the PIN screen is
shown. It will be the common PIN for “DVD-Video Ratings”, “BDVideo Ratings”, “Child Lock”, “Parental Control” and “Network
Lock”.
[On]
Titles recorded from programmes that were
broadcasted with guidance information in the night
(21:00–05:30) will be indicated with the
icon in
DIRECT NAVIGATOR, DELETE Navigator and copy
source selection screen.
You will have to enter the PIN when playing back
these titles.
[Off]
Access
OK
RETURN
Settings for Playback
Press [OK] to show the following settings.
Soundtrack
[English] [German] [French] [Italian] [Spanish] [Original]
[Other
]
Notes
Subtitles
[Automatic] [English] [German] [French] [Italian] [Spanish]
[Other
]
Menu
[English] [German] [French] [Italian] [Spanish] [Other
]
Play Video (AVCHD) on BD-RE / BD-R
Set when you are playing a disc that has high definition video
(AVCHD) recorded by the camcorder and high definition quality
title that was recorded on this unit.
• It can be played regardless of the setting for discs that do not
have both recorded.
[On]
Playback high definition video (AVCHD)
[Off]
Playback high definition quality title
BD-V DVD-V Choose the language for audio, subtitles and disc
menus.
If a language which is not recorded is selected, or if languages
are already fixed on the disc, the language set as the default on
the disc will be played instead.
[Original]
The original language of each disc will be
selected.
] This is the language code setting. Input a code
[Other
number with the numbered buttons (➔ 132,
“Language code list”).
[Automatic]
If the language selected for “Soundtrack” is
not available, subtitles of that language will
automatically appear if available on the disc.
BD-Live
You can restrict Internet access when BD-Live functions are
used.
[On (No Limit)] Internet access is permitted for all BD-Live
contents.
[On (Limit)]
Internet access is permitted only for BD-Live
contents which have content owner certificates.
Internet access is prohibited for all BD-Live
contents without a certificate.
[Off]
Internet access is prohibited for all BD-Live
contents.
BD-Video Ratings
Set a ratings level to limit BD-Video play.
Follow the on-screen instructions. Enter a 4-digit PIN with the
numbered buttons when the PIN screen is shown. It will be the
common PIN for “DVD-Video Ratings”, “BD-Video Ratings”,
“Child Lock”, “Parental Control” and “Network Lock”.
Setting ratings (When no limit is selected)
[No Limit]
All BD-Video can be played.
[0 to 254 year(s)] Prohibits play of BD-Video with corresponding
ratings recorded on them.
• Changing settings [When 0 to 254 year(s) is selected]
[Unlock Recorder] [Change Level] [Temporary Unlock]
100
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 100
2009/05/13 15:01:36
Settings for Recording
Press [OK] to show the following settings.
Recording time in EP mode
Select the maximum number of hours for recording in EP mode
(➔ 36, Recording modes and approximate recording time).
[6 hours]
You can record for 6 hours on an unused
4.7 GB disc.
[8 hours]
You can record for 8 hours on an unused
4.7 GB disc.
The sound quality is better when using “6 hours” than when
using “8 hours”.
Aspect for Recording
Sets the aspect ratio when recording in HX, HG, HE, HL, XP,
SP, LP, EP, FR mode.
[Automatic]
The programme will be recorded in the original
aspect used when recording started (including
when recording started at a commercial, etc.).
[16:9]
[4:3]
In the following cases, the programme will be recorded with
the original aspect ratio.
– BD-RE BD-R When the recording mode is set to “XP”, “SP”,
“LP”, “EP” or “FR”
– HDD RAM When the recording mode is set to “XP”, “SP”,
“LP”, “EP” or “FR” with the “Recording Format for DVD” set to
“VR format”
In the following cases, even when set to “Automatic” or “16:9”,
recordings will be made or copied in 4:3.
– -R -R DL -RW(V) When the recording mode is set to “EP” or
“FR (recordings 5 hours or longer)” mode.
– When recording to a +R, +R DL and +RW.
Recording Format for DVD
Titles recorded to the HDD from external input with “Recording
Format for DVD” set to “Video format” can be copied to DVD-R,
DVD-R DL, DVD-RW (DVD-Video format), +R, +R DL and +RW
using high speed mode.
We recommend turning the setting “VR format” if high speed
copy to DVD-R, etc. is not necessary when recording a
programme. This setting is effective when recording from external
equipment (including DV equipment), or when copying from a
finalised DVD-Video disc.
[Video format] You can high-speed copy to DVD-R, etc.
[VR format]
High speed copy from HDD is possible only to
DVD-RAM.
• In some cases, copying to DVD-R, etc. using the high speed
mode does not work.
BD / DVD Speed for High Speed Copy
Select the speed of high-speed copying (When using high-speed
copy compatible discs).
[Maximum]
[Normal (Silent)] Selecting “Normal (Silent)” means the noise
generated by this unit is less than “Maximum”,
however the time required for copying will
double (approximately).
HDD Management
• Press and hold [OK] for 3 seconds to show the following settings.
Delete all titles
Delete all titles in HDD.
• Delete does not work if one or more titles are protected.
Convenient
Functions
Format HDD
Format of the HDD is performed.
101
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 101
2009/05/13 15:01:36
Picture and Sound Settings
Sound
Others
Setup
(➔ 97, Accessing the Setup Menu)
All factory default settings are indicated with “Underlined” text.
Picture
e, r select “Picture” ➔
e, r select “Sound” ➔
Sound
Dynamic Range Compression
Downmix
Bilingual Audio Selection
Digital Audio Output
Audio Mode for XP Recording
Audio Mode for DV Input
Audio Mode for Digital Broadcast
Audio Channels for HG/HX/HE/HL Recording
Off
Stereo
M1
Dolby Digital
Stereo 1
Automatic
5.1-channel
RETURN
Picture
Still Mode
Automatic
Seamless Play
On
NTSC Video Output
Dynamic Range Compression
BD-V DVD-V
PAL60
Change the dynamic range for late night viewing.
[On] [Off] [Automatic]
Downmix
RETURN
Still Mode
Select the type of picture shown when you pause play. (➔ 138,
“Frames and fields”)
[Automatic]
[Field]
Select if jittering occurs when “Automatic” is selected.
[Frame]
Select if you cannot see small text or fine patterns
clearly when “Automatic” is selected.
Switch the downmix system for playing back multi-channel
surround sound.
• When “Dolby D/Dolby D +/Dolby TrueHD”, “DTS/DTS-HD” or
“MPEG” is set to “Bitstream”, there are no downmix effects for
the audio output.
• The audio output will be in “stereo” in the following cases.
– AVCHD playback
– BD-V Playback of clicking sound on the menu and audio with
secondary video in picture-in-picture mode
[Stereo]
When connected to equipment that does not
support the virtual surround function
[Surround encoded] When connected to equipment that supports
the virtual surround function
Seamless Play
Select the play mode between playlist chapter segments and
partially deleted titles.
• It is not valid for titles in DR mode or AVCHD videos.
[On]
The chapters in playlists are played seamlessly. This does
not work when there are several audio types included
on the playlist and when using Quick View (Play x1.3).
Additionally, the positioning of chapter segments may
change slightly.
[Off]
The points where chapters in playlists change are played
accurately, but the picture may freeze for a moment.
NTSC Video Output
Select how the NTSC image is output.
[NTSC]
Output as NTSC.
[PAL60] Convert and output as PAL60. Select this when
connected to the PAL format TV.
Bilingual Audio Selection
Select whether to record the main or secondary audio type when:
• Recording to a DVD-R, DVD-RW (DVD-Video format), +R and
+RW.
• “Recording Format for DVD” is set to “Video format”. (➔ 101)
• Recording sound in LPCM (➔ 103, “Audio Mode for XP
Recording”).
[M 1] [M 2]
• You cannot select the audio on this unit when recording from an
external source, such as when copying from a video cassette
recorder (except from DV equipment connected to this unit’s DV
input terminal). Select the audio on the other equipment.
• When recording from the unit’s DV terminal, select the type of
audio recording from “Audio Mode for DV Input” (➔ 103).
102
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 102
2009/05/13 15:01:36
Digital Audio Output
Change the settings when you have connected equipment through
the unit’s DIGITAL AUDIO OUT terminal (➔ 114).
Press [OK] to show the following settings.
PCM Down Conversion
Select how to output audio with a sampling frequency of 96 kHz.
Signals are converted to 48 kHz despite the above settings if the
signals have a sampling frequency of over 96 kHz, or the disc
has copy protection, or “BD-Video Secondary Audio” is set to
“On” ( BD-V ).
[On]
Signals are converted to 48 kHz. (Choose when the
connected equipment cannot process signals with a
sampling frequency of 96 kHz.)
[Off]
Signals are output as 96 kHz. (Choose when the
connected equipment can process signals with a sampling
frequency of 96 kHz.)
Dolby D/Dolby D +/Dolby TrueHD
DTS/DTS-HD 2
MPEG 1
1
Select to output Dolby Digital, Dolby Digital Plus, Dolby TrueHD,
DTS Digital Surround, DTS-HD High Resolution Audio, DTS-HD
Master Audio or MPEG as bitstream or PCM.
Notes
• Incorrect settings can cause noise to be output which can
be harmful to your ears and speakers, and audio will not be
recorded properly on media such as mini discs.
Refer to the operating instructions for connected equipment
to verify whether or not they can decode each of the audio
formats.
• If the unit is connected with the HDMI AV OUT terminal, the
specifications of the connected equipment take preference
over this unit and audio selected in these items may not
be output (e.g., when a television is connected, the HDMI
audio output of this unit is limited to down-mixed 2 ch.).
Audio Mode for DV Input
Select the kind of audio when recording from the unit’s DV input
terminal (➔ 65).
[Stereo 1]
Records audio (L1, R1)
[Stereo 2]
Records added audio such as narration (L2, R2)
subsequent to original recording.
[Mix]
Records both Stereo 1 and Stereo 2.
When recording bilingual broadcast, select the type of audio in
advance from “Bilingual Audio Selection” (➔ 102).
Audio Mode for Digital Broadcast
Selects the initial setting for Audio tracks.
If programme has both Dolby Digital and MPEG audio tracks,
priority is given to what you select.
Only the selected audio is recorded when copied in HG, HX, HE,
HL, XP, SP, LP, EP or FR recording mode.
(It is recorded in accordance with the setting of “Multi Audio/AD” in
the Disc menu only when it is copied with “Copy Title Playing”.)
[Automatic]
Automatically selects the audio tracks if programme
has more than two tracks. The priority is given in the
following order - Dolby Digital Plus, Dolby Digital,
MPEG.
[MPEG]
An audio compression method that compresses
audio to small size without any considerable loss of
audio quality.
Audio Channels for HG/HX/HE/HL Recording
This will set the audio when converting to the HDD in HG, HX, HE
or HL modes (➔ 55).
[5.1-channel] Record using 5.1 ch audio.
[2-channel]
Record using 2 ch audio.
If the audio sampling frequency is not 48 kHz, surround audio
is mixed and recorded in front LR channels. Audio will be
output from two front speakers only, even if you play it on 5.1 ch
speaker connection.
[Bitstream] Select “Bitstream” when the connected equipment
can decode the respective audio format.
–Connect equipment supporting HDMI Ver. 1.3 and
use a High Speed HDMI Cable in order to output
high bit rate audio such as Dolby Digital Plus,
Dolby TrueHD, DTS-HD High Resolution Audio or
DTS-HD Master Audio.
[PCM]
Select “PCM” when the connected equipment cannot
decode the respective audio format.
Refer to the operating instructions for connected
devices to verify whether or not they can decode
each of the audio formats.
Set the speaker output on the amplifier when
output with PCM.
1
2
The default setting is “PCM”.
The default setting is “Bitstream”.
BD-Video Secondary Audio
Convenient
Functions
( BD-V with secondary audio)
Turn on/off the clicking sound on the menu and audio with
secondary video.
[On]
The sampling frequency is converted to 48 kHz.
Audio will be converted to Dolby Digital during
playback of the BD-Video with secondary audio when
“Bitstream” (➔ above) is selected.
[Off]
Output in original audio method.
Audio Mode for XP Recording
Choose the audio type when recording or copying with XP mode.
[Dolby Digital] (➔ 138)
[LPCM] (➔ 139)
• The picture quality of LPCM recordings may be lower than that of
normal XP mode recordings.
• The audio recording becomes Dolby Digital even if you selected
LPCM when using a recording mode other than XP.
103
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 103
2009/05/13 15:01:37
Display and Connection Settings
Connection
Others
Setup
(➔ 97, Accessing the Setup Menu)
All factory default settings are indicated with “Underlined” text.
Display
e, r select “Display” ➔
Display
On-Screen Messages
Unit’s Display
Screen Saver
Teletext
Blue LED
e, r select “Connection” ➔
Connection
TV Aspect
Aspect for 4:3 Video
TV System
HDMI Connection
Component Resolution
AV1 Output
AV2 Settings
16:9
4:3
PAL
576i / 480i
RGB 2
OK
RETURN
TV Aspect
5 sec.
Bright
On
FASTEXT
On
This setting needs to be changed when connected to a 4:3
standard aspect TV.
[16:9] [4:3] [Letterbox]
Notes
• Aspect 4:3/16:9
RETURN
On-Screen Messages
Choose the approximate time until the digital satellite channel
information screen (➔ 90) disappears automatically.
The length of time the control panel (➔ 87) is displayed can also
be changed, but “Off” does not work.
The digital satellite channel information is not displayed.
[Off]
[3 sec.] [5 sec.] [7 sec.] [10 sec.]
Unit’s Display
Changes the brightness of the unit’s display.
Regardless of the setting, when “Power Save” (➔ 107) is “On” and
this unit is turned off, the unit’s display is turned off.
[Bright]
[Dim]
Screen Saver
This is to prevent burn-in on the screen.
• When this is set to “On”, the masked-off area on the screen becomes black.
[Only when connecting with an HDMI cable or a component video cable and
“HDMI Video Format” (➔ 105) is set to any other mode than “576p/480p”, or
“Component Resolution” (➔ 105) is set to “720p” or “1080i”.]
[On] If there is no operation for 5 minutes or more, the displayed
screen switches to the other states automatically.
– When the DIRECT NAVIGATOR, Copying list, DELETE
Navigator or FUNCTION menu is displayed, the screen
saver is not displayed.
– When music is played, the display returns to the screen
saver mode. (Playback continues.)
– When still pictures are shown (except for slideshows),
the display returns to the DIRECT NAVIGATOR screen.
– The display returns to the screen saver mode when it is
paused by the Pause Live TV. (Pause status will continue.)
[Off]
Teletext
Select the Teletext display mode. (➔ 91)
[FASTEXT] Four differently coloured subjects are situated at the
bottom of the screen. To access more information
about one of these subjects, press the appropriately
colour button. This facility enables fast access to
information on the subjects shown.
[List]
Four differently coloured page numbers are situated at
the bottom of the screen. Each of these numbers can
be altered and stored in this unit.
4:3
16:9
4:3 standard aspect television
16:9 widescreen television
• 16:9: When connected to a 16:9 widescreen television. However,
the 4:3 aspect ratio picture expands left and right.
• 4:3: When connected to a 4:3 aspect
television, side picture is trimmed for
16:9 picture (➔ 139, Pan&Scan).
The “4:3” setting may not work and the
pictures may be shown in the letterbox
style depending on the content.
• Letterbox: When connected to a 4:3 aspect
television, widescreen picture is
shown in the letterbox style (➔ 139).
Aspect for 4:3 Video
To play a 4:3 title when connected with an HDMI cable, set how to
show pictures on a 16:9 widescreen television. 4:3 picture from HDMI
output will be slightly smaller than that from the other outputs, e.g.
Scart and component, this is not a malfunction of the unit.
[4:3]
Picture output expands left or right.
[16:9]
Picture is output as original aspect with side panels.
TV System
Change this setting if you connect an NTSC television or to record
NTSC video from another source.
– Select when connecting to a PAL or Multi[PAL]
system television. Programmes recorded
using NTSC are played as PAL60.
– Select to record television programmes
and PAL input from other equipment.
– HDD Select when playing a PAL
input title recorded on the HDD.
[NTSC] – Select when connecting to an NTSC television.
Television programmes cannot be recorded properly.
– Select to record NTSC input from other equipment.
– HDD Select when playing an NTSC
input title recorded on the HDD.
Blue LED
Set the lighting method for the lamp on the SD card slot.
[On]
[SD inserted] When this unit is turned on and SD card is
inserted, the lamp is lighted.
[Off]
104
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 104
2009/05/13 15:01:37
Component Resolution
To change the setting without using the menu
(PAL ↔ NTSC)
While stopped, press and hold [g] and [; OPEN/CLOSE] on
the main unit simultaneously for about 5 seconds.
Notes
• This unit cannot record NTSC signals to discs that already have
PAL signal recordings. (However, both types of programmes can
be recorded onto the HDD, BD-RE or BD-R.)
• If “NTSC” has been selected, the TV Guide system cannot be used.
• If the current “TV System” setting does not match the “TV
System” of a disc or a title recorded on the HDD:
– the title cannot be played.
– the disc cannot be played during recording, timer recording
standby or EXT LINK standby.
Change the “TV System” to play the disc or the title. Also
note that the “TV System” setting should be changed back
to the previous setting after the playback.
HDMI Connection
1
• Press [OK] to show the following settings.
HDMI Video Mode
Select “On” when video is output from HDMI AV OUT terminal.
[On]
[Off]
When the equipment such as amplifiers is connected
using HDMI cable, and TV is connected to the
COMPONENT VIDEO OUT terminal. (Setup before
connecting to the amplifiers.)
HDMI Video Format
2
You can only select items compatible with the connected
equipment. If you are concerned about output picture quality, it
may be improved by changing the setting.
[576p/480p] [720p] [1080i]
[1080p]
When outputting 1080p signal, we recommend using
High Speed HDMI cables that have the HDMI logo
(as shown on the cover) and are less than 5 meters
to prevent video distortion etc.
[Automatic] Automatically selects the output resolution best suited to the
connected television (1080p, 1080i, 720p or 576p/480p).
This sets the video output resolution when using the component
video terminal.
[576i/480i]
[576p/480p]
[720p]
[1080i]
• You cannot change the setting while the “HDMI Video Mode” is
set to “On”.
• Set the “HDMI Video Mode” to “Off” and set the “AV1 Output” to
“Video (with component)” or “S Video (with component)”.
• If it is set to “720p”, images other than “720p” will be output as
“1080i”.
• Even if you select “720p” or “1080i”, the video output resolution is
restricted to “576p/480p” when:
– freesat programmes in HD quality is output.
– DVD-Video discs, DivX and BD-Video discs recorded at a rate
of 50 fields per second are played.
– images via AV1, AV2, AV3, AV4 or DV input are output.
AV1 Output
Select “Video (with component)” or “S Video (with component)” for
component output (progressive output).
Set according to the signal and terminal of the connected TV.
[Video (with component)]
Select when a TV is connected that can receive a composite signal.
[S Video (with component)]
Select when a TV is connected that can receive an S Video signal.
[RGB 1 (without component)]
Select when a TV is connected that can receive an RGB signal.
If you always would like to view the picture from the unit in RGB
signal, select this mode. The TV screen will automatically switch to
display the picture from the unit when the unit is turned on.
[RGB 2 (without component)]
Select when a TV is connected that can receive an RGB signal.
If you would like to switch to display the picture from the unit only
when playback or viewing menus, select this mode.
• If this unit is connected with an HDMI cable and “HDMI Video
Mode” is set to “On”, you cannot select “RGB 1 (without
component)” or “RGB 2 (without component)”.
AV2 Settings
Set to match the connected equipment.
• Press [OK] to show the following settings.
AV2 Input
BD-Video 24p Output
Set to “RGB/Video” or “RGB” when receiving or recording RGB
output from external equipment.
[RGB/Video] The unit automatically detects whether the input signal
from the AV2 terminal is an RGB signal or other signals
and makes settings.
[RGB]
[Video]
[S Video]
When playing BD-Video recorded in 24 frames, this unit displays
each frame at 1/24 second intervals the same interval originally
shot with the film movie.
• This item is effective only when the unit is connected to a TV
with an HDMI terminal that supports 1080/24p input.
[On]
Images in 24p are output in 24p as they are. (Only
when “HDMI Video Format” is “Automatic” or “1080p”)
However
– When video is being output at 24 frames, images
from any other terminal than the HDMI terminal
may not be output properly.
– When images other than 24p are played, images
are output at 60p.
[Off]
Ext Link
This setting cannot be made when the “TV System” is set to
“NTSC” (➔ 104).
[Ext Link 1] When this unit is connected to a satellite or cable
receiver with a 21-pin Scart cable and this unit receives
a control signal.
Start and stop timings of recording are controlled by
the control signal.
[Ext Link 2] When external equipment with a timer function is
connected.
Recording is continued while the image signal is being
sent to the unit from the external equipment.
Recording is stopped when the image signal is halted
by turning the external equipment off.
HDMI Audio Output
[On]
[Off]
When connected to TV with HDMI cable, and connected to amplifiers
not compatible to HDMI with a DIGITAL AUDIO OUT terminal.
HDCP on HDMI Output
[On]
[Off]
If you connect a DVI device that is not compatible with
HDCP, set to “Off”. In this case, some programmes,
BD-Video or DVD-Video cannot be seen.
VIERA Link
[On]
[Off]
1
2
Convenient
Functions
Tips
Depending on the connected equipment, some items may be
shaded in grey on the display and cannot be selected, or you may
not be able to change the settings.
Choose the setting to suit your TV and preference.
Select when you do not want to use “HDAVI Control”.
105
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 105
2009/05/13 15:01:38
Network Settings
Proxy Server Settings (➔ 110)
• Press [OK] to show the following settings.
Others
Setup
Initialize
Set the setting of the “Proxy Server Settings” back.
(➔ 97, Accessing the Setup Menu)
All factory default settings are indicated with “Underlined” text.
Proxy Address
Network Settings
Proxy Port Number
(The initial setting is blank.)
(The initial setting is “0”.)
e, r select “Network Settings” ➔
Connection Test
[----]
Network Settings
IP Address/DNS Settings
Proxy Server Settings
Network Service
Access
Network Service (➔ 110)
• Press [OK] to show the following settings.
Network Lock
OK
RETURN
IP Address/DNS Settings (➔ 109)
• Press [OK] to show the following settings.
Connection Test
[--]
[On]
[Off]
Automatic Volume Control
IP Address Auto-assignment
[On]
You can restrict using VIERA CAST.
Follow the on-screen instructions. Enter a 4-digit PIN with the
numbered buttons when the PIN setting screen is shown. It will be
the common PIN for “DVD-Video Ratings”, “BD-Video Ratings”,
“Child Lock”, “Parental Control” and “Network Lock”.
• Do not forget your PIN.
[Off]
IP Address
[---.---.---.---]
[On]
[Off]
Select “Off” when the audio is warped while using
VIERA CAST.
Picture Zoom
[In]
The picture is enlarged.
The picture is reduced.
Subnet Mask
[Out]
[---.---.---.---]
• Select “Out” when display of the contents is truncated.
Gateway Address
[---.---.---.---]
DNS-IP Auto-assignment
[On]
[Off]
Primary DNS
[---.---.---.---]
Secondary DNS
[---.---.---.---]
Connection Speed Auto-configure
[On]
[Off]
Connection Speed Setting
This is enabled only when “Connection Speed Auto-configure” is
turned “Off”.
[10BASE half duplex]
[10BASE full duplex]
[100BASE half duplex]
[100BASE full duplex]
106
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 106
2009/05/13 15:01:38
System Settings
System Update
Others
Setup
(➔ 97, Accessing the Setup Menu)
All factory default settings are indicated with “Underlined” text.
In order to update this unit’s software and to support system
changes made by broadcasts, this unit periodically performs
software updates.
• Press [OK] to show the following settings.
Software Update in Standby
[On]
You can perform the unit updates automatically when
the unit is turned in standby.
[Off]
Others
Software Licence
e, r select “Others” ➔
Others
Automatic Standby
Remote Control
Clock
Owner ID
PIN Entry
Power Save
System Update
DivX Registration
Initialize
4 hours
BD1
You need this registration code to purchase and play DivX
Video-on-Demand (VOD) content (➔ 52).
Press [OK] to show the following settings.
Shipping Condition
Automatic Standby
Select how long the unit remains on when it is not being used.
[2 hours]
[4 hours]
[6 hours]
[Off]
Remote Control (➔ 122)
[BD 2]
DivX Registration
Initialize
On
RETURN
[BD 1]
Information about software licence is displayed.
[BD 3]
Clock
Press [OK] to show the following settings.
This returns Setup menus to default settings, except for the
ratings level, PIN , Owner ID and Clock setting, etc.
[Yes] [No]
• The timer recording programmes are also cancelled.
PIN for BD-Video playback, DVD-Video playback, Child Lock,
Parental Control and VIERA CAST
Default Settings
This returns Setup menus to default settings, except for the
programmed channels, time settings, disc language settings,
ratings level, PIN , Owner ID and remote control code, etc.
[Yes] [No]
PIN for BD-Video playback, DVD-Video playback, Child Lock,
Parental Control and VIERA CAST
Auto Clock Setting
This unit usually obtains time and date information from digital
broadcasts. But, if the time is not set correctly, set it to “Off” and
perform the “Manual Setting”. (➔ below)
[On]
[Off]
Time Zone
Adjust the time data.
[Automatic]
The time data will be adjusted according to
your area automatically.
[GMT -6 to + 6] The time data will be corrected on GMT.
Manual Setting (➔ 15)
Owner ID (➔ 13)
In order to prevent another person from using this unit if it is
stolen, you can set a PIN and input your personal information.
Once the PIN has been set, you cannot return to the factory
preset. Make sure not to forget this.
• You can enter the PIN (➔ 13) to change the following personal
information.
– PIN
– NAME
– HOUSE NO
– POSTCODE
PIN Entry (➔ 14)
Power Save
Convenient
Functions
[On] [Off]
Refer to the following when “Power Save” is set to “On”.
• Power consumption is minimized when the unit is turned off
(➔ 14, step ).
• Startup of the unit becomes slower compared to when “Power
Save” is “Off”.
107
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 107
2009/05/13 15:01:38
Other Settings
HOLD function
The HOLD function deactivates all buttons on the unit and
remote control. Use it to prevent other people from operating
the unit.
Press and hold [OK] and [BACK/RETURN ] at the
same time until “X HOLD” appears on the unit’s
display.
If you press a button while the HOLD function is on,
“X HOLD” appears on the unit’s display and operation is
impossible.
Tips
To cancel the HOLD function
Press and hold [OK] and [BACK/RETURN ] at the same
time until “X HOLD” disappears.
Using the Unit’s Remote Control to
Operate the TV
You can configure the remote control TV operation buttons to
turn the television on/off, change the television input mode,
select the television channel and change the television
volume.
TV operation
buttons
1
2abc 3def
PAGE
Point the remote control at the TV.
While pressing and holding [^ TV],
enter the code from the table below using the
numbered buttons.
e.g., 01: press [0] ➔ [1]
Test the TV functions of the remote control for
operability.
– If the functions do not work, repeat steps
–
using different codes, if available. Some TVs may
not be compatible with the unit’s remote control.
Remote Control Codes for the TV
Manufacturer
Panasonic
AIWA
AKAI
BEJING
BEKO
BENQ
BP
BRANDT
BUSH
CENTREX
CHANGHONG
CURTIS
Code No.
01 / 02 / 03 / 04
35
27 / 30
33
05 / 71 / 72 / 73 / 74
58 / 59
09
10 / 15
05
66
69
05
Manufacturer
DAEWOO
DESMET
DUAL
ELEMIS
FERGUSON
FINLUX
FISHER
FUJITSU
FUNAI
GOLDSTAR
GOODMANS
GRADIENTE
GRUNDIG
HIKONA
HITACHI
INNO HIT
IRRADIO
ITT
JINGXING
JVC
KDS
KOLIN
KONKA
LG
LOEWE
MAG
METZ
MITSUBISHI
MIVAR
NEC
NOBLEX
NOKIA
NORDMENDE
OLEVIA
ONWA
ORION
PEONY
PHILCO
PHILIPS
PHONOLA
PIONEER
PROVIEW
PYE
RADIOLA
SABA
SALORA
SAMSUNG
SANSUI
SANYO
SCHNEIDER
SEG
SELECO
SHARP
SIEMENS
SINUDYNE
SONY
TCL
TELEFUNKEN
TEVION
TEX ONDA
THOMSON
TOSHIBA
WHITE
WESTINGHOUSE
YAMAHA
Code No.
64 / 65
05
05
05
10 / 34
61
21
53
63 / 67
05 / 50 / 51
05
36
09
52
05 / 22 / 23 / 40 / 41
05
30
25
49
17 / 30 / 39 / 70
52
45
62
05 / 50 / 51
07 / 46
52
05 / 28
05 / 19 / 20 / 47
24
36
33
25 / 26 / 27 / 60 / 61
10
45
30 / 39 / 70
05
49 / 69
41 / 48 / 64
05 / 06 / 46
05
37 / 38
52
05
05
10
26
32 / 42 / 43 / 65 / 68
05
21 / 54 / 55 / 56
05 / 29 / 30
05 / 69 / 75 / 76 / 77 / 78
05 / 25
18
09
05
08
31 / 33 / 66 / 67 / 69
10 / 11 / 12 / 13 / 14
52
52
10 / 15 / 44
16 / 57
05
18 / 41
108
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 108
2009/05/13 15:01:39
Network Settings
These settings are used when you will connect this unit to a
network. The connection to the Internet may take time or the
internet may not be connected depending on the connection
environment. It is recommended that you use a broadband
connection.
IP Address
Please input IP Address and press “OK”.
The IP address will be cleared by pressing
“OK” when there is no number input.
Press “DEL” button if a wrong number is
entered.
Testing the connection
192
Always test the connection when a LAN cable is connected or when
new “IP Address/DNS Settings” have been made.
.
1
.
.
0 - 9 Number
Press [FUNCTION MENU].
Press [e, r] to select “Others”, then press [OK].
Press [e, r] to select “Setup”, then press [OK].
Press [e, r] to select “Network Settings”, then
press [OK].
Press [e, r] to select “IP Address/DNS Settings”,
then press [OK].
IP Address / DNS Settings
Connection Test
On
IP Address Auto-assignment
IP Address
9
Press [w, q] to select “Yes”, then press [OK].
Notes
• The numeric input range is between 0 and 255.
Setting the DNS-IP
In most cases, default settings can normally be used without making
any changes.
When setting an assigned DNS server from your internet service
provider, perform the following settings.
After performing steps
Subnet Mask
Gateway Address
On
DNS-IP Auto-assignment
–
(➔ left)
Press [e, r] to select “DNS-IP Auto-assignment”,
then press [w, q] to select “Off”.
Press [e, r] to select “Primary DNS” or
“Secondary DNS”, then press [OK].
Primary DNS
Secondary DNS
On
Connection Speed Auto-configure
8
Connection Speed Setting
MAC Address: 00-0b-97-e6-7a-ae
Enter numbers with the numbered buttons, then
press [OK].
Follow the instructions given by your internet service
provider and enter the numbers. If the number is unknown,
then check the number of other devices such as personal
computers connected via a LAN cable and assign the same
number.
If a wrong number is entered, then press [DEL].
OK
RETURN
Press [e, r] to select “Connection Test”, then
press [OK].
“Testing” : The test is in progress.
“OK”
: The connection is completed.
“Failed” : Please check the connection and settings.
Notes
9
Press [w, q] to select “Yes”, then press [OK].
Notes
• The numeric input range is between 0 and 255.
• Perform the “Connection Test” also when any change was made to
the “IP Address / DNS Settings”.
• If the connection test fails, it may be necessary to set the MAC
address of this unit at the router side. The MAC address can be
displayed by selecting “Network Settings” and “IP Address / DNS
Settings” in steps
−
(➔ above).
Setting the IP address
In most cases, default settings can normally be used without making
any changes.
Set the IP address only when the router has no DHCP server
functions or when the router’s DHCP server function is disabled.
After performing steps
–
(➔ above)
Press [e, r] to select “IP Address Autoassignment”, then press [w, q] to select “Off”.
Setting the connection speed
When the connection test results in “Failed” after the IP and DNS-IP
addresses are assigned, perform the following settings.
After performing steps
–
(➔ left)
Press [e, r] to select “Connection Speed Autoconfigure”, then press [w, q] to select “Off”.
Press [e, r] to select “Connection Speed Setting”,
then press [w, q] to select a connection speed.
Select a connection speed in accordance with the
environment of the network connected.
When the settings are changed, the network connection
may be disabled depending on the device.
Press [e, r] to select “IP Address”, “Subnet
Mask” or “Gateway Address”, then press [OK].
Enter numbers with the numbered buttons, then
press [OK].
Convenient
Functions
8
After checking the specifications for your broadband router,
enter each number.
If the number is unknown, then check the number of other
devices such as personal computers connected via a LAN
cable. Assign a different number from those of other
devices for “IP Address” and the same number for others.
If a wrong number is entered, then press [DEL].
109
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 109
2009/05/13 15:01:39
Network Settings
Setting the proxy server
In most cases, default settings can normally be used without
making any changes.
Please use this setting when instructed to by your Internet
provider.
• Set the proxy server only after the connection test is
completed properly.
Press [FUNCTION MENU].
Press [e, r] to select “Others”, then press [OK].
Setting the network service (VIERA CAST)
Press [FUNCTION MENU].
Press [e, r] to select “Others”, then press [OK].
Press [e, r] to select “Setup”, then press [OK].
Press [e, r] to select “Network Settings”, then
press [OK].
Press [e, r] to select “Network Service”, then
press [OK].
Press [e, r] to select “Setup”, then press [OK].
Network Service
Press [e, r] to select “Network Settings”, then
press [OK].
Network Lock
Off
Automatic Volume Control
On
Picture Zoom
In
Press [e, r] to select “Proxy Server Settings”,
then press [OK].
Proxy Server Settings
Initialize
OK
Proxy Address
Proxy Port Number
Connection Test
0
----
OK
RETURN
Press [e, r] to select “Connection Test”, then
press [OK].
RETURN
• Network Lock (➔ 106)
• Automatic Volume Control
Select “On”, the volume is controlled by this unit automatically. If
you want to enjoy the original volume, set it to “Off”.
• Picture Zoom
Select “In” to enlarge the picture, or select “Out” to reduce the
picture.
Proxy Server Settings
Initialize
Proxy Address
Proxy Port Number
Connection Test
0
----
OK
RETURN
“Testing...”: The test is in progress.
“Pass”:
The connection is completed.
Press [BACK/RETURN ] to exit.
“Fail”:
Please check the connection and settings.
Press [e, r] to select “Proxy Address”, then press
[OK].
(➔ 84, Entering Text)
After the input of “Proxy Address” is completed
8
Press [e, r] to select “Proxy Port Number”, then
press [OK].
9
Enter numbers with the numbered buttons, then
press [OK].
Proxy Port Number
Please input HTTP Proxy Server Port Number
and press “OK”. The number will be set to “0”
by pressing “OK” when there is no number
input. Press “DEL” button if a wrong number
is entered.
1
0 - 9 Number
Press [w] to select “Yes”, then press [OK].
To set back to default setting
After performing steps
–
(➔ above)
1 Press [e, r] to select “Initialize”, then press [OK].
2 Press [w] to select “Yes”, then press [OK].
110
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 110
2009/05/13 15:01:40
Software Update
Software of this unit can be updated automatically by
following method.
• From broadcasts
• From Internet [network connection and setting is required.
(➔ 109, 115)]
Update of the software is done when it is in standby mode.
Once the new software is found, it will start the download of
the software, and then update.
Download of the software will start automatically when the
power of this unit is turned in standby or when it is 3 a.m.
• The time it takes to update depends on the connection.
– For Broadcast: About 1 hour. (It may change depending on the
condition of the broadcast.)
– For Internet: About 1 hour (It may take longer than specified
above to download because the download time differs depending
on the network environment. It is recommended to be used in a
broadband environment.)
If you do not want to perform the software update during the
standby mode, set “Software Update in Standby” in the Setup
menu to “Off”. (➔ 107)
If a software update is available, a
notification is displayed
New software version has been found.
The software will be updated automatically
after the unit is switched to standby.
Do not disconnect the AC mains lead.
• Update of the software will start when the power is turned
off.
To start downloading
Press [OK].
To ignore the new software
Press [EXIT].
The unit’s display during the update
• “SW-DL”
: Software is downloading. Download will stop
when the power is turned on, or the timer
recording starts.
• “START”
: Update of the software will start once the
download is completed.
• “UPD / ” : Software is updating.
• “FINISH”
: Updated of the software has completed.
You cannot operate the unit until the update is complete.
Removing the AC mains lead while the update is in progress
may damage the unit.
Notes
Convenient
Functions
• If the timer recording is scheduled within the following time at the
start of the download, the download will not be executed.
– For broadcast: Within 4 hours
– For Internet: Within 1 hour
• If downloading on this unit fails or this unit is not connected to
the Internet, then you can download the latest software from the
following website and burn it to a CD-R to update the software.
http://panasonic.net/support/
111
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 111
2009/05/13 15:01:41
Additional Connections
• Before connection, turn off the mains for all connected equipment and read the appropriate operating instructions.
Adding a VCR: Connecting to a Television
and a Video Cassette Recorder
Adding a Digital Satellite or Cable
Receiver: Connecting to a Television and a
Digital Satellite or Cable Receiver
RF coaxial cable
TV
21-pin Scart cable
21-pin Scart cable
HDMI cable
HDMI cable
RF IN
Digital satellite or cable receiver
You can enjoy
high-quality
picture by adding
the HDMI cable
connection (➔ 10).
HDMI IN
HDMI OUT
DISH INPUT
AV1(TV)
HDMI AV
AV2 (EXT)
OUT
AV
HDMI IN
AV
This unit
DISH IN 1
VCR
RF IN
HDMI IN
AV/TV
AV/VCR
This unit
To the aerial
TV
AV
DISH IN 2
AV
AV1(TV)
HDMI AV
OUT AV2 (EXT)
RF OUT
To record from a digital satellite or cable receiver
Refer to “Recording from a Satellite or Cable Receiver” (➔ 64).
To record from a VCR
Refer to “Recording from an External Device” (➔ 65).
Your existing dish may require an upgrade to allow
additional satellite outputs.
21-pin Scart terminal
The 21-pin Scart terminal transmits both input
and output signals for picture and sound.
TVs equipped with the same type of terminal
can be connected here.
This type of terminal is also called Peritel,
Euro Connector and Euro AV.
• When the unit is connected to a
Q Link-compatible TV with a fully wired 21-pin
Scart cable, you can use convenient functions
of Q Link.
1 3 5 7 9 11 13 15 17 19
21
2 4 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20
AV1 Scart terminal (TV)
1 Audio output CH2 (R)
2 Audio input CH2 (R)
3 Audio output CH1 (L)
4 Audio ground
5 Blue ground
6 Audio input CH1 (L)
7 Blue output
8 Switching voltage output
9 Green ground
10 Q Link control signal
11 Green output
12 Reserved
13 Red ground
14 Blanking ground
15 Red output / chrominance output
16 Blanking output
17 Video output ground
18 Video input ground
19 Video output / luminance output
20 Video input
21 Ground
AV2 Scart terminal (EXT)
1 Audio output CH2 (R)
2 Audio input CH2 (R)
3 Audio output CH1 (L)
4 Audio ground
5 Blue ground
6 Audio input CH1 (L)
7 Blue input
8 Switching voltage input
9 Green ground
10 Reserved
11 Green input
12 Reserved
13 Red ground
14 Blanking ground
15 Red input / chrominance input
16 Blanking input
17 Video output ground
18 Video input ground
19 Video output
20 Video input / luminance input
21 Ground
Using a fully wired 21-pin Scart cable
– You can use a variety of Q Link functions by connecting the unit to a Q Link compatible television (➔ 86).
– You can enjoy high-quality viewing by connecting the unit to an RGB compatible television when you are viewing
in the standard definition (SD) quality. Set “AV1 Output” in the Setup menu to “RGB 1 (without component)” or
“RGB 2 (without component)” (➔ 105).
– “AV2 Input” settings in the Setup menu (➔ 105).
112
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 112
2009/05/13 15:01:41
• You can connect this unit to a TV using the audio/video (AV) cable, S Video cable or component video cables instead of the 21pin Scart cable (➔ 10, 11, 12, 112).
Using an Audio/Video Cable (not included)
TV
AUDIO IN VIDEO
R
L
IN
Using an S Video Cable (not included)
The S VIDEO OUT terminal achieves a more vivid picture
than the VIDEO OUT terminal. (Actual results depend on the
television.)
TV
S Video cable
Audio cable
This unit
OUT
AUDIO IN
R
L
R - AUDIO - L
S VIDEO
IN
VIDEO
OUT
This unit
R - AUDIO - L S VIDEO
Using Component Video Cables (not included)
The COMPONENT VIDEO OUT terminals on this unit can be used for either interlace or progressive output (➔ 139) to provide a
purer picture than the S VIDEO OUT terminal.
TV
Component video cables
Audio cable
COMPONENT
VIDEO IN
Y PB PR
AUDIO IN
R
L
This unit
OUT
PR PB
COMPONENT
Y VIDEO OUT
R - AUDIO - L
Required settings
• Set “HDMI Video Mode” to “Off” (➔ 105).
• Set “AV1 Output” to “Video (with component)” or “S Video
(with component)” (➔ 105).
• Set “Component Resolution” to the item compatible with
connected equipment (➔ 105).
COMPONENT
VIDEO OUT
Notes
This unit
CRT
Use component output
with progressive “Off”.
COMPONENT
VIDEO IN
Reference
If you have a regular television (CRT: cathode ray tube)
Progressive output may cause some flickering, even if it is
progressive compatible. Set “HDMI Video Mode” in the Setup
menu to “Off” and “Component Resolution” in the Setup menu
to “576i/480i” if you are concerned about it (➔ 105). This is
the same for multi-system televisions using PAL mode.
113
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 113
2009/05/13 15:01:42
Additional Connections
You can improve sound quality by connecting this unit to an
amplifier or system component using the audio cable or the
digital audio cable (optical/coaxial).
Connecting with an HDMI (High Definition
Multimedia Interface) Terminal
Using an Audio Cable (not included) for
Better Sound
When connected to an HDMI compatible unit, an
uncompressed digital audio and video signal is transmitted,
enabling you to enjoy high quality, digital video and audio
with just one cable. When connecting to an HDMI-compatible
HDTV (High Definition Television), the output can be switched
to 1080p, 1080i or 720p HD video.
• Please use High Speed HDMI Cables that have the HDMI
logo (as shown on the cover).
• When outputting 1080p signal, please use the HDMI cables
5.0 meters or less.
Use this connection to play sound through speakers
connected to an amplifier or system component.
Amplifier or System Component
AUDIO IN
R
L
Regarding VIERA Link “HDAVI ControlTM” function
OUT
This unit
R - AUDIO - L
Using a Optical Digital Audio Cable (not
included) for Better Sound
This method allows you to enjoy multi-channel surround
sound.
■ With OPTICAL
Amplifier or System Component
When connecting with a Panasonic TV (VIERA) or a
receiver equipped with the “HDAVI Control” function, linked
operations would be possible. [➔ 86, Linked Operations
with the TV (VIERA Link “HDAVI Control™”/Q Link)]
• Non-HDMI-compliant cables cannot be utilized.
• It is recommended that you use Panasonic’s HDMI cable.
Recommended part number: RP-CDHG10 (1.0 m), RPCDHG15 (1.5 m), RP-CDHG20 (2.0 m), RP-CDHG30
(3.0 m), RP-CDHG50 (5.0 m), etc.
Using an HDMI (High Definition Multimedia
Interface) Cable (not included)
TV
OPTICAL IN
Receiver
HDMI IN
Insert fully with this side up.
Do not bend cable sharply.
HDMI OUT
HDMI IN
AV
This unit
This unit
AV1(TV)
OPTICAL
HDMI AV OUT
■ With COAXIAL
Amplifier or System Component
COAXIAL IN
This unit
COAXIAL
• Connect an amplifier or system component with a built-in
Dolby Digital, DTS or MPEG decoder.
• Adjust settings in “Digital Audio Output” (➔ 103).
Notes
114
• When this unit is connected to an amplifier with a digital audio
cable and connected to a television with an HDMI cable, you can
enjoy the highest quality of audio from the disc by setting “HDMI
Audio Output” to “Off” in the Setup menu (➔ 105).
In this case audio is only output from the amplifier not the television.
• You cannot use DTS Digital Surround decoders not meant for DVD.
• Before purchasing an optical digital audio cable, check the terminal
shape of the equipment to be connected.
Connecting with a Panasonic TV (VIERA)
If the 21-pin Scart cable is connected, the Direct TV
Recording and Pause Live TV function is available. (➔ 37)
• Set “HDMI Audio Output” to “On” (➔ 105). (The default setting is
“On”.)
• To enjoy High Quality Video up-converted to 1080p, you need to
connect the unit to 1080p compatible HDTV and set “HDMI Video
Format” in the Setup menu to “1080p” (➔ 105).
Notes
• If connecting to equipment that is only compatible with 2
channel audio output, audio with 3 channels or more will
be down-mixed (➔ 138) and output as 2 channels, even
if connecting with an HDMI cable (some discs cannot be
down-mixed).
• For display units compatible with HDCP (High-Band width
Digital Content Protection) that are equipped with a digital
DVI input terminal (PC monitors, etc.):
Depending on the unit, picture may not display properly or
at all when connecting with a DVI/HDMI switching cable
(audio cannot be output).
• If you connect a DVI device that is not compatible with
HDCP, set “HDCP on HDMI Output” in the Setup menu to
“Off” (➔ 105).
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 114
2009/05/13 15:01:42
Network connection
Following function will be available when this unit is connected to the network.
This document is assuming that you already have a broadband connection.
This connection is not necessary if following functions are not to be used.
The unit is connected to the internet when the following functions are used, which may generate communication charges depending on your
internet provider.
Enjoying VIERA CASTTM
You can access a selection of Internet services from the Home screen with VIERA CAST, for example
YouTube, Picasa Web Albums. (Current as of February 2009) (➔ 85)
VIERA CAST requires a broadband Internet connection. Dial-up Internet connections cannot be used.
Enjoying BD-Live discs with
Internet
You can enjoy more functions such as subtitles, exclusive images and online games by connecting this
unit to the Internet. (➔ 49)
Automatically acquire the title
of the CD
Automatically acquire the title of the CD or the information about the artist. (➔ 82)
Update the software of this
unit
Automatically update the software of this unit. (➔ 111)
Update of the software can be done from the broadcast too.
Internet
This unit
LAN
10 BASE-T /
100BASE-TX
Straight LAN cable
Hub or broadband router
Telecommunications
equipment (modem, etc.)
When your communication equipment (modem, etc.) has
no broadband router functions: Connect a broadband
router. When your communication equipment (modem, etc.)
has broadband router functions but there are no vacant
ports: Connect a hub.
Use a router that supports 10BASE-T/100BASE-TX.
Make the necessary settings in “Network Settings” after connecting. (➔ 109)
Notes
Reference
Refer to the operating instructions for the connected device.
It may not work properly depending on the equipment or environment used.
Depending on the contract with the provider, you may not be able to connect multiple numbers of terminals such as this unit or computers, or an
additional fee might be required.
Use only category 5 straight LAN cables (STP) when connecting to peripheral devices.
When operating the VIERA CAST, use high-speed Internet service no less than 1.5 Mbps for SD (Standard Definition) and 6 Mbps for HD (High
Definition) picture quality by your local broadband company.
- If using slow Internet connection, the video may not be displayed correctly.
Inserting any cable other than a LAN cable in the LAN terminal can damage the unit.
115
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 115
2009/05/13 15:01:42
Operations that can be performed simultaneously
Operations that can be performed while recording or copying a title
( : Possible, –: Impossible)
Playback of
HDD
Playback of
discs
Playback of BDVideo
Playback of still
pictures
While recording to HDD (in DR mode)
Playback of
music recorded
on HDD
–
While recording from external equipment
to HDD (in XP, SP, LP, EP and FR mode)
–
–
While recording from DV input
–
–
–
–
–
While copying in normal speed mode
–
–
–
–
–
While copying in high speed mode
[With finalising or creating Top Menu
( +RW )]
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
While copying in high speed mode
[Without finalising or creating Top Menu
( +RW )]
AVCHD It cannot playback.
Simultaneous operation is not possible while executing “DV Automatic Recording” or “Recording via AV3 input”.
Starting of the timer recording while executing other operation
Starting of timer recording possible during the following
operations
Recording the title 1
Playing the title 2
Editing the title
Copying a title in high speed mode (without finalising/creating top
menu)
– Only 1 programme can be recorded
Executing “DV Automatic Recording” 3
Executing “Recording via AV3 input” 3
Executing Pause Live TV 1
1
2
3
Starting of timer recording not possible during the following
operations
Copying a title in normal speed mode
Copying a title in high speed mode (with finalising/creating top
menu)
Copying HD Video (AVCHD format)
Editing still pictures or music
Copying still pictures
Copying music
Formatting
Finalising/Creating Top Menu( +RW )
Executing operation will terminate when 2 programmes
simultaneous recording cannot be performed.
Playback of disc stops when a timer recording in recording mode
other than DR has started.
Executing operation will be terminated.
116
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 116
2009/05/13 15:01:43
Media (Disc/USB Memory/SD Card) Handling
Inserting Discs
1 Press [; OPEN/CLOSE] to open the tray.
– Insert a disc.
Insert label-up.
Inserting/Removing the SD Card
When the card indicator (“SD”) on the unit’s display is
flashing, the card is being read from or written to. Do not turn
off the unit or remove the card.
Such action may result in malfunction or loss of the card’s
contents.
• Inserting foreign objects can cause a malfunction.
Inserting the card
2 Press [; OPEN/CLOSE] to close the tray.
Notes
Press on the centre of
the card until it clicks into
place.
• It is not possible to record or play continuously from one
side of a double sided disc to the other. You will need to
eject the disc and turn it over.
Disc with a Cartridge
• BD-RE with a cartridge cannot be used with this unit. (It
cannot be used even if it is taken out from the cartridge)
• Remove the DVD-RAM or 8 cm disc from the cartridge
and place it on the tray. (TYPE1 cannot be used) Refer
to the instructions of the disc on how to remove the disc
from the cartridge.
Automatic drive select function
BD-V DVD-V CD
, MP3, JPEG, DivX
• If the unit is recording to the HDD or stopped, it automatically
switches to the BD drive when a disc is inserted.
• If you eject a disc and close the disc tray, the HDD drive is
automatically selected.
Inserting/Removing the USB memory
Inserting the USB memory
When the USB indicator (“USB”) is flashing, the USB memory is
being read from. Do not turn off the unit or remove the USB memory.
Such action may result in malfunction or loss of the USB memory’s
contents.
If you are using a
e.g., miniSD
miniSD card, or a
microSD card, insert
it into the adaptor that
comes with the card.
Insert and remove this
adaptor from the unit.
ADAPTER
Insert the card label up with
the cut-off corner on the right.
Removing the card
1 Press on the centre of the card.
2 Pull it straight out.
Automatic drive select function
• If you insert an SD card while the unit is stopped, the “SD
Card” screen is displayed (➔ 68, 69, 70, 74).
• If you remove an SD card, the HDD drive is automatically
selected.
Disc and Card Care
Holding a disc or card
Handle discs by the edges to avoid inadvertently scratching or getting
oil from your fingers on the disc. Do not touch the signal surface of
discs (the shiny side) or the terminal surface (the metal part) of SD
cards.
Cleaning discs or cards
Removing the USB memory
• Complete all USB-related operations and pull the USB
memory straight out.
• If a USB memory being accessed is pulled out, then the
data may be damaged.
Storing discs and cards
• Do not place or store discs and cards in the following locations:
– Direct sunlight
– Very dusty or humid areas
– Near a heat source
– Places that undergo extreme shifts in temperature (condensation
can occur)
– Where static electricity or electromagnetic waves occur
• Keep the Memory Card out of reach of children to prevent swallowing.
Discs to avoid
• Discs that are not perfectly circular in shape
• Warped discs, which may not balance properly in your unit, causing
improper operation or damage to the unit
• Cracked discs
• Discs with exposed adhesive (from removed stickers or labels, such
as may occur with rental discs or improperly cared-for discs that
were previously labeled or re-labeled)
Reference
• Before inserting any USB memory to this unit, ensure that
the data stored therein has been backed up.
• Check the orientation of the USB connector and insert it
straight in.
• Insert a USB device while the unit is stopped, so the “USB
device” screen is displayed. Select an item and press [OK]
to switch to the USB-related operations (➔ 51, 68, 69, 70,
74, 77, 82).
Discs are not indestructible and occasionally dirt or condensation
may appear. Clean by gently wiping with a soft, dry lint-free cloth in a
straight line from the centre of the disc to the edge of the disc.
Return discs and SD cards to their cases when not in use; this helps
to protect against scratches and dirt.
117
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 117
2009/05/13 15:01:43
Frequently Asked Questions
Setup
Page
How can I enjoy High Quality
Video up-converted to 1080p?
• Connect the unit to 1080p compatible HDTV using an HDMI cable.
Set “HDMI Video Format” in the Setup menu to “1080p”.
What equipment is necessary
to play multi-channel surround
sound?
• You cannot playback multi-channel sound on this unit without other equipment.
You must connect this unit with an HDMI cable, an optical digital audio cable
or a coaxial digital audio cable to an amplifier with a built-in (Dolby Digital,
DTS or MPEG) decoder.
114
Can the headphones and
speakers be directly connected to
the unit?
• You cannot directly connect to the unit. Connect through the amplifier, TV, etc.
−
The television has a Scart terminal
and component video input
terminal. Which terminal should I
connect with?
• If you have a regular television (CRT: cathode ray tube), we recommend using
the Scart terminal. You can enjoy high-quality RGB video from this unit by
connecting to an RGB compatible television.
If you have an LCD/plasma television or LCD projector compatible with
progressive scan, connect through the component video terminals for high
quality progressive video.
If you have a CRT television or a multi-system television using PAL mode
that is compatible with progressive scan, we cannot recommend progressive
output as some flickering can occur.
10−12,
112,
113
Is my TV progressive output
compatible?
• All Panasonic televisions that have 625 (576)/50i · 50p, 525 (480)/60i · 60p
input terminals are compatible.
Consult the manufacturer if you have another brand of TV.
−
When are the software updates
broadcast ?
• The unit shows automatically when a software update has been broadcast,
and also automatically updates the software if this function has not been
switched off in the Setup menu.
111
Discs
10, 105,
112
Page
Can I play BD-Video/DVD-Video
bought in another country?
• Playback of the following discs is not possible.
Can a BD-Video/DVD-Video that
does not have a region code/
number be played?
• The region management information for BD-Video/DVD-Video indicates that
the disc conforms to industry standards. You cannot play discs that do not
conform to industry standards or do not have a region code or number.
Please tell me about disc
compatibility with this unit.
• Refer to “HDD and Disc Handling”.
Cover
– BD-Video discs that do not include region “B”.
– DVD-Video discs that do not include region “2” or “ALL”.
Refer to the disc’s jacket for more information.
−
20−22
118
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 118
2009/05/13 15:01:43
Recording
Page
Can I record from a commercially
purchased video cassette, Blu-ray
Disc or DVD?
• Most commercially sold video cassette, Blu-ray Disc and DVD are copy
protected; therefore, recording is usually not possible.
Can the disc recorded on the unit
be played on other equipment?
• Refer to “Play on other players” in “HDD and Disc Handling”.
Can I high speed copy to a disc?
• Yes, you can. (But you may not high speed copy depending on the disc to
copy or the title.)
Depending on the disc type, the maximum speed varies.
57
Is it possible to copy to the disc,
SD card, or USB memory after
copying HD video (AVCHD format)
to the HDD?
• It can be copied to the disc.
– BD-RE BD-R It can be copied with HD quality.
– RAM -R -R DL -RW(V) +R +R DL +RW It will be copied with SD quality. (It
cannot be copied as it is in HD picture quality.)
• It cannot be copied to SD card or USB memory.
−
• Only MPEG-2 or AVCHD on a Panasonic’s video camera, etc. will be
recognised. MPEG-2 or AVCHD copied to USB memory or an SD card will not
be recognised.
−
MPEG-2 or AVCHD files are not
recognised
TV Guide
−
20−21
−
Page
Is it possible to programme a
recording, with a start and end
time that are different from the TV
Guide system?
• You can manually change the start and end time of programmes in the Timer
Recording menu.
But if timings are altered by more than 10 minutes, “Guide Link” will not be
able to function.
41, 42
Can I receive TV Guide system
data via a connected satellite or
cable receiver?
• No, only via the built-in tuner. To perform timer recordings with satellite or
cable receiver, please use the External Link feature or your unit’s manual timer
programming.
39, 64
How can I cancel a timer
programming?
• Press [PROG/CHECK] and select the desired entry and then press [DEL].
41, 42
What happens when I unplug my
unit from the household mains
socket?
• The TV Guide system data will not be updated. If the unit is disconnected from
the AC mains for a longer period of time, then the TV Guide data is lost. And
if the unit is left unplugged for approximately 60 minutes, the clock and timer
recordings that have been set are lost.
USB
What can or cannot be done using
the USB port on this unit?
Page
• You can play DivX, MP3 or still picture (JPEG) files on a USB memory.
• You can copy still pictures (JPEG) files on a USB memory to the HDD, BD-RE or
DVD-RAM.
• You can copy MP3 files on a USB memory to the HDD.
• You can connect a video equipment and copy SD Video to the HDD or DVD-RAM.
• You can connect a video equipment and copy HD Video to the HDD, BD-RE or
BD-R.
• Data on the HDD or a disc cannot be transferred to a USB memory.
• Data on a USB memory cannot be edited or a USB memory cannot be
formatted on this unit.
• Some USB memories cannot be used with this unit.
Music
What will happen if I try to record
the same CD multiple times?
−
51, 70, 77
74
82
69
68
−
−
23
Page
• New album will be made following the existing album.
−
Reference
Can I transfer the music tracks from • No, you cannot.
HDD to the disc or USB memory?
−
119
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 119
2009/05/13 15:01:44
Messages
On the Unit’s Display
H
,F
(“ ” stands for a service
number.)
BD
(“ ” stands for a number.)
EXT-L
FINISH
GUIDE
HARD ERR
NoERAS
NoREAD
NoWRIT
PLEASE WAIT
PROG FULL
REMOVE
START
SW-DL
UNFORMAT
UNSUPPORT
UPD /
(“ ” stands for a number.)
U50
U50 1
U50 2
U59
U61
U72
U73
U76
U77
U88
U99
X HOLD
120
Page
• An error has occurred. The number following “H” or “F” depends on the status of the unit.
Check the items below and in the Troubleshooting Guide. If the service number still does
not disappear after the check, reset the unit (➔ 122, “To restore the unit if it freezes” ).
• If the service numbers fail to clear, note the service numbers and contact a
qualified service person.
• The remote control and the main unit are using different codes. Change the code
on the remote control.
• This unit is in EXT LINK standby. EXT LINK has been turned on and will stop
operation on the unit until the recording has completed.
Press [EXT LINK] to stop recording or cancel linked timer.
• The software update is completed.
• TV Guide data is being downloaded.
• If there is no change after turning the unit on and off, consult the dealer where the
unit was purchased.
• You cannot delete items on this disc.
The disc may be damaged. Use a new disc.
• The disc is dirty or badly scratched. The unit cannot record, play, or edit.
• The disc may be incompatible or of poor quality.
• You have used a lens cleaner and it has finished operation. Press
[; OPEN/CLOSE] on the main unit to eject the disc.
• You cannot write to this disc.
The disc may be damaged. Use a new disc.
• Displayed when the unit is started or when turned to standby. This is not a malfunction.
• The unit is carrying out its recovery process. You cannot operate the unit while the
message is displayed.
• There are already 32 timer recording programmes. Delete unnecessary timer recording programmes.
• The USB device is drawing too much power. Remove the USB device.
• Update of the software is started.
You cannot operate the unit until the update is complete.
• The unit is performing a software update.
Download will stop when the power is turned on, or the timer recording starts.
• You inserted an unformatted DVD-RAM, DVD-RW, +RW, an unused BD-R, +R, +R
DL or DVD-RW (DVD-Video format) that has been recorded on other equipment.
Format the disc to use it.
However all the recorded contents on the disc are deleted.
• You have inserted a disc the unit cannot play or record onto.
• You tried to operate with a non-compatible USB memory.
• The software is being updated.
You cannot operate the unit until the update is complete.
• The terminal, antenna cable or DISH is short-circuited as for both DISH IN 1 and
DISH 2. Check the connection status.
• The terminal, antenna cable or DISH is short-circuited as for DISH IN 1. Check the connection status.
• The terminal, antenna cable or DISH is short-circuited as for DISH IN 2. Check the connection status.
• The unit is hot.
The unit switches to standby for safety reasons. Wait for about 30 minutes until
the message disappears.
Select a position with good ventilation when installing the unit. Do not block the
cooling fan on the rear of the unit.
• (When a disc is not inserted) Displays when a malfunction has occurred during recording
or playback. This is displayed when the unit is in the recovery process to return to normal
operation; it is not broken. Once the display clears you can use the unit again.
• The HDMI connection acts unusually.
– The connected equipment is not HDMI compatible.
– Please use HDMI cables that have the HDMI logo (as shown on the cover).
– The HDMI cable is damaged.
• HDMI cannot be output because you are connected to a model that does not
support copyright protection.
• Due to the current disc not having authorised copyright information, video output is not performed.
• There was something unusual detected with the disc while recording, playing or
copying; there was a power failure or the AC mains lead was disconnected while the
unit was on. The unit is carrying out its recovery process. This process restores the
unit to normal operation. The unit is not broken. Wait until the message disappears.
• The unit fails to operate properly. Press [8] on the main unit to switch the unit to
standby mode. Now press [8] on the main unit again to turn the unit on.
• The HOLD function is activated.
Press and hold [OK] and [BACK/RETURN ] at the same time until “X HOLD” disappears.
−
−
122
64
111
44
−
−
117
20−22
7
−
−
−
41
−
111
111
95
20−22
23
111
10, 11
10, 11
10, 11
−
−
−
−
−
124
−
108
The message is alternately displayed.
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 120
2009/05/13 15:01:44
On the TV
Authorisation Error.
Page
• You are trying to play the DivX VOD content that was purchased with a
different registration code. You cannot play the content on this unit. (DivX)
52
Cannot finish recording completely. • The programme was copy-protected.
• The HDD or disc may be full.
• The maximum number of title has been exceeded.
−
−
35
Cannot playback.
TV system is different from the
setting.
To playback, please change the
TV System in Setup.
• You tried to play a title recorded using a different encoding system from that of
the TV system currently selected on the unit.
Alter the “TV System” setting on this unit to suit.
104
Cannot record to the disc.
• The disc may be dirty or scratched.
117
Cannot play on this unit.
• You tried to play a non-compatible image.
• Turn the unit off and re-insert the card.
135
117
Cannot record. Disc is full.
• HDD BD-RE RAM -RW(V) +RW Create space by deleting unwanted titles. Even if
Unable to format.
Cannot record. Maximum number
of titles exceeded.
you delete recorded content from the BD-R, DVD-R, DVD-R DL, +R or +R DL,
there is no increase in disc space. Available recording space on a DVD-RW
(DVD-Video format) or +RW disc increases when the last title is deleted
(space may increase slightly when you delete other titles).
• Use a new disc.
32, 53,
95, 101
−
No Disc.
• The disc is upside down. If it is a single-sided disc, insert it so the label is facing up.
117
No folders.
• There is no compatible folder in this unit.
136
No SD CARD
No valid SD card.
• The card is not inserted. If this message is displayed with a compatible card
already inserted, turn off the unit, remove and then re-insert the card.
• The format of the card inserted is incomplete.
• MPEG-2 or AVCHD will only be recognised when recorded on to the card from
Panasonic’s video camera, etc.
• Files on the card are not of the right type.
117
Not enough space in the copy
destination.
• Create space by deleting any unnecessary items.
• Delete one or more items registered on the copying list to ensure that the
“Destination Capacity” is not exceeded.
The disc is not recordable.
23
−
−
32, 53,
95, 101
61, 75
• The unit cannot record on the disc you inserted. Insert an unfinalised disc.
• You inserted an unformatted disc.
−
95
Rental Expired.
• The DivX VOD content has zero remaining plays. You cannot play it. (DivX)
52
This operation cannot be
performed now.
• Some operations are unsupported by the unit. For example;
– BD-V During playback, reverse slow-motion or reverse frame-by-frame is not
possible.
−
This operation is prohibited by
this disc.
• Depending on the disc, you may not be able to perform search or skip when
film previews and warning screens are being played back.
−
This disc is not formatted properly.
When removing a recorded disc
-R -R DL -RW(V) +R +R DL
The following screen appears when you have not processed the disc for play on other equipment.
Finalise
Finalise the disc to enable playing on other
DVD players.
Note: Recording or Editing is not possible
after finalising. This may take up to min.
Finalise the disc ?
Press the REC button to start finalise.
Press the OPEN/CLOSE button to exit.
This disc cannot be played on other players
without finalising.
■ To finalise the disc
■ To open the tray without disc finalisation
Press [; OPEN/CLOSE] on the main unit.
Reference
Press [* REC].
• You cannot stop this process once you have started it.
• If you want to set the background, play menu select or provide a disc name, select “Top Menu” (➔ 96), “Auto-Play Select” (➔ 96)
or “Disc Name” (➔ 94) in “DVD Management” before finalising.
121
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 121
2009/05/13 15:01:44
Troubleshooting Guide
When Other Panasonic Products
Respond to this Remote Control
Use this function to synchronize the codes for the remote
control and the main unit when there are other Panasonic
products close to your unit.
With the unit stopped
Press [FUNCTION MENU].
Press [e, r] to select “Others”, then press [OK].
Press [e, r] to select “Setup”, then press [OK].
Press [e, r] to select “Others”, then press [OK].
Press [e, r] to select “Remote Control”, then
press [OK].
Press [e, r] to select the code (“BD 1”, “BD 2” or
“BD 3”), then press [OK] to set.
While pressing and holding [OK],
press and hold the numbered button [1], [2] or [3]
corresponding to the code set in step
for more
than 5 seconds to set.
8
Press [OK] to complete.
When the following indicator appears on the unit’s display
To reset this unit
To reset the unit’s settings
All the settings except for the ratings level, PIN , Owner
ID and Clock, etc. return to the factory preset. The timer
recording programmes are also cancelled.
PIN for BD-Video playback, DVD-Video playback, Child
Lock, Parental Control and VIERA CAST
On the main unit
Press and hold [2 CH] and [CH 1] for about 5
seconds.
– “freesat Auto Setup” (➔ 98) starts.
To reset the unit’s settings by using
the menu, see page 107.
To reset the ratings level settings
With the unit stopped
Press [; OPEN/CLOSE] to open the disc tray.
Press [DRIVE SELECT] to select the BD drive.
On the main unit
Press and hold [* REC] and [q/✕1.3] for about 5
seconds.
To restore the unit if it freezes
– Change the code on the remote control to match the code
displayed for the main unit (➔ step ).
Tips
To return to the previous screen
Press [BACK/RETURN ].
To exit the screen
Press [EXIT].
On the main unit
Press and hold [8] for more than 10 seconds.
– The unit is turned in standby.
To eject the disc forcibly
On the main unit
Press [8] to switch to standby mode.
– If the unit doesn’t switch to standby
mode, restore the unit. (➔ above)
While the unit is turned in standby
Press and hold [g] and [CH 1] at the same time
for about 5 seconds.
Before requesting service, make the following checks. If you are in doubt about some of the check points, or if the solutions
indicated in the chart do not solve the problem, consult your dealer for instructions.
Updating to the latest software may solve the problem. (➔ 111)
The following does not indicate a problem with the unit:
• Regular disc rotating sound.
• Poor reception due to atmospheric conditions.
• Image disturbance during search.
• Periodic interruptions to the reception due to satellite broadcasting breaks.
• Operations are slow to respond when “Power Save” is set to “On”.
• Operations are not working due to a poor-quality disc. (Try again using a Panasonic disc.)
• The unit freezing due to the activation of one of its safety devices (➔ above, To restore the unit if it freezes).
• When the unit is turned on or off, there may be an unexpected sound.
122
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 122
2009/05/13 15:01:44
General Issues
Power
Page
No power.
The unit does not turn on pressing
[^].
• Insert the AC mains lead securely into a known active household mains
socket.
• Linked timer recordings with external equipment is in recording standby
(“EXT-L” on the unit’s display blinks when [^] is pressed). Press [EXT LINK] to
cancel the recording standby.
The unit switches to standby
mode.
• One of the unit’s safety devices is activated. Press [8] on the main unit to
turn the unit on.
−
The unit is turned in standby
automatically.
• If you connected this unit to an “HDAVI Control” compatible TV with an HDMI
cable, or connected this unit to a Q Link-compatible TV with a fully wired 21pin Scart cable, this unit will be automatically set to standby mode when the
TV is set to standby mode.
86
This unit turns off when the TV
input is switched.
• If connected with an HDAVI Control 4 compatible TV (VIERA) with the
“Intelligent Auto Standby” setting activated on the TV, when switching the TV
input, the unit will be automatically turned to standby. For details please read
the operating instructions of the TV.
−
General Issues
Displays
10, 11
64
Page
The display is dim.
• Change “Unit’s Display” in the Setup menu.
104
“0:00” is flashing on the unit’s
display.
• Set the clock.
15
The displayed time of this unit is
different from the actual recording
time or MP3 recording time.
• Times shown may disagree with actual times.
• BD-R -R -R DL +R +R DL The remaining capacity does not increase
even if titles are deleted.
• Available space on a DVD-RW (DVD-Video format) or +RW disc increases
when you delete the last title (space may increase slightly when you delete
other titles).
• If you record or edit about 200 times or more, the remaining capacity of DVDR, DVD-R DL, +R, and +R DL is reduced and then recording or editing may
be disabled (for the second layer on DVD-R DL and +R DL, this happens after
about 60 times).
• While searching, the elapsed time may not be displayed accurately.
−
−
• The displayed recording/play time is converted from the number of frames at
29.97 frames (equal to 0.999 seconds) to one second. There will be a slight
difference between the time displayed and the actual elapsed time (e.g.,
actual one-hour elapsed time may display as approximately 59 minutes 56
seconds). This does not affect the recording.
−
Compared to the actual recorded
time, the elapsed time displayed
is less.
(Only when recording in NTSC)
• Ensure “Power Save” is set to “Off”.
Available disc space display is
showing different from what was
used
• Available disc space display may be different from actual. Varying may be
large especially when recorded in DR mode.
−
−
107
−
Reference
The clock does not display on the
unit when switched to standby.
−
123
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 123
2009/05/13 15:01:45
Troubleshooting Guide
General Issues
Operation
Page
• Change the manufacturer code on the remote control.
• It may be necessary to set the code on the remote control again after
changing the batteries.
108
122
Cannot operate the disc.
• Press [DRIVE SELECT] to select the BD drive when operating the disc.
26
The remote control doesn’t work.
• The remote control code is wrong. Change to the correct code.
• The batteries are depleted. Replace them with new ones.
• Point the remote control at the remote control sensor on the main unit.
• Remove obstacles between the remote control and the main unit.
• Remove dust from the transmission window and the unit’s sensor.
• Coloured glass may obstruct the signal reception/transmission.
• Don’t place the signal sensor in direct sunlight or in areas that may be subject
to sun exposure.
• It may be necessary to set the manufacturer code again after changing the batteries.
• The HOLD function is activated.
• Software is updating when “UPD / ” is displaying on the unit’s display. Wait
until the update is completed.
122
7
7
−
−
−
−
The unit is on but cannot be
operated.
• Recording drive or playback drive has not been selected properly.
• Some operations are prohibited by the disc.
• The unit is warm (“U59” appears on the unit’s display). Wait until “U59” disappears.
• One of the unit’s safety devices may have been activated.
Reset the unit as follows:
Press [8] on the main unit to switch to standby mode.
If the unit doesn’t switch to standby mode, reset the unit (➔ 122, “To restore
the unit if it freezes”).
26, 27
−
120
−
“U88” is displayed and the disc
cannot be ejected.
• The unit is carrying out the recovery process. The disc may be defective. Do
the following to eject the disc. Try another disc.
(1) Press [8] on the main unit to switch to standby mode.
If the unit doesn’t switch to standby mode, reset the unit (➔ 122, “To
restore the unit if it freezes”).
(2) While the unit is turned in standby, press and hold [g] and [CH 1] on the
main unit at the same time for about 5 seconds. (Ejection may take extra
time depending on discs.)
Cannot eject a disc.
• The unit is recording.
• The unit may have a problem. Eject the disc as in (2) above.
• Linked timer recordings with external equipment is in recording standby (“EXTL” on the unit’s display blinks when [^] is pressed). Press [EXT LINK] to cancel
the recording standby.
If the HOLD function is activated, above operation does not work. Cancel the
HOLD function.
Startup is slow.
• Startup takes time in the following situations:
– A disc other than a DVD-RAM is inserted.
– The clock is not set.
– Immediately after a power failure or the AC mains lead is connected.
– When the unit is connected with an HDMI cable.
• Set “Power Save” to “Off”in the Setup menu. If connected with an HDAVI
Control 4 compatible TV (VIERA) with the “Standby Power Save” setting
activated on the TV, even with “Power Save” set to “Off” when the TV is in
Standby mode, the unit may take some time to startup.
Cannot operate the TV with the
unit’s remote control.
General Issues
TV Guide
The TV Guide system does not
receive any data.
The empty field is displayed for
some or all stations.
The TV Guide information is not
displayed properly.
The TV Guide data is not updated.
• Check whether the clock is properly set.
• If signal quality is bad (ghost images or limited reception), the TV Guide
system may not be able to receive any data. Check the connection and retune
unit.
• Some stations are not supported by the TV Guide system.
• Programme the Timer recording manually.
• There was a programme change or TV Guide information from a broadcast
station was possibly not correctly transmitted.
Check the current programme, e.g. on the Web site for the TV Guide system
provider or station provider.
• Make sure that the time is set correctly. Set the clock manually.
108
108
111
−
−
−
64, 108
−
107
Page
15
98
−
39
−
15
124
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 124
2009/05/13 15:01:45
Digital satellite broadcast
freesat Auto Setup cannot be done • Check connections and dish alignment. The dish needs to be pointing at Astra
completely.
2 at 28.2º East, and Eurobird 1 at 28.5º East.
• If the problem persists, consult your freesat registered retailer or call Freesat
(UK) Ltd on 0844 881 6700 or visit www.freesat.co.uk
freesat channels cannot be
• Check the connections.
received.
• The satellite dish may not be pointing in the direction of the satellite, or
the direction of the satellite dish may have changed due to strong winds or
vibration. If problem persists consult your freesat registered dealer.
• Perform “freesat Auto Setup” in the Setup menu.
• This can occur because the signals are being divided between the unit and other equipment.
TV reception worsens after
It can be solved by using a signal booster, available from electronics retailers.
connecting the unit.
Picture regularly breaks up on
• Check “Signal Condition”. If “Signal Quality” or “Signal Strength” are displayed in red or constantly
some channels, “No Signal”
changing, check satellite dish. If problem persists consult your freesat registered dealer.
• Interference (known as impulse noise) from household appliances such as light switches,
message is displayed.
fridges, etc. may cause picture break up and/or audio distortion. Use a high quality quad
shielded coaxial cable fly lead between this unit and antenna wall socket to minimise
impulse noise pickup. If problem persists consult your freesat registered dealer.
• When “No Signal” message is displayed, check satellite dish connection.
• Perform “freesat Auto Setup” in the Setup menu.
Picture very infrequently breaks up • Electrical atmospheric interference caused by local or distant lighting storms
on some or all channels.
or heavy rain and/or wind may cause pictures to break up and audio to mute
or distort momentarily.
• Impulse noise interference from an infrequently used electrical appliance, or a
passing vehicle or lawn mower with a “noisy” ignition system.
The digital satellite channel
• Select the length of time (3-10 sec.) in the “On-Screen Messages” in the Setup menu.
information does not appear.
• The digital satellite channel information will not appear during playback.
• When subtitle is on or additional information in the digital satellite channel
No Digital TEXT
information is displayed, Digital TEXT does not work.
Some functions of digital text do
• New functions introduced by broadcasters cannot be guaranteed to work.
not work.
After the Auto-setup, there aren’t
• “Shipping Condition” was performed or the unit was in the delivery status. The
any stations in the station list.
Auto-setup was then started and interrupted.
Do an Auto-setup again and let it continue right through to the end. The data is
only saved after this has been completed.
The Signal Strength is over 100 % (> 10) • Reduce the signal amplification at your satellite dish.
Interference or frozen /
• Check “Signal Condition”. If “Signal Quality” or “Signal Strength” are displayed in red,
disappearing image
the signal is weak.
• Check dish.
• Check your postcode area is able to receive the freesat channels at www.freesat.co.uk
• Weather conditions will affect signal reception (heavy rain, snow, etc.), in particular
in poor reception areas. Even during good weather the high pressure can cause poor
reception of some channels.
• Turn off the unit and disconnect the AC mains lead then turn on again.
Some freesat channels do not
• This is due to broadcasts even if they have English sound. In this case, press
produce the sound in English by
[OPTION] and set “Multi Audio/AD”. Please note that this setting cannot be
default.
memorized if you disconnect the AC mains lead.
No picture output after changing the • After changing the “HDCP on HDMI Output” setting, turn the power of this unit
“HDCP on HDMI Output” setting.
off once, and turn it back on.
General Issues
VIERA Link doesn’t work.
VIERA Link
• Check the HDMI cable connection. Check that “HDMI” is displayed on the front
display when the power for the main unit is set to On.
• Make sure that “VIERA Link” is set to “On”.
• Check the “VIERA Link” settings on the connected device.
• Some functions may not work if depending on the version of “HDAVI Control”
of the connected equipment. This unit supports “HDAVI Control 4” functions.
• If the connection for the equipment connected with an HDMI cable was changed, or if
there was a power failure or the plug was removed from the household mains socket,
“VIERA Link” may not work. In this case, perform the following operations.
1. When the HDMI cable is connected to all equipment with the power on,
turn the TV (VIERA) on again.
2. Change the TV (VIERA) settings for the “VIERA Link” function to off, and then
set to on again. (For more information, see the VIERA operating instructions.)
3. Switch the VIERA input to HDMI connection with this unit, and after this
unit’s screen is displayed, check that “VIERA Link” is working.
The control panel does not appear. • The control panel is only displayed when connected to a TV with “HDAVI Control 2” or later function.
The operation on this unit (music
• The operation on this unit may be interrupted when you press buttons on the
playback etc.) is interrupted.
TV remote control that do not work for VIERA Link functions.
Page
−
−
10, 11
−
98
−
98
−
−
98
−
−
104
−
−
−
−
98
98
−
−
−
−
90
105
Page
−
105
−
−
−
Reference
General Issues
86
−
125
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 125
2009/05/13 15:01:46
Troubleshooting Guide
General Issues
Picture
The images from the unit do not
appear on the TV.
Picture is distorted.
• Make sure the connections are pushed in firmly.
• Try connecting an alternative cable.
• Make sure recorder is connected to an appropriate AV input of the TV.
• Make sure the TV’s input setting (e.g., HDMI 1) is correct.
• The TV isn’t compatible with progressive signals. Press and hold [g] and
[q/x1.3] on the main unit for about 5 seconds. The setting will change to
interlace.
• The TV isn’t compatible with RGB signals.
Set “AV1 Output” in the Setup menu to “Video with component”.
• The unit’s “TV System” setting differs from the TV system used by the disc
now playing. While stopped, keep pressing [g] and [; OPEN/CLOSE] on the
main unit for 5 or more seconds.
The system switches from PAL to NTSC or vice versa.
• When this unit is connected with an HDMI cable, use a disc that matches with
this unit’s TV system.
• Picture may not be seen when more than 4 devices are connected with HDMI
cables. Reduce the number of connected devices.
• After changing the “HDCP on HDMI Output” setting, turn the power of this unit
off once, and turn it back on.
Television reception worsens after • This can occur because the signals are being divided between the unit and
connecting the unit.
other equipment. It can be solved by using a signal booster, available from
audio-visual suppliers. If it is not solved by using a signal booster, consult the
dealer.
Picture does not appear during
• Timer recordings work regardless of whether the unit is on or off. To confirm
timer recording.
the timer recording is going to work properly, turn the unit on.
The screen changes automatically. • The screen saver function is activated.
• Set “Screen Saver” in the Setup menu to “Off” to turn off the screen saver function.
• Use the TV to change the aspect. If your TV does not have that function, set
The 4:3 aspect ratio picture
expands left and right.
“HDMI Video Mode” to “Off” and “Component Resolution” to “576i/480i” in the
Setup menu.
Screen size is wrong.
• If you connect an HDMI cable, set “Aspect for 4:3 Video” in the Setup menu to “16:9”.
• Check the settings for “TV Aspect” in the Setup menu.
It may be possible to adjust the display mode on the TV. Refer to your
television’s operating instructions.
• 16:9 aspect programmes are recorded in 4:3 aspect in the following cases.
Titles recorded with 16:9 aspect
are stretched vertically.
– -R -R DL -RW(V) If you recorded or copied using “EP” or “FR”
(recordings 5 hours or longer) recording mode
– If you recorded or copied to a +R, +R DL or +RW
It may be possible to adjust the display mode on the TV. Refer to your
television’s operating instructions.
There is a lot of after-images when • Set “HD optimizer” in the Picture menu to “Off”.
playing video.
When playing DVD-Video using
• If outputting from the COMPONENT VIDEO OUT terminal, set “HDMI Video
progressive output, one part of the
Mode” to “Off” and “Component Resolution” to “576i/480i” in the Setup menu.
picture momentarily appears to be
If outputting from the HDMI terminal, “HDMI Video Format” to “576i/480i”. This
doubled up.
problem is caused by the editing method or material used on DVD-Video, but
should be corrected if you use interlaced output.
There is no apparent change
• The effect cannot be seen with certain types of video.
in picture quality when making
adjustments in the Picture menu
using the on-screen display.
The picture is distorted during play, • You may be playing a TV programme recorded with poor reception or
or video will not play correctly.
unfavourable weather conditions.
• The picture may be distorted or a black screen may appear briefly between
recorded titles in the following situations:
– between titles recorded with different recording modes.
– between scenes recorded with different aspect ratios.
– between scenes recorded with different resolutions.
– between playlist chapters.
• Make sure the connections are pushed in firmly.
• Try connecting an alternative cable.
Page
10, 11,
112, 113,
114
−
10, 11,
112, 113,
114
−
−
105
104
−
−
105
−
−
−
104
105
104
104
−
89
105
−
−
−
10, 11,
112, 113,
114
−
126
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 126
2009/05/13 15:01:46
General Issues
Sound
• Check the connections and the “Digital Audio Output” settings. Check the input
No sound.
mode on the amplifier if you have connected one.
Low volume.
• Check if TV is muted.
Distorted sound.
Cannot hear the desired audio type. • Check if amplifier is muted.
• Sound is not output while fast-forwarding during chasing playback and
simultaneous record and playback.
• Turn “Sound Effects” in the Sound menu to “Off” in the following cases:
– When using discs that do not have surround sound effects, such as Karaoke discs
– When playing bilingual broadcast programmes
• Audio may not be output due to how files were created. (DivX)
• The sound effects will not work when the bitstream signal is output from the
HDMI AV OUT terminal or the DIGITAL AUDIO OUT terminal.
• Audio may not be heard when more than 4 devices are connected with HDMI
cables. Reduce the number of connected devices.
• To output audio from a device connected with an HDMI cable, set “HDMI
Audio Output” to “On” in the Setup menu.
• Depending on the connected equipment, the sound may be distorted if this
unit is connected with an HDMI cable.
• When “BD-Video Secondary Audio” is set to “On”, Dolby Digital Plus, Dolby
TrueHD, and DTS-HD are converted to 48 kHz Dolby Digital and output. In this
case, set “BD-Video Secondary Audio” to “Off”.
Cannot switch audio.
General Issues
• You cannot switch the audio in the following cases.
– When the recording mode is XP and “Audio Mode for XP Recording” is set to “LPCM”.
– When “Recording Format for DVD” is set to “Video format”. (The default
setting is “Video format”).
• You have used a digital connection. Set “Dolby D/Dolby D+/Dolby TrueHD”,
“DTS/DTS-HD” or “MPEG” to “PCM” or connect using audio cables (analogue
connection).
• There are discs whose audio cannot be changed due to how the disc was created.
Page
103, 114
−
−
−
89
−
−
−
105
−
103
103
101
103
−
USB
The contents of the USB memory
cannot be read.
Page
−
117
23, 135
136
−
−
23
−
−
105
Reference
USB memory cannot be operated.
• Remove the USB memory from the USB port and then insert again. If this
does not solve the problem, turn off and turn on the unit again.
• Check that the USB memory is inserted correctly.
• The format of the USB memory or of its contents is not compatible with the
unit. (The contents on the USB memory may be damaged.)
• The USB memory contains a folder structure and/or file extensions that are
not compatible with this unit.
• Turn off and then turn on the unit again.
• USB memories connected using a USB extension cable or a USB hub may
not be recognized by this unit.
• Some USB memories cannot be used with this unit.
• If inserted during playback, recording or copying etc., the USB memory may
not be recognized by this unit.
• You can use USB memories with capacities up to 128 GB.
• Turn the power of this unit off once, and turn it back on. If it cannot be
operated after that, set “VIERA Link” to “Off”.
127
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 127
2009/05/13 15:01:46
Troubleshooting Guide
Playback Issues
Operation
Play fails to start even when
[q] (PLAY) is pressed.
Play starts but then stops
immediately.
Audio and video momentarily
pause.
• Insert the disc correctly with the label facing up.
• The disc is dirty, scratched or marked.
• You tried to play a blank disc or a disc that is unplayable on the unit.
• You tried to play a +RW that needs to have a top menu created on the
equipment used for recording.
• You may be able to copy a “One time only recording” title that was recorded to
DVD-RAM using a different Panasonic DVD Recorder to this unit’s HDD, but
play is not possible due to copyright protection.
• When recording to DVD-RAM using EP (8 hours) mode, play may not be possible on
DVD players that are compatible with DVD-RAM. In this case use EP (6 hours) mode.
• You cannot playback while executing “Recording via AV3 input” or when
recording from the DV input.
• Make sure that the TV is turned on. If the menu or messages are displayed,
follow the on-screen instructions.
• This occurs between playlist chapters.
• This occurs between chapters and with partially deleted titles on finalised
DVD-R, DVD-R DL, DVD-RW (DVD-Video format), +R, +R DL and +RW that
have been copied using the high speed mode.
• This occurs as scenes change during Quick View (Play x1.3).
• -R DL +R DL When playing a title recorded on both layers, the unit automatically
switches between layers and plays the title in the same way as a normal programme.
However, video and audio may momentarily cut out when the unit is switching layers.
Page
117
117
20−22
−
−
101
67
−
−
−
−
47
• You have set a ratings level to limit BD-Video or DVD-Video play. Change this setting.
• Ensure the disc is for the correct BD-Video region code or DVD-Video region
number, and is not defective.
• BD-V You cannot playback while recording in recording mode other than DR mode.
100
Cover
• The languages are not recorded on the disc.
• You may not be able to use the on-screen menus to change the soundtrack and
subtitles on some discs. Use the disc’s menus to make changes.
• After conversion from DR mode or copy to disc in mode other than DR it is not
possible to switch soundtrack and subtitles.
−
26
No subtitles.
• Subtitles are not recorded on the HDD or disc.
• Turn the subtitles on. Set “Subtitles” on the on-screen menu to “On”.
• Subtitles are not recorded in the following cases.
– When the “Subtitle” on the on-screen menu is set to “Off” and a DR mode
programme on HDD is converted to a different mode
– When the “Subtitle” on the on-screen menu is set to “Off” and a DR mode
programme on HDD is copied onto a disc with a different mode
−
88
−
Angle cannot be changed.
• This function depends on software availability. Angles can only be changed
during scenes where different angles are recorded.
−
BD-Video or DVD-Video is not
played.
Alternative soundtrack and
subtitles cannot be selected.
−
−
You have forgotten your ratings PIN. • With the tray open, press [DRIVE SELECT] to select the BD drive, then press and hold
[* REC] and [q/x1.3] on the main unit simultaneously for about 5 or more seconds.
You want to cancel the ratings level.
• The PIN and the ratings level return to the factory preset (“0000”).
−
Quick View (Play x1.3) does not
work.
• Image may not be played back smoothly in case of DR mode titles,
• This does not work while recording in XP or FR mode.
−
−
The resume play function does not
work.
• Memorized positions are cancelled when
– open the disc tray.
– SD CD USB turn off the power.
( HDD Memorized positions will not be cancelled)
• Resume play does not work for some BD-Video disc that contain BD-J.
Time Slip, Manual Skip, etc. do not
work.
Slow-motion playback does not go
reverse.
Reverse frame-by-frame does not
work properly.
• These functions do not work with finalised discs.
• Time Slip does not work when the unit’s “TV System” settings are different
from the title recorded on the disc.
• Slow-motion playback in reverse does not work for title that has copied the
AVCHD, BD-V and AVCHD .
• BD-V AVCHD Reverse frame-by-frame cannot be done.
• Frame-by-frame backward for titles that have copied the AVCHD will be
reversed in 10 frame units.
• Slow-motion and frame-by-frame do not work with the title recorded from radio service.
BD-V
or
AVCHD .
−
−
−
−
104
−
−
−
−
It takes time before play starts.
• This is normal on DivX video. (DivX)
−
Picture stops.
• Picture may stop if the DivX files are greater than 2 GB. (DivX)
−
Cannot see the beginning of the
title played.
• (If connecting to a TV that supports VIERA Link with an HDMI cable)
When [q] (PLAY) is pressed on this unit’s remote control, you may not be able
to see the beginning of the title played until the picture is displayed on the TV.
Using [u], return to the beginning of the title.
−
128
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 128
2009/05/13 15:01:46
Recording / Timer Recording / Copying / External input
Timer recording does not work
properly.
Cannot record 2 programmes
simultaneously.
The recording lacks the beginning
or ending part of the programme
although the timer recording was
set on TV Guide.
Timer recording does not stop
even when [g] is pressed.
The timer programme remains
even after recording finishes.
Cannot record.
Cannot copy.
Part or all of a recorded title has
been lost.
The quality has dropped when the
title in HDD is copied to the disc.
• The timer programme is incorrect or different timer programme times overlap
( is displayed). Correct the programme.
• The programme is not in timer recording standby. (The timer icon “z” in the
timer recording list is grey.)
1 Press [PROG/CHECK].
2 Press [e, r] to select the programme and press the “Red” button.
Confirm the timer icon “z” turns red.
• The clock is not correct. Set the clock.
• The programme information in the TV Guide system may not be correct. It is
recommended to modify the start and end times to allow a margin of a few
minutes.
• It cannot in following conditions.
– Record 2 programmes from external input
– When performing high speed copying (1 programme can be recorded to
HDD)
– Recording from DV input, while “Recording via AV3 input”
• 2 dish inputs are required to record 2 programmes simultaneously.
• This occurs when the broadcast signals are not correct. We recommend you
set the timer again, allowing enough time for the start and end time. (Guide
Link function allows you to set the start time earlier and the end time later up
to a maximum of 10 minutes.)
• When using the linked timer recording with external equipment, press [EXT
LINK]. (“EXT-L” on the unit’s display disappears.)
• The timer programme remains if set to daily, weekly or series timer recording.
• You can not record to the disc by pressing the [* REC].
• BD-RE with a cartridge cannot be recorded or copied.
• BD-RE BD-R RAM -RW(V) +R +R DL +RW The disc is unformatted. Format the disc.
• The disc is protected with DVD Management or Blu-ray Disc Management.
• Some programmes have limitations on the number of times they can be
copied.
• You cannot record when there is not enough space or when the number of
titles has reached its limit. Delete unwanted titles or use a new disc.
• In the following situations, you cannot copy. Delete unnecessary titles from the
HDD and then copy.
– If there is not enough space available on the HDD (If you will copy titles from
the HDD to a blank disc and fill the entire disc, HDD disc space equivalent
to 4 hours of SP mode recording is necessary.)
– If the number of recorded titles and the number of titles to be copied has
exceeded 499
• You cannot record and copy on finalised discs. However, you can record and
copy again if you format -RW(V) -RW(VR) .
• Due to peculiarities of -R -R DL -RW(V) +R +R DL +RW you may be unable to
record onto or edit them if you either insert and remove the disc or switch the
unit on and off while a disc is loaded, a total of 30 times.
• The discs recorded on this unit may not be recordable on other Panasonic
DVD Recorders.
• Discs recorded on equipment other than this unit may not be able to be
recorded to.
• This unit cannot record NTSC signals to discs that already have PAL signal
recordings.
(However, both types of programmes can be recorded onto the HDD.)
Play of discs recorded with both PAL and NTSC on another unit is not guaranteed.
• Some broadcasts are copyright protected.
• Some programmes on freesat channels are copy-restricted and the number of
times you can copy in DR, HG, HX, HE, HL mode is assigned by the broadcaster.
• If the power shuts down or the AC mains lead is disconnected from the
household mains socket while recording or editing, the title may be lost or the
HDD/disc may become unusable. We cannot offer any guarantee regarding
lost titles or discs. You will have to format the disc ( HDD BD-RE RAM -RW(V)
+RW ) or use a new disc.
• If you use Auto Renewal Recording, the old title will be deleted after the new
title is recorded.
• Titles with the “HD No Copy” restriction can only be copied in SD quality.
• Titles in HD quality (titles recorded in DR, HG, HX, HE, HL mode or titles in
AVCHD) will be copied as SD quality when copied to RAM -R -R DL -RW(V) +R
Page
41
41
15
28
−
−
28
64
39, 40
−
−
95
94
33
32, 53,
95, 101
32, 53
−
−
−
−
104
−
33
−
41
33
−
Reference
Recording Issues
+R DL +RW
129
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 129
2009/05/13 15:01:46
Troubleshooting Guide
Recording Issues
Recording / Timer Recording / Copying / External input (Continued)
Stripe-shaped black noise is
recorded.
The programme name and the
recorded title do not match.
Cannot copy to a disc using the
high speed mode.
When copying, it takes a long time
even in high speed mode.
• An external playback device is interfering with the TV because the device is
too close to the TV. Move the device away from the TV.
• There was a programme change after timer recording was set but the
recorded title still has the old programme name.
• High speed copying cannot be performed depending on the disc or title that is
being copied. Refer to “When is high speed copy not possible?” for details.
• Use a disc that is compatible with high speed recording. Even if the disc is
high speed recording compatible, the maximum speed may not be possible
due to the condition of the disc.
• It takes longer than normal to copy many titles.
• You cannot high speed copy to DVD-R titles longer than 6 hours when using
other Panasonic DVD Recorders that are not compatible with EP (8 hours)
mode recording.
An unusually loud sound is coming • When high speed copying to a disc the sound of the disc rotating may be
from the rotating disc.
louder than normal, however, this is not a problem.
• If you want copy to perform more quietly, select “Normal (Silent)” in “BD/DVD
Speed for High Speed Copy” in the Setup menu.
• The external device is not correctly connected.
Cannot record from the external
• The proper external input channel (AV1, AV2, AV3, AV4 or DV) is not selected.
device.
Press [INPUT SELECT] to change.
• Select the input channel for the equipment you have connected.
• If images cannot be recorded or if the recording is aborted, check the
The DV Automatic Recording
function does not work.
connections and the DV equipment settings.
• You cannot start recording until the images from the DV equipment appear on
the television.
• Recording may not be performed as desired if the time codes on the tape in
the DV equipment are not successive.
• Depending on the equipment, the DV Automatic Recording may not operate
properly.
• You can only record audio/video images on a DV tape.
You cannot press [INPUT
• Press [EXT LINK] to cancel EXT LINK Standby mode.
SELECT] to select external input
other than AV2.
Recording Issues
−
59
−
−
−
−
101
65
−
−
65
−
−
−
−
64
Music
Tracks could not be copied to the
HDD.
Title of the newly released CD
cannot be acquired.
ID3 tag of an MP3 file is not
completely displayed.
Page
−
• If there are copyright protected tracks such as SCMS restrictions, they will not
be copied.
• Recording from CDs that do not conform to CD-DA specifications (copy
control CDs, etc.) cannot be guaranteed.
• Bonus tracks may not be copied.
• Title cannot be acquired if the title is not registered in the built-in Gracenote®
Database. Connection to the network is necessary to acquire title for the newly
released CD.
• Only the track name and artist name can be displayed with this unit.
Page
−
−
−
82
−
130
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 130
2009/05/13 15:01:47
Editing Issues
HDD and Discs
Cannot edit.
Cannot format.
Cannot create chapters.
Cannot mark the start point or the
end point during “Partial Delete”
operation.
Cannot delete chapters.
The available recording time
doesn’t increase even after
deleting titles on the disc.
Cannot create a playlist.
Editing Issues
Page
32, 53,
95, 101
117
−
95
−
−
−
56
−
−
−
Still Pictures
The contents of the card cannot
be read.
Copying, deleting, and setting
protection takes a long time.
• Remove the card from the slot and then insert again. If this does not solve the
problem, turn off and turn on the unit again.
• The card format is not compatible with the unit. (The contents on the card may
be damaged.)
This unit is compatible with SD Memory Cards that meet SD Card
Specifications FAT12 and FAT16 formats, as well as SDHC Memory Cards in
FAT32 format.
• The card contains a folder structure and/or file extensions that are not
compatible with this unit.
• You can use SD Memory Cards with capacities from 8 MB to 2 GB and SDHC
Memory Cards with capacities from 4 GB to 32 GB.
• When there are a lot of folders and files, it may sometimes take a few hours.
• When repeating copying or deleting, it may sometimes take a long time.
Format the disc or card.
• The images that were edited on the PC, such as Progressive JPEG, etc., may
not play back.
Page
−
23
135, 136
−
−
95
135
Reference
Still pictures (JPEG) do not
playback normally.
• You may not be able to edit on the HDD if there is no available space.
Delete any unwanted titles to create empty space.
• The disc is dirty. Wipe with a damp cloth and then wipe dry.
• Disc may be defective or of poor quality.
• You tried formatting a disc that is not compatible with the unit.
• The unit writes the chapter division information to the disc when you turn it off
or remove the disc.
The information is not written if there is an interruption in the power.
• These operations are not possible with still pictures.
• You cannot set points if they are too close to each other. You cannot set an
end point before a start point.
• HDD BD-RE BD-R RAM When the chapter is too short to delete, use “Combine
Chapters” to make the chapter longer.
• Available space on BD-R, DVD-R, DVD-R DL, +R, or +R DL does not increase
even after deleting previous titles.
• Available space on DVD-RW (DVD-Video format) or +RW increases when you
delete the last title.
• Creation or editing of playlists cannot be done on this unit.
131
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 131
2009/05/13 15:01:47
Troubleshooting Guide
Other Issues
Network
I can’t connect to the network.
While using my PC, I cannot
connect to the network.
Other Issues
• Has the LAN cable come unplugged? Check that the LAN cable is properly
connected.
• Have you plugged in a modular cable for use with a telephone into the LAN
terminal on this unit? Connect with a straight LAN cable.
• Is the power for the modem or broadband router turned on?
Turn the power on for each device.
• Is there a mistake in the network settings? Follow any instructions you may
have received from your ISP (Internet Service Provider) and make changes to
the settings.
• Are the broadband router settings correct? Read the operating instructions for
the broadband router.
• Is the broadband router and/or modem correctly connected?
Check the operating instructions for each device and connect accordingly.
• Does your Internet Service Provider (ISP) or service contract prevent multiple
terminals connecting at the same time? Check the content of your contract.
Page
115
115
−
−
−
−
−
Other
After performing an update, you
can no longer receive broadcasts.
Cannot set “On” in “BD-Video 24p
Output”.
Pause Live TV stops.
• Depending on the content of the update, some settings may have returned to
the preset values. Fix the settings again.
• Only when the unit is connected to the HDMI terminal of a TV supporting 24p
you can select “On”. In some cases where the unit is connected to a TV via an
amplifier/receiver through the HDMI terminals, you may not be able to select
“On”. In this case, connect the unit to a TV through the HDMI terminal and
connect it to the amplifier/receiver through any terminal other than HDMI.
• Pause Live TV from AV1, AV2, AV3 or AV4 input stops when a timer recording
from external input started.
Page
−
−
−
Language code list Enter the code with the numbered buttons.
Abkhazian:
Afar:
Afrikaans:
Albanian:
Amharic:
Arabic:
Armenian:
Assamese:
Aymara:
Azerbaijani:
Bashkir:
Basque:
Bengali; Bangla:
Bhutani:
Bihari:
Breton:
Bulgarian:
Burmese:
Byelorussian:
Cambodian:
Catalan:
6566
6565
6570
8381
6577
6582
7289
6583
6589
6590
6665
6985
6678
6890
6672
6682
6671
7789
6669
7577
6765
Chinese:
Corsican:
Croatian:
Czech:
Danish:
Dutch:
English:
Esperanto:
Estonian:
Faroese:
Fiji:
Finnish:
French:
Frisian:
Galician:
Georgian:
German:
Greek:
Greenlandic:
Guarani:
Gujarati:
9072
6779
7282
6783
6865
7876
6978
6979
6984
7079
7074
7073
7082
7089
7176
7565
6869
6976
7576
7178
7185
Hausa:
Hebrew:
Hindi:
Hungarian:
Icelandic:
Indonesian:
Interlingua:
Irish:
Italian:
Japanese:
Javanese:
Kannada:
Kashmiri:
Kazakh:
Kirghiz:
Korean:
Kurdish:
Laotian:
Latin:
Latvian, Lettish:
Lingala:
7265
7387
7273
7285
7383
7378
7365
7165
7384
7465
7487
7578
7583
7575
7589
7579
7585
7679
7665
7686
7678
Lithuanian:
Macedonian:
Malagasy:
Malay:
Malayalam:
Maltese:
Maori:
Marathi:
Moldavian:
Mongolian:
Nauru:
Nepali:
Norwegian:
Oriya:
Pashto,Pushto:
Persian:
Polish:
Portuguese:
Punjabi:
Quechua:
7684
7775
7771
7783
7776
7784
7773
7782
7779
7778
7865
7869
7879
7982
8083
7065
8076
8084
8065
8185
Rhaeto-Romance:
8277
Romanian:
8279
Russian:
8285
Samoan:
8377
Sanskrit:
8365
Scots Gaelic:
7168
Serbian:
8382
Serbo-Croatian: 8372
Shona:
8378
Sindhi:
8368
Singhalese:
8373
Slovak:
8375
Slovenian:
8376
Somali:
8379
Spanish:
6983
Sundanese:
8385
Swahili:
8387
Swedish:
8386
Tagalog:
8476
Tajik:
8471
Tamil:
Tatar:
Telugu:
Thai:
Tibetan:
Tigrinya:
Tonga:
Turkish:
Turkmen:
Twi:
Ukrainian:
Urdu:
Uzbek:
Vietnamese:
Volapük:
Welsh:
Wolof:
Xhosa:
Yiddish:
Yoruba:
Zulu:
8465
8484
8469
8472
6679
8473
8479
8482
8475
8487
8575
8582
8590
8673
8679
6789
8779
8872
7473
8979
9085
132
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 132
2009/05/13 15:01:47
Reference
133
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 133
2009/05/13 15:01:47
Specifications
Recording system BD-RE (SL/DL): Blu-ray Disc Rewritable Format
BD-R (SL/DL): Blu-ray Disc Recordable Format
DVD-RAM: DVD Video Recording format
DVD-R: DVD-Video format
DVD-R DL (Dual Layer): DVD-Video format
DVD-RW: DVD-Video format
+R
+R DL (Double Layer)
+RW
Recordable discs
BD-RE (SL/DL):
1-2X SPEED (Ver. 2.1)
BD-R (SL/DL):
1-2X SPEED (Ver. 1.1), 1-4X SPEED (Ver. 1.2),
1-6X SPEED (Ver. 1.3),
1-2X SPEED LTH type (Ver. 1.2),
1-6X SPEED LTH type (Ver. 1.3)
DVD-RAM:
2X SPEED (Ver. 2.0),
2-3X SPEED (Ver. 2.1), 2-5X SPEED (Ver. 2.2)
DVD-R (SL):
1X SPEED (Ver. 2.0), 1-4X SPEED (Ver. 2.0),
1-8X SPEED (Ver. 2.0), 1-16X SPEED (Ver. 2.1)
DVD-R (DL):
2-4X SPEED (Ver. 3.0), 2-8X SPEED (Ver. 3.0)
DVD-RW:
1X SPEED (Ver. 1.1), 1-2X SPEED (Ver. 1.1),
2-4X SPEED (Ver. 1.2), 2-6X SPEED (Ver. 1.2)
+R (SL):
2.4X SPEED (Ver. 1.0), 2.4-4X SPEED (Ver. 1.1),
2.4-8X SPEED (Ver. 1.2), 2.4-16X SPEED (Ver. 1.3)
+R (DL):
2.4X SPEED (Ver. 1.0), 2.4-8X SPEED (Ver. 1.1)
+RW:
2.4X SPEED (Ver. 1.1), 2.4-4X SPEED (Ver. 1.2)
Maximum writing speed of discs
BD-RE (DL):
Up to 2X SPEED
BD-RE (SL):
Up to 2X SPEED
BD-R (DL):
Up to 6X SPEED
BD-R (SL):
Up to 6X SPEED
DVD-RAM:
Up to 5X SPEED
DVD-R:
Up to 12X SPEED
DVD-R DL:
Up to 4X SPEED
DVD-RW:
Up to 4X SPEED
+R:
Up to 8X SPEED
+R DL:
Up to 4X SPEED
+RW:
Up to 4X SPEED
Maximum supporting speed of drive for each discs;
Refer “Recordable discs” (➔ above).
Notes
When recording or playing while copying, this unit may not copy at
the maximum speed.
Depending on the condition of the disc, this unit may not copy at the
maximum speed.
Playable discs
BD-RE (SL/DL):
BD-R (SL/DL):
Video
Video system:
PAL colour signal, 625 lines, 50 fields
NTSC colour signal, 525 lines, 60 fields
MPEG2 (Hybrid VBR)/MPEG-4 AVC/H.264
Recording system:
Video in (PAL/NTSC):
AV1/AV2 (21 pin), AV3/AV4 (pin jack) 1 Vp-p 75 Ω, termination
S-Video in (PAL/NTSC):
AV2 (21 pin), AV3/AV4 (S terminal) 1 Vp-p 75 Ω, termination
RGB in (PAL):
AV2 (21 pin) 0.7 Vp-p 75 Ω, termination
Video out (PAL/NTSC):
AV1/AV2 (21 pin), Video Out (pin jack) 1 Vp-p 75 Ω, termination
S-Video out (PAL/NTSC):
AV1 (21 pin), S-Video Out (S terminal) 1 Vp-p 75 Ω, termination
RGB out (PAL/NTSC): AV1 (21 pin) 0.7 Vp-p (PAL) 75 Ω, termination
Component video output
(PAL 576i/576p/720p/1080i, NTSC 480i/480p/720p/1080i)
Y: 1.0 Vp-p 75 Ω, termination
PB: 0.7 Vp-p 75 Ω, termination
PR: 0.7 Vp-p 75 Ω, termination
Audio
Recording system:
Dolby Digital (XP, SP, LP, EP mode: 2ch),
Linear PCM (XP mode),
Dolby Digital [DR mode (freesat), HG, HX, HE, HL mode: Max 5.1ch],
Dolby Digital Plus [DR mode (freesat): Max 5.1ch],
MPEG (DR mode: 2ch)
Audio in:
AV1/AV2 (21 pin), AV3/AV4 (pin jack)
Input level:
Standard: 0.5 Vrms, Full scale: 2.0 Vrms at 1 kHz
Input impedance:
More than 10 kΩ
Audio out:
AV1/AV2 (21 pin), Audio Out (pin jack)
Output level:
Standard: 0.5 Vrms, Full scale: 2.0 Vrms at 1 kHz
Output impedance:
Less than 1 kΩ
Digital audio out: Optical terminal (PCM, Dolby Digital, DTS, MPEG)
Coaxial terminal (PCM, Dolby Digital, DTS, MPEG)
HDMI terminal (PCM, Dolby Digital, DTS, MPEG,
Dolby Digital Plus, Dolby TrueHD, DTS-HD Master Audio,
DTS-HD High Resolution Audio)
HDMI Output
19 pin type A: 1 pc
HDMITM (V.1.3a with Deep Colour, x.v.ColourTM, High Bit rate Audio)
This unit supports “HDAVI Control 4” function.
Internal HDD capacity
DMR-BS850
DMR-BS750
DV input
IEEE 1394 Standard, 4 pin : 1 pc
USB port
Type A: 1 pc
SD Card Slot
1 pc
LAN (Ethernet) Port
BD-RE Ver. 2.1 conforming, JPEG
BD-R LTH TYPE Ver. 1.2 conforming,
BD-R Ver. 1.3 conforming
BD-Video
DVD-RAM 1: DVD Video Recording format, AVCHD format, JPEG
DVD-R: DVD-Video format 2, AVCHD format 2, MP3 2, 3, JPEG 2, 3,
DivX 2, 3
DVD-R DL (Dual Layer):
DVD-Video format 2, AVCHD format 2,
MP3 2, 3, JPEG 2, 3, DivX 2, 3
DVD-RW:
DVD-Video format 2, DVD Video Recording format,
AVCHD format 2
+R 2, +R DL (Double Layer) 2, +RW
DVD-Video, CD-Audio (CD-DA)
CD-R/CD-RW:
CD-DA 2, MP3 2, 3, JPEG 2, 3, DivX 2, 3
Optical pick-up
System with 2 lens, 3 integration units
(405 nm wavelength for BDs,
662 nm wavelength for DVDs, 783 nm wavelength for CDs)
LASER specification
Class 1 LASER Product (Pickup)
Wave length:
CD
783 nm wave length
DVD
662 nm wave length
BD
405 nm wave length
Laser power:
No hazardous radiation is emitted with the safety protection
: 500 GB
: 250 GB
10 BASE-T/100 BASE-TX
Television system
Tuner system:
Satellite (freesat, Other Sat.)
Antenna receive frequency:
950 MHz to 2150 MHz
Input impedance:
Nominal 75 Ω
Demodulation:
QPSK, 8PSK
LNB input:
F shape terminal female, power supply 13 V/18 V
max. 350 mA, 22 kHz 0.6 Vp-p
LNB output:
Not provided
RF converter output:
Not provided
Others
Region code:
Operating temperature:
Operating humidity range:
Power supply:
Power consumption:
Dimensions (W×H×D):
DVD
BD
#2
Region B
5 °C to 40 °C
10 % to 80 % RH (no condensation)
AC 220 to 240 V, 50 Hz
DMR-BS850 : Approx. 58 W
DMR-BS750 : Approx. 57 W
: 430 mm × 66 mm × 330 mm
: 430 mm × 59 mm × 330 mm
Mass:
Approx. 4.1 kg
Power consumption in standby mode:
Approx. 0.4 W (Power Save mode:ON)
Approx. 12 W (Power Save mode:OFF)
DMR-BS850
DMR-BS750
134
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 134
2009/05/13 15:01:47
SD Card
Slot:
Compatible media:
Format:
SD Memory Card slot: 1 pc
SD Memory Card 4, SDHC Memory Card,
FAT12, FAT16 5 (In case of SD Memory Card)
FAT32 5 (In case of SDHC Memory Card)
Data that can be played:
JPEG,SD (Standard Definition)-Video 6,
HD (High Definition)-Video
USB device
USB standard:
USB 2.0 High Speed
Format:
FAT16, FAT32
Data that can be played:
MP3, JPEG, DivX, SD (Standard Definition)-Video 7,
HD (High Definition)-Video 8
MP3
HDD -R -R DL CD USB
Playable
media
File format
MP3
Files must have the extension “.mp3” or “.MP3”.
Compression 32 kbps to 320 kbps
rates
Sampling rate 16 kHz, 22.05 kHz, 24 kHz, 32 kHz, 44.1 kHz,
48 kHz
Number of
Maximum number of folders recognizable (except
folders
for HDD) : 300 folders (including the root folder)
Number of
Maximum number of files recognizable (except for
files
HDD) : 3000 files
ID3 tags
compatible
JPEG
Playable
media
File format
HDD BD-RE RAM -R -R DL CD SD USB
JPEG conforming DCF (Design rule for Camera
File system)
Files must have the extension “.jpg” or “.JPG”.
Number of
Between 34 × 34 and 8192 × 8192 pixels
pixels
(Sub sampling is 4:2:2 or 4:2:0)
Thawing Time Approx. 2 sec. in case of SD Card (8.1 M pixels,
JPEG)
CD Maximum number of folders recognizable: 99
Number of
folders (including the root folder)
folders
HDD BD-RE RAM -R -R DL SD USB Maximum
number of folders recognizable: 300 folders
(including the root folder)
CD Maximum number of files recognizable: 999
Number of
files
files
RAM -R -R DL SD USB Maximum number of
files recognizable: 3000 files
HDD BD-RE Maximum number of files
recognizable: 9999 files
MOTION
not supported
JPEG
Progressive
JPEG
It may take a few moments for still pictures to display.
When there are many files and/or folders, some files may not
display or be playable.
DivX
Playable
media
File format
DivX
Files must have the extension
“.DIVX” or “.divx”, “.AVI” or
“.avi”.
Maximum number of folders recognizable: 300
folders (including the root folder)
Maximum number of files recognizable: 200 files
Official DivX® Certified product.
Plays all versions of DivX® video (including
DivX®6) with standard playback of DivX® media
files. Certified to the DivX Home Theater Profile.
GMC (Global Motion Compensation) is not
supported.
DivX, DivX Certified, and associated logos are
trademarks of DivX, Inc. and are used under
license.
SD (Standard Definition)-Video
SD 6 USB 7
Playable
media
Codec
MPEG2 (SD-Video Entertainment Video Profile)
File format
SD-Video format conforming
HD (High Definition)-Video
SD USB 8
Playable
media
Codec
MPEG4 AVC/H.264
File format
AVCHD format conforming
-R -R DL CD
Compatible formats: ISO9660 level 1 or 2 (except for extended
formats) and Joliet
This unit is compatible with multi-session but reading or play of the
disc may take time if there are a lot of sessions.
Operation may take time to complete when there are many files
(tracks) and/or folders and some files (tracks) may not display or be
playable.
English alphabet and Arabic numerals are displayed correctly. Other
characters may not be displayed correctly.
The display order on this unit may differ from how the order is
displayed on a computer.
Depending on how you create the disc (writing software), files
(tracks) and folders may not play in the order you numbered them.
This unit is not compatible with packet-write format.
Depending on the recording conditions, the disc may not play.
Notes
Specifications are subject to change without notice.
Useable capacity will be less. (SD card)
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
Remove the disc from cartridge case (TYPE1 cannot be used).
Finalising is necessary for compatible playback.
ISO9660 level 1 or 2 (except for extended formats) and Joliet
This unit is compatible with multi-session/border (except for DVD-R
DL).
This unit is not compatible with packet-write format.
Includes miniSD cards. (A miniSD adaptor needs to be inserted.)
Includes microSD cards. (A microSD adaptor needs to be
inserted.)
Long file name is unsupported.
Video Recording conversion and transfer is possible from SD card
to HDD or DVD-RAM disc.
After Video Recording conversion and transfer to HDD or DVDRAM disc is completed, the playback becomes possible.
Video Recording conversion and transfer is possible from USB
device to HDD or DVD-RAM disc.
After Video Recording conversion and transfer to HDD or DVDRAM disc is completed, the playback becomes possible.
Video Recording conversion and transfer is possible from USB
device to HDD, BD-RE (SL/DL) or BD-R (SL/DL) disc.
After Video Recording conversion and transfer to HDD, BD-RE
(SL/DL) or BD-R (SL/DL) disc is completed, the playback becomes
possible.
Reference
Number of
folders
Number of
files
-R -R DL CD USB
Support
version
135
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 135
2009/05/13 15:01:48
Specifications
■ Structure of folders displayed by this unit
SD
You can play MP3 and still pictures (JPEG) on this unit by
making folders as shown below. However depending on the
method of writing data (writing software), play may not be in the
order you numbered the folders.
Structure of MP3 folders
CD USB
: Numbers
XXX: Letters
Card
DCIM
XXXXX
Prefix with 3-digit numbers in
the order you want to play
them.
(Picture folder)
Root
001
XXXX
001 Folder
001track.mp3 (file=track)
002track.mp3
003track.mp3
Any folder with JPEG files
e.g.,
002 Folder
001
001track.mp3
002track.mp3
003track.mp3
004track.mp3
003 Folder
P0000001.JPG
P0000002.JPG
001track.mp3
002track.mp3
003track.mp3
SD_VIDEO
(MPEG2 folder)
PRG
Order of play
Structures of still picture folders
MOV
MOV
PRG
CD USB
Files inside a folder are
displayed in the order they
were updated or taken.
Root
.JPG
.MOD
.MOI
.PGI
MGR_INFO
P0000001.jpg
P0000002.jpg
(MPEG2 information folder)
002 Folder
PRIVATE
AVCHD
P0000003.jpg
P0000004.jpg
P0000005.jpg
(AVCHD folder)
003 Folder
P0000006.jpg
P0000007.jpg
P0000008.jpg
P0000009.jpg
004 Folder
Order of play
P0000010.jpg
P0000011.jpg
P0000012.jpg
BD-RE RAM
The following
can be displayed on this unit.
Still pictures on the root
folder can also be
displayed.
2
Folders can be created on
other equipment. However,
these folders cannot be
selected as a copying
destination.
If a folder name or file name
has been input using other
equipment, the name may
not be displayed properly or
you may not be able to play
or edit the data.
1
: Numbers
XXX: Letters
Root
1
XXXX
JPEG
.JPG
DCIM
XXXXX
XXXX
.JPG
2
DCIM
XXXXX
XXXX
.JPG
136
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 136
2009/05/13 15:01:48
Copyright, etc.
Manufactured under license from Dolby Laboratories.
Dolby and the double-D symbol are trademarks of Dolby
Laboratories.
Manufactured under license under U.S. Patent #’s: 5,451,942;
5,956,674; 5,974,380; 5,978,762; 6,226,616; 6,487,535;
7,392,195; 7,272,567; 7,333,929; 7,212,872; & other U.S. and
worldwide patents issued & pending. DTS is a registered
trademark and the DTS logos, Symbol, DTS-HD and DTS-HD
Master Audio | Essential are trademarks of DTS, Inc. © 19962008 DTS, Inc. All Rights Reserved.
This product incorporates copyright protection technology that is
protected by U.S. patents and other intellectual property rights.
Use of this copyright protection technology must be authorized by
Macrovision, and is intended for home and other limited viewing
uses only unless otherwise authorized by Macrovision. Reverse
engineering or disassembly is prohibited.
SDHC logo is a trademark.
Portions of this product are protected under copyright law and
are provided under license by ARIS/SOLANA/4C.
HDMI, the HDMI logo and High-Definition Multimedia Interface
are trademarks or registered trademarks of HDMI Licensing LLC.
This product is licensed under the AVC patent portfolio license and VC1 patent portfolio license for the personal and non-commercial use of a
consumer to (i) encode video in compliance with the AVC Standard
and VC-1 Standard (“AVC/VC-1 Video”) and/or (ii) decode AVC/VC-1
Video that was encoded by a consumer engaged in a personal and
non-commercial activity and/or was obtained from a video provider
licensed to provide AVC/VC-1 Video. No license is granted or shall be
implied for any other use. Additional information may be obtained from
MPEG LA, LLC. See http://www.mpegla.com
“AVCHD” and the “AVCHD” logo are trademarks of Panasonic
Corporation and Sony Corporation.
HDAVI Control™ is a trademark of Panasonic Corporation.
“Blu-ray Disc” is trademark.
VIERA CAST
TM
is a trademark of Panasonic Corporation.
“BD-LIVE” logo is trademark of Blu-ray Disc Association.
“BONUSVIEW” is trademark of Blu-ray Disc Association.
Plays DivX® video
DivX® is a registered trademark of DivX, Inc., and is used under
license.
YouTube and Picasa are trademarks of Google, Inc.
“freesat” is a registered trademark and the “freesat” logo is a
trademark of Freesat (UK) Ltd.
x.v.Colour™ is a trademark.
Gracenote® Corporate Description
Music recognition technology and related data are provided by
Gracenote®. Gracenote is the industry standard in music
recognition technology and related content delivery.
For more information visit www.gracenote.com.
Gracenote® Proprietary Legends
CD and music-related data from Gracenote, Inc., copyright © 20002009 Gracenote. Gracenote Software, copyright © 2000-2009
Gracenote. This product and service may practice one or more of
the following U.S. Patents: #5,987,525; #6,061,680; #6,154,773,
#6,161,132, #6,230,192, #6,230,207, #6,240,459, #6,330,593, and
other patents issued or pending. Some services supplied under
license from Open Globe, Inc. for U.S. Patent: #6,304,523.
Gracenote and CDDB are registered trademarks of Gracenote.
The Gracenote logo and logotype, and the “Powered by
Gracenote” logo are trademarks of Gracenote.
Gracenote® End-User License Agreement
USE OF THIS PRODUCT IMPLIES ACCEPTANCE OF THE TERMS BELOW.
This application or device contains software from Gracenote, Inc. of
Emeryville, California (“Gracenote”). The software from Gracenote (the
“Gracenote Software”) enables this application to perform disc and/or file
identification and obtain music-related information, including name,
artist, track, and title information (“Gracenote Data”) from online servers
or embedded databases (collectively, “Gracenote Servers”) and to
perform other functions. You may use Gracenote Data only by means of
the intended End-User functions of this application or device.
You agree that you will use Gracenote Data, the Gracenote Software,
and Gracenote Servers for your own personal non-commercial use
only. You agree not to assign, copy, transfer or transmit the Gracenote
Software or any Gracenote Data to any third party. YOU AGREE NOT
TO USE OR EXPLOIT GRACENOTE DATA, THE GRACENOTE
SOFTWARE, OR GRACENOTE SERVERS, EXCEPT AS
EXPRESSLY PERMITTED HEREIN.
You agree that your non-exclusive license to use the Gracenote Data,
the Gracenote Software, and Gracenote Servers will terminate if you
violate these restrictions. If your license terminates, you agree to cease
any and all use of the Gracenote Data, the Gracenote Software, and
Gracenote Servers. Gracenote reserves all rights in Gracenote Data,
the Gracenote Software, and the Gracenote Servers, including all
ownership rights. Under no circumstances will Gracenote become
liable for any payment to you for any information that you provide. You
agree that Gracenote, Inc. may enforce its rights under this Agreement
against you directly in its own name.
The Gracenote service uses a unique identifier to track queries for
statistical purposes. The purpose of a randomly assigned numeric
identifier is to allow the Gracenote service to count queries without
knowing anything about who you are. For more information, see the
web page for the Gracenote Privacy Policy for the Gracenote service.
The Gracenote Software and each item of Gracenote Data are
licensed to you “AS IS.”
Gracenote makes no representations or warranties, express or implied,
regarding the accuracy of any Gracenote Data from in the Gracenote
Servers. Gracenote reserves the right to delete data from the
Gracenote Servers or to change data categories for any cause that
Gracenote deems sufficient. No warranty is made that the Gracenote
Software or Gracenote Servers are error-free or that functioning of
Gracenote Software or Gracenote Servers will be uninterrupted.
Gracenote is not obligated to provide you with new enhanced or
additional data types or categories that Gracenote may provide in the
future and is free to discontinue its services at any time.
GRACENOTE DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES EXPRESS OR
IMPLIED, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, IMPLIED
WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A
PARTICULAR PURPOSE, TITLE, AND NON-INFRINGEMENT.
GRACENOTE DOES NOT WARRANT THE RESULTS THAT WILL BE
OBTAINED BY YOUR USE OF THE GRACENOTE SOFTWARE OR
ANY GRACENOTE SERVER. IN NO CASE WILL GRACENOTE BE
LIABLE FOR ANY CONSEQUENTIAL OR INCIDENTAL DAMAGES
OR FOR ANY LOST PROFITS OR LOST REVENUES.
Reference
Java and all Java-based trademarks and logos are trademarks or
registered trademarks of Sun Microsystems, Inc. in the United States
and other countries.
137
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 137
2009/05/13 15:01:48
Glossary
AVCHD
AVCHD is a new format (standard) for high definition video cameras
that can be used to record and play high-resolution HD images.
BD-J
Some BD-Video discs contain Java applications, and these
applications are called BD-J. You can enjoy various interactive
features in addition to playing normal video.
Bitstream
This is the digital form of multi-channel audio data (e.g., 5.1 channel)
before it is decoded into its various channels.
BONUSVIEW™
With the new play function of the BD-Video, you can enjoy the
secondary video recorded on the disc, in addition to the main movie.
Decoder
A decoder restores the coded audio signals on discs to normal. This
is called decoding.
Deep Colour
This unit incorporates HDMITM (V.1.3a with Deep Colour) technology
that can reproduce greater colour gradation (4096 steps) when
connected to a compatible TV.
You can enjoy exceptionally rich, natural-looking colours, with smooth,
detailed gradation and minimal colour banding.
[A lower colour gradation (256 steps), without Deep Colour, will be
reproduced if connected to a TV which does not support Deep Colour. The
unit will automatically set appropriate output to suit the connected TV.]
Film and video
DVD-Videos are recorded using either film or video. This unit can
determine which type has been used, then uses the most suitable
method of progressive output.
Film:
Recorded at 25 frames per second (PAL discs) or 24
frames per second (NTSC discs). (NTSC discs
recorded at 30 frames per second as well.) Generally
appropriate for motion picture films.
Video:
Recorded at 25 frames/50 fields per second. (PAL discs)
or 30 frames/60 fields per second (NTSC discs). Generally
appropriate for TV drama programmes or animation.
Finalise
A process that makes play of a recorded CD-R, CD-RW, DVD-R, etc.
possible on equipment that can play such media. You can finalise BDR, DVD-R, DVD-R DL, DVD-RW (DVD-Video format), +R, +R DL on
this unit.
After finalising, the disc becomes play-only and you can no longer
record or edit. However, finalised DVD-RW can be formatted for
recording again.
Folder
This is a place on the hard disk, disc or SD card where groups of
data are stored together. In the case of this unit, it refers to the place
where still pictures (JPEG) and MPEG2, etc. are stored.
DivX
DivX is a popular media technology created by DivX, Inc. DivX media
files contain highly compressed video with high visual quality that
maintains a relatively small file size.
Formatting
Formatting is the process of making media such as DVD-RAM
recordable on recording equipment.
You can format BD-RE, DVD-RAM, DVD-RW (only as DVD-Video
format), +RW, SD cards and the HDD or unused BD-R, +R and +R
DL on this unit.
Formatting permanently deletes all contents.
DNS Server
A server which acts like a telephone directory and translates Internet
domain names into IP addresses.
Frames and fields
Frames refer to the single images that constitute the video you see
on your television. Each frame consists of two fields.
Dolby Digital
This is a method of coding digital signals developed by Dolby
Laboratories. Apart from stereo (2-channel) audio, these signals can
also be multi-channel audio.
Dolby Digital Plus
Multi-channel audio and higher audio quality is made possible using
Dolby Digital Plus. BD-Video supports up to 7.1 channel output.
Dolby TrueHD
Dolby TrueHD is a very high quality audio format that reproduces the
studio master audio. BD-Video supports up to 7.1 channel output.
Down-mixing
This is the process of remixing the multi-channel audio found on
some discs into fewer channels.
Drive
In the instance of this unit, this refers to the hard disk (HDD), disc (BD)
and SD card (SD). These perform the reading and writing of data.
DTS (Digital Theater Systems)
This surround system is used in many movie theaters. There is good
separation between the channels, so realistic sound effects are
possible.
DTS-HD
DTS-HD is a high-quality, sophisticated audio format used in movie
theaters. Previous DTS Digital Surround-compatible equipment can
play DTS-HD as DTS Digital Surround audio. BD-Video supports up
to 7.1 channel output.
Dynamic range
Dynamic range is the difference between the lowest level of sound
that can be heard above the noise of the equipment and the highest
level of sound before distortion occurs.
Dynamic range compression means reducing the gap between the
loudest and softest sounds. This means you can listen at low
volumes but still hear dialogue clearly.
=
+
Frame
Field
Field
A frame still shows two fields, so there may be some blurring, but
picture quality is generally better.
A field still shows less picture information so it may be rougher, but
there is no blurring.
Gateway
IP address of the electronic device providing Internet access. Usually
called a router IP address. (e.g., 192.168.0.1)
HDD (Hard disk drive)
This is a mass data storage device used in computers, etc. A disk
with a surface that has been treated with magnetic fluid is spun and a
magnetic head is brought in close proximity to facilitate the reading
and writing of large amounts of data at high speed.
HDMI (High-Definition Multimedia Interface)
Unlike conventional connections, it transmits uncompressed digital
video and audio signals on a single cable. This unit supports highdefinition video output [720p (750p), 1080i (1125i), 1080p (1125p)]
from HDMI AV OUT terminals. To enjoy high-definition video a high
definition compatible television is required.
Hub
Used for connecting more than one device to the network.
IP address
A set of numbers which distinguish each PC on the network when,
for example, connected to the Internet. When using a PC in a LAN to
access a PC or device that is not included in the LAN, the IP address
is called the local IP address. (e.g., 192.168.0.10)
JPEG (Joint Photographic Experts Group)
This is a system used for compressing/decoding colour still pictures.
If you select JPEG as the storage system on digital cameras, etc.,
the data will be compressed to 1/10–1/100 of its original size. The
benefit of JPEG is less deterioration in picture quality considering the
degree of compression.
138
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 138
2009/05/13 15:01:48
LAN (Local Area Network)
A group of linked devices in a company, school or home. Indicates
the boundaries of a particular network.
Local storage
This storage area is used as a destination for sub contents for
playing virtual packages on BD-Video.
LPCM (Linear PCM)
These are uncompressed digital signals, similar to those found on CDs.
MPEG2 (Moving Picture Experts Group)
A standard for efficiently compressing and expanding colour video.
MPEG2 is a compression standard used for DVD and satellite based
digital broadcasting.
MPEG-4AVC/H.264
A standard for efficiently compressing and expanding colour video.
MPEG-4AVC/H.264 is an encoding method used for recording of the
high definition videos.
MP3 (MPEG Audio Layer 3)
An audio compression method that compresses audio to
approximately one tenth of its size without any considerable loss of
audio quality.
Pan&Scan/Letterbox
In general, BD-Video and DVD-Video are produced with the intention
that they be viewed on a widescreen television (16:9 aspect ratio), so
images often don’t fit regular (4:3 aspect ratio) televisions. Two styles
of picture, “Pan&Scan” and “Letterbox”, deal with this problem.
Pan&Scan: The sides are cut off so the picture
fills the screen.
Letterbox:
x.v.ColourTM
x.v.ColourTM is a name for devices that are compatible with the
xvYCC format, an international standard for expanded colour in
motion pictures, and that follow the rules for signal transmission.
You can enjoy vivid colours of wider colour ranges for a more realistic
picture when connected to a TV that supports the x.v.ColourTM with
HDMI cable.
1080i
In one high definition image, 1080 (1125) alternating scan lines pass
every 1/50th of a second to create an interlace image. Because 1080i
(1125i) more than doubles current television broadcasts of 480i
(525i), the detail is much clearer and creates a more realistic and rich
image.
1080p
In one high definition image, 1080 (1125) scan lines pass at the
same time every 1/50th of a second to create a progressive image.
Since progressive video does not alternate scan lines like interlace,
there is a minimal amount of screen flicker.
24p
This is a progressive image recorded at a rate of 24 frames per second.
720p
In one high definition image, 720 (750) scan lines pass at the same
time every 1/50th of a second to create a progressive image. Since
progressive video does not alternate scan lines like interlace, there is
a minimal amount of screen flicker.
Black bands appear at the top and
bottom of the picture so the picture
itself appears in an aspect ratio of
16:9.
Progressive/Interlace
Interlace is a conventional image signal that displays the image in 2
phases by splitting the display into odd and even scans. Progressive
will display whole image in 1 scan. Therefore, it will give high
definition image without flickering compared with interlace.
Protection
You can prevent accidental deletion by setting writing protection or
deletion protection.
Router
Distinguishes the IP address assigned to each device, such as the
PC, and relays the flow of data within the network.
RGB
This refers to the three primary colours of light, red (R), green (G),
and blue (B) and also the method of producing video that uses them.
By dividing the video signal into the three colours for transmission,
noise is reduced for even higher quality images.
Sampling frequency
Sampling is the process of converting the heights of sound wave
(analogue signal) samples taken at set periods into digits (digital
encoding). Sampling frequency is the number of samples taken per
second, so larger numbers mean more faithful reproduction of the
original sound.
Signal quality
This is the guide for checking the satellite dish direction. The
numbered values displayed do not indicate the strength of the signal,
but the quality of the signal (the signal to noise ratio, or “S/N”). The
channels you can receive are affected by weather conditions,
seasons, time (day/night), region, length of the cable that is
connected to the satellite dish, etc.
Subnet mask
Enables efficient network use. A set of numbers which identify which
part of the IP address allocated to every device connected to the
router is the network portion.
Reference
Thumbnail
This refers to a miniature representation of a picture used to display
multiple pictures in the form of a list.
VIERA CAST
An information service unique to Panasonic where specific Web sites
can be viewed on this unit by connecting to the Internet without using
a PC.
139
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 139
2009/05/13 15:01:49
Safety precautions
Placement
Set the unit up on an even surface away from direct sunlight, high
temperatures, high humidity, and excessive vibration. These
conditions can damage the cabinet and other components, thereby
shortening the unit’s service life.
Do not place heavy items on the unit.
Voltage
Do not use high voltage power sources. This can overload the unit
and cause a fire.
Do not use a DC power source. Check the source carefully when
setting the unit up on a ship or other place where DC is used.
AC mains lead protection
Ensure the AC mains lead is connected correctly and not
damaged. Poor connection and lead damage can cause fire or
electric shock. Do not pull, bend, or place heavy items on the lead.
Grasp the plug firmly when unplugging the lead. Pulling the AC
mains lead can cause electric shock.
Do not handle the plug with wet hands. This can cause electric
shock.
Foreign matter
Do not let metal objects fall inside the unit. This can cause electric
shock or malfunction.
Do not let liquids get into the unit. This can cause electric shock or
malfunction. If this occurs, immediately disconnect the unit from the
power supply and contact your dealer.
Do not spray insecticides onto or into the unit. They contain
flammable gases which can ignite if sprayed into the unit.
Service
Do not attempt to repair this unit by yourself. If sound is
interrupted, indicators fail to light, smoke appears, or any other
problem that is not covered in these instructions occurs, disconnect
the AC mains lead and contact your dealer or an authorized service
centre. Electric shock or damage to the unit can occur if the unit is
repaired, disassembled or reconstructed by unqualified persons.
Extend operating life by disconnecting the unit from the power
source if it is not to be used for a long time.
CAUTION!
THIS PRODUCT UTILIZES A LASER.
USE OF CONTROLS OR ADJUSTMENTS OR
PERFORMANCE OF PROCEDURES OTHER THAN THOSE
SPECIFIED HEREIN MAY RESULT IN HAZARDOUS
RADIATION EXPOSURE.
DO NOT OPEN COVERS AND DO NOT REPAIR YOURSELF.
REFER SERVICING TO QUALIFIED PERSONNEL.
WARNING:
TO REDUCE THE RISK OF FIRE, ELECTRIC SHOCK OR
PRODUCT DAMAGE,
DO NOT EXPOSE THIS APPARATUS TO RAIN, MOISTURE,
DRIPPING OR SPLASHING AND THAT NO OBJECTS
FILLED WITH LIQUIDS, SUCH AS VASES, SHALL BE
PLACED ON THE APPARATUS.
USE ONLY THE RECOMMENDED ACCESSORIES.
DO NOT REMOVE THE COVER (OR BACK); THERE ARE NO
USER SERVICEABLE PARTS INSIDE. REFER SERVICING
TO QUALIFIED SERVICE PERSONNEL.
CAUTION!
DO NOT INSTALL OR PLACE THIS UNIT IN A BOOKCASE,
BUILT-IN CABINET OR IN ANOTHER CONFINED SPACE.
ENSURE THE UNIT IS WELL VENTILATED. TO PREVENT
RISK OF ELECTRIC SHOCK OR FIRE HAZARD DUE TO
OVERHEATING, ENSURE THAT CURTAINS AND ANY
OTHER MATERIALS DO NOT OBSTRUCT THE
VENTILATION VENTS.
DO NOT OBSTRUCT THE UNIT’S VENTILATION OPENINGS
WITH NEWSPAPERS, TABLECLOTHS, CURTAINS, AND
SIMILAR ITEMS.
DO NOT PLACE SOURCES OF NAKED FLAMES, SUCH AS
LIGHTED CANDLES, ON THE UNIT.
DISPOSE OF BATTERIES IN AN ENVIRONMENTALLY
FRIENDLY MANNER.
CAUTION
Danger of explosion if battery is incorrectly replaced. Replace
only with the same or equivalent type recommended by the
manufacturer. Dispose of used batteries according to the
manufacturer’s instructions.
THIS UNIT IS INTENDED FOR USE IN MODERATE CLIMATES.
This product may receive radio interference caused by mobile
telephones during use. If such interference is apparent, please
increase separation between the product and the mobile
telephone.
The socket outlet shall be installed near the equipment and
easily accessible.
The mains plug of the power supply cord shall remain readily
operable.
To completely disconnect this apparatus from the AC Mains,
disconnect the power supply cord plug from AC receptacle.
The recording and playback of content on this or any other device may require permission from the owner of the copyright or other such rights
in that content. Panasonic has no authority to and does not grant you that permission and explicitly disclaims any right, ability or intention to
obtain such permission on your behalf. It is your responsibility to ensure that your use of this or any other device complies with applicable
copyright legislation in your country. Please refer to that legislation for more information on the relevant laws and regulations involved or
contact the owner of the rights in the content you wish to record or playback.
140
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 140
2009/05/13 15:01:49
Information for Users on Collection and Disposal of Old
Equipment and used Batteries
These symbols on the products, packaging, and/
or accompanying documents mean that used
electrical and electronic products and batteries
should not be mixed with general household
waste.
For proper treatment, recovery and recycling of
old products and used batteries, please take
them to applicable collection points, in
accordance with your national legislation and the
Directives 2002/96/EC and 2006/66/EC.
By disposing of these products and batteries
correctly, you will help to save valuable resources
and prevent any potential negative effects on
human health and the environment which could
otherwise arise from inappropriate waste
handling.
For more information about collection and
recycling of old products and batteries, please
contact your local municipality, your waste
disposal service or the point of sale where you
purchased the items.
Penalties may be applicable for incorrect disposal
of this waste, in accordance with national
legislation.
For business users in the European Union
If you wish to discard electrical and electronic
equipment, please contact your dealer or
supplier for further information.
[Information on Disposal in other Countries
outside the European Union]
These symbols are only valid in the European
Union. If you wish to discard these items, please
contact your local authorities or dealer and ask
for the correct method of disposal.
Cd
Note for the battery symbol (bottom two
symbol examples):
This symbol might be used in combination with a
chemical symbol. In this case it complies with the
requirement set by the Directive for the chemical
involved.
CLASS 1
LASER PRODUCT
(Back of product)
(Inside of product)
Reference
For your safety, be sure not to connect or handle the equipment
with wet hands.
141
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 141
2009/05/13 15:01:49
Index
A
B
C
D
Adjust the Audio Quality (Sound Menu) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 89
Adjust the Picture Quality (Picture Menu) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 89
Album (Music)
Edit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80
Play . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78
Album (Still Picture)
Copy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74
Delete . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 76
Edit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72
Play . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70
Angle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88
Aspect . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 92
Audio
Playback . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88
Audio Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90
Auto Renewal Recording. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41
AVCHD
Copy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68
Play . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48
BD/DVD Speed for High Speed Copy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101
BD-Live . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49
BONUSVIEW™ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49
Change Thumbnail . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54
Channel
Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97
Chapter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56
Chasing Playback. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37
Cleaning
Disc . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117
Lens. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7
Main unit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7
Clock Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15
Connection
Aerial . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112
Amplifier. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114
COMPONENT VIDEO OUT terminals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113
HDMI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10–11, 112, 114
Network . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115
Satellite dish . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10–12, 112
S VIDEO OUT terminal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113
Television . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10–12, 112–114
Copy
HD video . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68
Music . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82
SD video . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69
Still picture . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74
Title . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30–31, 57–63
Copy Title Playing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60
Create Chapter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47, 56
Deep Colour . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 138
Delete
Album (music) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 83
Album (still picture) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 76
All titles (discs). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95
All titles (HDD) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101
Chapter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56
Still picture . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 76
Title . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32, 53
Track . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 83
Digital Audio Output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103
Direct Navigator
Music . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78
Still picture . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70
Title . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45
Direct TV Recording . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37
Discs
Disc name . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94
Discs that cannot be played. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22
Discs you can use for recording and play . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20
Format . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95
Play-only discs. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22
Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94
E
F
G
H
I
J
L
M
N
O
Divide Title . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54
DivX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51, 135, 138
DR File Conversion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55
DR Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36
Edit
Chapter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56
Music on HDD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80
Still picture . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72
Title . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53
Finalise . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96, 138
Format . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95, 101, 138
freesat
Auto setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13–14
Channel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24
Timer Recording . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28–29
TV Guide . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43–44
FR (Flexible Recording Mode). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36
FUNCTION MENU . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 92
Glossary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 138
Gracenote® Database. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82
HDD
Format . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101
Handling Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6
Information for recording and play . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20
HDMI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 138
Connecting a TV . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10–11
Connection with a receiver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114
Settings (HDMI Connection) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105
HD Video
Copy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68
Play . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48
Initialize . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107
JPEG . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135, 138
Language
Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100
Soundtrack. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88, 100
Subtitles. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88, 100
Linked Timer Recording . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 64
LPCM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103, 139
Manual Skip . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47
Menu
DivX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51
Setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97
Mode
Recording . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35
Still mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102
MPEG2. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 139
Copy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69
MP3
Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77
Music
Copy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82
Delete . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 83
Edit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80
Play (CD) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77
Play (MP3) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77
Play (music on HDD) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78
Name
Album (music) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80
Album (still picture) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73
Disc . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94
Entering Text . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 84
Title . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53
Network
Connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115
Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109
Other Satellite Service
Auto setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16–17
Channel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25
Owner ID . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13
142
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 142
2009/05/13 15:01:50
P
Q
R
T
U
V
X
Timer Recording
Check, change or delete a programme . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41
Manual recording. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39
Using the TV Guide . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28–29
Time Slip . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47
Title
Copy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30–31, 57–63
Delete . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32, 53
Edit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53
Play . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26
Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54
TV Guide . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28, 43–44
TV System (PAL/NTSC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 104
USB
Copy (HD video) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68
Copy (music) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82
Copy (SD video) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69
Copy (still picture) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74
Insert . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117
Play (still picture) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70
Supported format. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23
VIERA CAST™ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 85
VIERA Link (HDAVI Control)
Connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10–11, 112, 114
Operation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86
Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105
x.v.Colour™ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 139
2 Programmes Simultaneous Recording . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36
Reference
S
Parental Guidance
Child lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99
Parental control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100
Partial Delete . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54
Pause Live TV . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 93
VIERA . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 87
Playing back
HD video . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48
Music . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78
Still picture . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70
Title . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26
Playlist
Music . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 81
Title . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48
Pop-up Menu. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26
Power Save . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107
Progressive. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 89, 139
Properties
Music . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79
Still picture . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71
Title . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53
Protection
Album (still picture) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73
Card. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23
Discs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94
Still picture . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73
Title . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54
Quick View . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46
Ratings level
BD-Video . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100
DVD-Video. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100
Recording
Aspect . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101
Flexible Recording via AV input . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67
Important notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33–34
Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35
Recording via AV3 input . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67
Timer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28–29
Remote Control Code . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122
Repeat Play. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 89
Resume Play Function. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26
SD Card
Copy (HD video) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68
Copy (SD video) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69
Copy (still picture) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74
Format . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95
Play (HD video) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48
Play (still picture) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70
Supported format. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23
SD Video
Copy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69
Select Channel
freesat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24
Other satellite service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25
Setup Menu. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97
Simultaneous Record and Playback . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37
Slideshow . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71
Software Update. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111
Soundtrack . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88
Specifications. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 134
Status Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 91
Still Picture
Copy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74
Delete . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 76
Edit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72
Play . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70
Subtitle
Disc . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88
Playback . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47
Switch the Audio/Subtitles on the Disc (Disc Menu) . . . . . 88
143
RQT9430
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 143
2009/05/13 15:01:50
EU
Environment friendly printed on chlorine free bleached paper.
Panasonic Corporation
Web Site: http://panasonic.net
Pursuant to at the directive 2004/108/EC, article 9(2)
Panasonic Testing Centre
Panasonic Marketing Europe GmbH
Winsbergring 15, 22525 Hamburg, Germany
RQT9430-1B_DMR-BS850_EB.indb 144
En
RQT9430-1B
H0409FJ1059
2009/05/13 15:01:50